POSTCONF man page on Oracle

Man page or keyword search:  
man Server   33470 pages
apropos Keyword Search (all sections)
Output format
Oracle logo
[printable version]

POSTCONF(5)							   POSTCONF(5)

NAME
       postconf - Postfix configuration parameters

SYNOPSIS
       postconf parameter ...

       postconf -e "parameter=value" ...

DESCRIPTION
       The  Postfix main.cf configuration file specifies a small subset of all
       the parameters that control the operation of the Postfix	 mail  system.
       Parameters not specified in main.cf are left at their default values.

       The general format of the main.cf file is as follows:

       ·      Each  logical line has the form "parameter = value".  Whitespace
	      around the "=" is ignored, as is whitespace at the end of a log‐
	      ical line.

       ·      Empty  lines and whitespace-only lines are ignored, as are lines
	      whose first non-whitespace character is a `#'.

       ·      A logical line starts with  non-whitespace  text.	 A  line  that
	      starts with whitespace continues a logical line.

       ·      A parameter value may refer to other parameters.

	      ·	     The  expressions  "$name",	 "${name}"  or	"$(name)"  are
		     recursively replaced by the value of the named parameter.

	      ·	     The expression "${name?value}" expands  to	 "value"  when
		     "$name" is non-empty. This form is supported with Postfix
		     version 2.2 and later.

	      ·	     The expression "${name:value}" expands  to	 "value"  when
		     "$name"  is  empty.  This	form is supported with Postfix
		     version 2.2 and later.

	      ·	     Specify "$$" to produce a single "$" character.

       ·      When the same parameter is defined multiple times, only the last
	      instance is remembered.

       ·      Otherwise,  the  order of main.cf parameter definitions does not
	      matter.

       The remainder of this document is a description of all Postfix configu‐
       ration parameters. Default values are shown after the parameter name in
       parentheses, and can be looked up with the "postconf -d" command.

       Note: this is not an invitation to make changes to  Postfix  configura‐
       tion  parameters.  Unnecessary  changes can impair the operation of the
       mail system.

2bounce_notice_recipient (default: postmaster)
       The recipient of undeliverable mail that	 cannot	 be  returned  to  the
       sender.	This feature is enabled with the notify_classes parameter.

access_map_defer_code (default: 450)
       The  numerical  Postfix	SMTP server response code for an access(5) map
       "defer" action, including "defer_if_permit" or "defer_if_reject". Prior
       to Postfix 2.6, the response is hard-coded as "450".

       Do  not	change	this  unless  you have a complete understanding of RFC
       5321.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

access_map_reject_code (default: 554)
       The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code for  an	access(5)  map
       "reject" action.

       Do  not	change	this  unless  you have a complete understanding of RFC
       5321.

address_verify_cache_cleanup_interval (default: 12h)
       The amount of time  between  verify(8)  address	verification  database
       cleanup	runs.  This  feature  requires	that the database supports the
       "delete" and "sequence" operators.  Specify a zero interval to  disable
       database cleanup.

       After  each  database cleanup run, the verify(8) daemon logs the number
       of entries that were retained and dropped. A cleanup run is  logged  as
       "partial"  when	the  daemon  terminates	 early after "postfix reload",
       "postfix stop", or no requests for $max_idle seconds.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7.

address_verify_default_transport (default: $default_transport)
       Overrides the default_transport parameter setting for address verifica‐
       tion probes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_local_transport (default: $local_transport)
       Overrides  the  local_transport parameter setting for address verifica‐
       tion probes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_map (default: see postconf -d output)
       Lookup table for persistent address verification status	storage.   The
       table  is maintained by the verify(8) service, and is opened before the
       process releases privileges.

       The lookup table is persistent by  default  (Postfix  2.7  and  later).
       Specify	an empty table name to keep the information in volatile memory
       which is lost after "postfix reload" or "postfix	 stop".	 This  is  the
       default with Postfix version 2.6 and earlier.

       Specify a location in a file system that will not fill up. If the data‐
       base becomes corrupted, the world comes to an end.  To  recover	delete
       (NOT: truncate) the file and do "postfix reload".

       Postfix	daemon	processes do not use root privileges when opening this
       file (Postfix 2.5 and later).  The file must therefore be stored	 under
       a  Postfix-owned	 directory such as the data_directory.	As a migration
       aid, an attempt to open the file under a non-Postfix directory is redi‐
       rected to the Postfix-owned data_directory, and a warning is logged.

       Examples:

       address_verify_map = hash:/var/lib/postfix/verify
       address_verify_map = btree:/var/lib/postfix/verify

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_negative_cache (default: yes)
       Enable caching of failed address verification probe results.  When this
       feature is enabled, the cache may pollute quickly with  garbage.	  When
       this  feature  is  disabled, Postfix will generate an address probe for
       every lookup.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_negative_expire_time (default: 3d)
       The time after which a failed probe expires from the address  verifica‐
       tion cache.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_negative_refresh_time (default: 3h)
       The  time  after	 which a failed address verification probe needs to be
       refreshed.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_poll_count (default: normal: 3, overload: 1)
       How many times to query the verify(8) service for the completion of  an
       address verification request in progress.

       By  default,  the Postfix SMTP server polls the verify(8) service up to
       three times under non-overload conditions, and  only  once  when	 under
       overload.  With Postfix version 2.5 and earlier, the SMTP server always
       polls the verify(8) service up to three times by default.

       Specify 1 to implement a crude form of  greylisting,  that  is,	always
       defer the first delivery request for a new address.

       Examples:

       # Postfix <= 2.6 default
       address_verify_poll_count = 3
       # Poor man's greylisting
       address_verify_poll_count = 1

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_poll_delay (default: 3s)
       The delay between queries for the completion of an address verification
       request in progress.

       The default polling delay is 3 seconds.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_positive_expire_time (default: 31d)
       The time after which a successful probe expires from the address	 veri‐
       fication cache.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_positive_refresh_time (default: 7d)
       The  time  after which a successful address verification probe needs to
       be refreshed.  The address verification status is not updated when  the
       probe fails (optimistic caching).

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_relay_transport (default: $relay_transport)
       Overrides  the  relay_transport parameter setting for address verifica‐
       tion probes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_relayhost (default: $relayhost)
       Overrides the relayhost	parameter  setting  for	 address  verification
       probes. This information can be overruled with the transport(5) table.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_sender (default: $double_bounce_sender)
       The  sender  address  to	 use  in address verification probes; prior to
       Postfix 2.5 the	default	 was  "postmaster".  To	 avoid	problems  with
       address probes that are sent in response to address probes, the Postfix
       SMTP server excludes the probe sender address  from  all	 SMTPD	access
       blocks.

       Specify	an  empty value (address_verify_sender =) or <> if you want to
       use the null sender address. Beware, some sites reject  mail  from  <>,
       even though RFCs require that such addresses be accepted.

       Examples:

       address_verify_sender = <>
       address_verify_sender = postmaster@my.domain

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_sender_dependent_default_transport_maps		     (default:
       $sender_dependent_default_transport_maps)
       Overrides the sender_dependent_default_transport_maps parameter setting
       for address verification probes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

address_verify_sender_dependent_relayhost_maps	   (default:	$sender_depen‐
       dent_relayhost_maps)
       Overrides the  sender_dependent_relayhost_maps  parameter  setting  for
       address verification probes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

address_verify_sender_ttl (default: 0s)
       The time between changes in the time-dependent portion of address veri‐
       fication probe sender addresses. The time-dependent portion is appended
       to  the	localpart  of  the  address  specified	with  the address_ver‐
       ify_sender parameter. This feature is ignored  when  the	 probe	sender
       addresses  is  the null sender, i.e. the address_verify_sender value is
       empty or <>.

       Historically, the probe sender address was fixed. This has caused  such
       addresses  to  end  up  on  spammer  mailing lists, and has resulted in
       wasted network and processing resources.

       To enable time-dependent probe sender  addresses,  specify  a  non-zero
       time  value  (an integral value plus an optional one-letter suffix that
       specifies the time unit).  Specify a value of at least  several	hours,
       to  avoid  problems  with senders that use greylisting.	Avoid nice TTL
       values, to make the result less predictable.  Time units are:  s	 (sec‐
       onds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

address_verify_service_name (default: verify)
       The  name  of  the verify(8) address verification service. This service
       maintains the status of sender and/or  recipient	 address  verification
       probes, and generates probes on request by other Postfix processes.

address_verify_transport_maps (default: $transport_maps)
       Overrides the transport_maps parameter setting for address verification
       probes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

address_verify_virtual_transport (default: $virtual_transport)
       Overrides the virtual_transport parameter setting for address verifica‐
       tion probes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

alias_database (default: see postconf -d output)
       The  alias  databases  for  local(8)  delivery  that  are  updated with
       "newaliases" or with "sendmail -bi".

       This is a separate configuration parameter because not all  the	tables
       specified with $alias_maps have to be local files.

       Examples:

       alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
       alias_database = hash:/etc/mail/aliases

alias_maps (default: see postconf -d output)
       The alias databases that are used for local(8) delivery. See aliases(5)
       for syntax details.

       The default list is system dependent.  On systems with NIS, the default
       is to search the local alias database, then the NIS alias database.

       If  you	change	the  alias  database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
       wherever your system  stores  the  mail	alias  file),  or  simply  run
       "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.

       The  local(8)  delivery agent disallows regular expression substitution
       of $1 etc. in alias_maps, because that would open a security hole.

       The local(8) delivery agent will silently ignore requests  to  use  the
       proxymap(8)  server  within  alias_maps. Instead it will open the table
       directly. Before Postfix version 2.2, the local(8) delivery agent  will
       terminate with a fatal error.

       Examples:

       alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
       alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases

allow_mail_to_commands (default: alias, forward)
       Restrict	 local(8)  mail delivery to external commands.	The default is
       to disallow delivery to "|command" in :include:	files (see  aliases(5)
       for the text that defines this terminology).

       Specify	zero  or more of: alias, forward or include, in order to allow
       commands in aliases(5), .forward files or in :include:  files,  respec‐
       tively.

       Example:

       allow_mail_to_commands = alias,forward,include

allow_mail_to_files (default: alias, forward)
       Restrict	 local(8)  mail	 delivery to external files. The default is to
       disallow "/file/name" destinations in :include:	files (see  aliases(5)
       for the text that defines this terminology).

       Specify	zero  or more of: alias, forward or include, in order to allow
       "/file/name"  destinations  in  aliases(5),  .forward  files   and   in
       :include:  files, respectively.

       Example:

       allow_mail_to_files = alias,forward,include

allow_min_user (default: no)
       Allow a sender or recipient address to have `-' as the first character.
       By default, this is not allowed, to avoid accidents with software  that
       passes email addresses via the command line. Such software would not be
       able to distinguish a malicious address from a bona  fide  command-line
       option.	Although this can be prevented by inserting a "--" option ter‐
       minator into the command line, this is  difficult  to  enforce  consis‐
       tently and globally.

       As  of  Postfix version 2.5, this feature is implemented by trivial-re‐
       write(8).  With	earlier	 versions  this	 feature  was  implemented  by
       qmgr(8) and was limited to recipient addresses only.

allow_percent_hack (default: yes)
       Enable  the rewriting of the form "user%domain" to "user@domain".  This
       is enabled by default.

       Note: with Postfix version 2.2, message header address  rewriting  hap‐
       pens only when one of the following conditions is true:

       ·      The message is received with the Postfix sendmail(1) command,

       ·      The  message  is	received  from	a  network client that matches
	      $local_header_rewrite_clients,

       ·      The  message   is	  received   from   the	  network,   and   the
	      remote_header_rewrite_domain  parameter  specifies  a  non-empty
	      value.

       To   get	  the	behavior   before   Postfix   version	2.2,   specify
       "local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all".

       Example:

       allow_percent_hack = no

allow_untrusted_routing (default: no)
       Forward	mail  with sender-specified routing (user[@%!]remote[@%!]site)
       from untrusted clients to destinations matching $relay_domains.

       By default, this feature is turned off.	This closes a nasty open relay
       loophole	 where	a  backup  MX host can be tricked into forwarding junk
       mail to a primary MX host which then spams it out to the world.

       This parameter also controls if non-local addresses with	 sender-speci‐
       fied  routing  can  match  Postfix  access  tables.  By	default,  such
       addresses cannot match Postfix access tables, because  the  address  is
       ambiguous.

alternate_config_directories (default: empty)
       A  list	of  non-default	 Postfix configuration directories that may be
       specified with "-c config_directory" on the command line,  or  via  the
       MAIL_CONFIG environment parameter.

       This list must be specified in the default Postfix configuration direc‐
       tory, and is used by set-gid Postfix commands such as postqueue(1)  and
       postdrop(1).

always_add_missing_headers (default: no)
       Always  add (Resent-) From:, To:, Date: or Message-ID: headers when not
       present.	 Postfix 2.6 and later add these  headers  only	 when  clients
       match  the  local_header_rewrite_clients	 parameter  setting.   Earlier
       Postfix versions always add these headers; this may break  DKIM	signa‐
       tures that cover non-existent headers.

always_bcc (default: empty)
       Optional	 address  that	receives a "blind carbon copy" of each message
       that is received by the Postfix mail system.

       Note: with Postfix 2.3 and later the BCC address is added as if it  was
       specified  with	NOTIFY=NONE.  The sender will not be notified when the
       BCC address is undeliverable,  as  long	as  all	 down-stream  software
       implements RFC 3461.

       Note: with Postfix 2.2 and earlier the sender will be notified when the
       BCC address is undeliverable.

       Note: automatic BCC recipients are produced  only  for  new  mail.   To
       avoid  mailer  loops,  automatic BCC recipients are not generated after
       Postfix forwards mail  internally,  or  after  Postfix  generates  mail
       itself.

anvil_rate_time_unit (default: 60s)
       The  time  unit	over which client connection rates and other rates are
       calculated.

       This feature is implemented by the anvil(8) service which is  available
       in Postfix version 2.2 and later.

       The default interval is relatively short. Because of the high frequency
       of updates, the anvil(8) server uses volatile memory only. Thus, infor‐
       mation is lost whenever the process terminates.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

anvil_status_update_time (default: 600s)
       How frequently the anvil(8) connection and rate	limiting  server  logs
       peak usage information.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

append_at_myorigin (default: yes)
       With locally submitted mail, append the	string	"@$myorigin"  to  mail
       addresses  without  domain  information.	 With remotely submitted mail,
       append the string "@$remote_header_rewrite_domain" instead.

       Note 1: this feature is enabled by default and must not be turned  off.
       Postfix does not support domain-less addresses.

       Note 2: with Postfix version 2.2, message header address rewriting hap‐
       pens only when one of the following conditions is true:

       ·      The message is received with the Postfix sendmail(1) command,

       ·      The message is received  from  a	network	 client	 that  matches
	      $local_header_rewrite_clients,

       ·      The   message   is   received   from   the   network,   and  the
	      remote_header_rewrite_domain  parameter  specifies  a  non-empty
	      value.

       To   get	  the	behavior   before   Postfix   version	2.2,   specify
       "local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all".

append_dot_mydomain (default: yes)
       With  locally  submitted	 mail,	append	the  string  ".$mydomain"   to
       addresses  that	have no ".domain" information. With remotely submitted
       mail, append the string ".$remote_header_rewrite_domain" instead.

       Note 1: this feature is enabled by default. If disabled, users will not
       be able to send mail to "user@partialdomainname" but will have to spec‐
       ify full domain names instead.

       Note 2: with Postfix version 2.2, message header address rewriting hap‐
       pens only when one of the following conditions is true:

       ·      The message is received with the Postfix sendmail(1) command,

       ·      The  message  is	received  from	a  network client that matches
	      $local_header_rewrite_clients,

       ·      The  message   is	  received   from   the	  network,   and   the
	      remote_header_rewrite_domain  parameter  specifies  a  non-empty
	      value.

       To   get	  the	behavior   before   Postfix   version	2.2,   specify
       "local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all".

application_event_drain_time (default: 100s)
       How long the postkick(1) command waits for a request to enter the Post‐
       fix daemon process input buffer before giving up.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

authorized_flush_users (default: static:anyone)
       List of users who are authorized to flush the queue.

       By default, all users are allowed to flush the queue.  Access is always
       granted if the invoking user is the super-user or the $mail_owner user.
       Otherwise, the real UID of the process is looked up in the system pass‐
       word file, and access is granted only if the corresponding  login  name
       is  on  the  access list.  The username "unknown" is used for processes
       whose real UID is not found in the password file.

       Specify a list of user names, "/file/name"  or  "type:table"  patterns,
       separated  by  commas  and/or  whitespace.  The list is matched left to
       right, and the search stops on the first match. A "/file/name"  pattern
       is  replaced  by	 its  contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched
       when a name matches a lookup key (the lookup result is ignored).	  Con‐
       tinue  long  lines  by  starting the next line with whitespace. Specify
       "!pattern" to exclude a name from the list. The form  "!/file/name"  is
       supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

authorized_mailq_users (default: static:anyone)
       List of users who are authorized to view the queue.

       By  default, all users are allowed to view the queue.  Access is always
       granted if the invoking user is the super-user or the $mail_owner user.
       Otherwise, the real UID of the process is looked up in the system pass‐
       word file, and access is granted only if the corresponding  login  name
       is  on  the  access list.  The username "unknown" is used for processes
       whose real UID is not found in the password file.

       Specify a list of user names, "/file/name"  or  "type:table"  patterns,
       separated  by  commas  and/or  whitespace.  The list is matched left to
       right, and the search stops on the first match. A "/file/name"  pattern
       is  replaced  by	 its  contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched
       when a name matches a lookup key (the lookup result is ignored).	  Con‐
       tinue  long  lines  by  starting the next line with whitespace. Specify
       "!pattern" to exclude a user name from the list. The form "!/file/name"
       is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

authorized_submit_users (default: static:anyone)
       List  of	 users	who are authorized to submit mail with the sendmail(1)
       command (and with the privileged postdrop(1) helper command).

       By default, all users are allowed to submit mail.  Otherwise, the  real
       UID of the process is looked up in the system password file, and access
       is granted only if the corresponding login name is on the access	 list.
       The  username  "unknown"	 is  used  for processes whose real UID is not
       found in the password file. To deny mail submission access to all users
       specify an empty list.

       Specify	a  list	 of user names, "/file/name" or "type:table" patterns,
       separated by commas and/or whitespace. The  list	 is  matched  left  to
       right,  and the search stops on the first match. A "/file/name" pattern
       is replaced by its contents; a "type:table"  lookup  table  is  matched
       when  a name matches a lookup key (the lookup result is ignored).  Con‐
       tinue long lines by starting the next  line  with  whitespace.  Specify
       "!pattern" to exclude a user name from the list. The form "!/file/name"
       is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Example:

       authorized_submit_users = !www, static:all

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

authorized_verp_clients (default: $mynetworks)
       What remote SMTP clients are allowed  to	 specify  the  XVERP  command.
       This  command  requests	that mail be delivered one recipient at a time
       with a per recipient return address.

       By default, only trusted clients are allowed to specify XVERP.

       This parameter was introduced with Postfix version 1.1.	 Postfix  ver‐
       sion  2.1  renamed  this parameter to smtpd_authorized_verp_clients and
       changed the default to none.

       Specify a list of network/netmask patterns, separated by commas	and/or
       whitespace.  The	 mask specifies the number of bits in the network part
       of a host address. You can also specify hostnames or .domain names (the
       initial	 dot   causes	the  domain  to	 match	any  name  below  it),
       "/file/name" or	"type:table"  patterns.	  A  "/file/name"  pattern  is
       replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched when a
       table entry matches a lookup string (the	 lookup	 result	 is  ignored).
       Continue	 long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Specify
       "!pattern" to exclude an address or network block from  the  list.  The
       form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Note:  IP  version 6 address information must be specified inside [] in
       the  authorized_verp_clients  value,  and  in  files   specified	  with
       "/file/name".   IP  version  6 addresses contain the ":" character, and
       would otherwise be confused with a "type:table" pattern.

backwards_bounce_logfile_compatibility (default: yes)
       Produce additional bounce(8) logfile records that can be read by	 Post‐
       fix versions before 2.0. The current and more extensible "name = value"
       format is needed in order to implement more  sophisticated  functional‐
       ity.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

berkeley_db_create_buffer_size (default: 16777216)
       The per-table I/O buffer size for programs that create Berkeley DB hash
       or btree tables.	 Specify a byte count.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

berkeley_db_read_buffer_size (default: 131072)
       The per-table I/O buffer size for programs that read Berkeley  DB  hash
       or btree tables.	 Specify a byte count.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

best_mx_transport (default: empty)
       Where  the  Postfix  SMTP  client should deliver mail when it detects a
       "mail loops back to myself" error  condition.  This  happens  when  the
       local  MTA is the best SMTP mail exchanger for a destination not listed
       in   $mydestination,   $inet_interfaces,	   $proxy_interfaces,	 $vir‐
       tual_alias_domains, or $virtual_mailbox_domains.	 By default, the Post‐
       fix SMTP client returns such mail as undeliverable.

       Specify, for example, "best_mx_transport = local" to pass the mail from
       the Postfix SMTP client to the local(8) delivery agent. You can specify
       any message delivery "transport" or "transport:nexthop" that is defined
       in  the master.cf file. See the transport(5) manual page for the syntax
       and meaning of "transport" or "transport:nexthop".

       However, this feature is expensive because it ties up  a	 Postfix  SMTP
       client  process while the local(8) delivery agent is doing its work. It
       is more efficient (for Postfix) to list all hosted domains in  a	 table
       or database.

biff (default: yes)
       Whether	or not to use the local biff service.  This service sends "new
       mail" notifications to users who have requested new  mail  notification
       with the UNIX command "biff y".

       For  compatibility  reasons  this feature is on by default.  On systems
       with lots of interactive users, the biff service can be	a  performance
       drain.  Specify "biff = no" in main.cf to disable.

body_checks (default: empty)
       Optional	 lookup	 tables	 for  content  inspection  as specified in the
       body_checks(5) manual page.

       Note: with Postfix versions before 2.0, these rules inspect all content
       after the primary message headers.

body_checks_size_limit (default: 51200)
       How  much  text in a message body segment (or attachment, if you prefer
       to use that term) is subjected to body_checks inspection.   The	amount
       of text is limited to avoid scanning huge attachments.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

bounce_notice_recipient (default: postmaster)
       The  recipient  of postmaster notifications with the message headers of
       mail that Postfix did not deliver and of SMTP conversation  transcripts
       of mail that Postfix did not receive.  This feature is enabled with the
       notify_classes parameter.

bounce_queue_lifetime (default: 5d)
       Consider a bounce message as undeliverable, when delivery fails with  a
       temporary   error,   and	  the  time  in	 the  queue  has  reached  the
       bounce_queue_lifetime limit.  By default, this limit is the same as for
       regular mail.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is d (days).

       Specify 0 when mail delivery should be tried only once.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

bounce_service_name (default: bounce)
       The name of the bounce(8) service. This service maintains a  record  of
       failed delivery attempts and generates non-delivery notifications.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

bounce_size_limit (default: 50000)
       The  maximal  amount  of	 original  message text that is sent in a non-
       delivery notification. Specify a byte count.  A message is returned  as
       either message/rfc822 (the complete original) or as text/rfc822-headers
       (the headers only).  With Postfix version 2.4 and earlier, a message is
       always  returned as message/rfc822 and is truncated when it exceeds the
       size limit.

       Notes:

       ·      If you  increase	this  limit,  then  you	 should	 increase  the
	      mime_nesting_limit value proportionally.

       ·      Be  careful  when making changes.	 Excessively large values will
	      result in the loss of non-delivery notifications, when a	bounce
	      message size exceeds a local or remote MTA's message size limit.

bounce_template_file (default: empty)
       Pathname	 of a configuration file with bounce message templates.	 These
       override the built-in templates of delivery status  notification	 (DSN)
       messages for undeliverable mail, for delayed mail, successful delivery,
       or delivery verification. The bounce(5) manual page  describes  how  to
       edit and test template files.

       Template message body text may contain $name references to Postfix con‐
       figuration parameters. The result of $name expansion can	 be  previewed
       with "postconf -b file_name" before the file is placed into the Postfix
       configuration directory.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

broken_sasl_auth_clients (default: no)
       Enable inter-operability with remote SMTP  clients  that	 implement  an
       obsolete	 version  of  the  AUTH	 command  (RFC 4954). Examples of such
       clients are MicroSoft Outlook Express version 4 and MicroSoft  Exchange
       version 5.0.

       Specify "broken_sasl_auth_clients = yes" to have Postfix advertise AUTH
       support in a non-standard way.

canonical_classes     (default:	     envelope_sender,	   envelope_recipient,
       header_sender, header_recipient)
       What  addresses	are  subject  to  canonical_maps  address mapping.  By
       default, canonical_maps address mapping is applied to  envelope	sender
       and  recipient  addresses,  and	to  header sender and header recipient
       addresses.

       Specify	one   or   more	  of:	envelope_sender,   envelope_recipient,
       header_sender, header_recipient

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

canonical_maps (default: empty)
       Optional	  address  mapping  lookup  tables  for	 message  headers  and
       envelopes.  The	mapping	 is  applied  to  both	sender	and  recipient
       addresses,  in  both  envelopes	and in headers, as controlled with the
       canonical_classes parameter. This is typically used to clean  up	 dirty
       addresses from legacy mail systems, or to replace login names by First‐
       name.Lastname.  The table format and lookups are documented in  canoni‐
       cal(5).	For  an	 overview  of  Postfix	address	 manipulations see the
       ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.

       If you use this feature, run "postmap /etc/postfix/canonical" to	 build
       the  necessary  DBM  or	DB  file  after every change. The changes will
       become visible after a minute or so.  Use "postfix reload" to eliminate
       the delay.

       Note:  with Postfix version 2.2, message header address mapping happens
       only when message header address rewriting is enabled:

       ·      The message is received with the Postfix sendmail(1) command,

       ·      The message is received  from  a	network	 client	 that  matches
	      $local_header_rewrite_clients,

       ·      The   message   is   received   from   the   network,   and  the
	      remote_header_rewrite_domain  parameter  specifies  a  non-empty
	      value.

       To   get	  the	behavior   before   Postfix   version	2.2,   specify
       "local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all".

       Examples:

       canonical_maps = dbm:/etc/postfix/canonical
       canonical_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/canonical

cleanup_service_name (default: cleanup)
       The name of the cleanup(8) service.  This  service  rewrites  addresses
       into  the  standard form, and performs canonical(5) address mapping and
       virtual(5) aliasing.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

command_directory (default: see postconf -d output)
       The location of all postfix administrative commands.

command_execution_directory (default: empty)
       The local(8) delivery agent working directory for delivery to  external
       command.	  Failure  to  change  directory  causes  the  delivery	 to be
       deferred.

       The following $name expansions are done on  command_execution_directory
       before  the  directory  is changed. Expansion happens in the context of
       the delivery request.  The result of $name expansion is	filtered  with
       the character set that is specified with the execution_directory_expan‐
       sion_filter parameter.

       $user  The recipient's username.

       $shell The recipient's login shell pathname.

       $home  The recipient's home directory.

       $recipient
	      The full recipient address.

       $extension
	      The optional recipient address extension.

       $domain
	      The recipient domain.

       $local The entire recipient localpart.

       $recipient_delimiter
	      The system-wide recipient address extension delimiter.

       ${name?value}
	      Expands to value when $name is non-empty.

       ${name:value}
	      Expands to value when $name is empty.

       Instead of $name you can also specify ${name} or $(name).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

command_expansion_filter (default: see postconf -d output)
       Restrict the characters that the	 local(8)  delivery  agent  allows  in
       $name  expansions of $mailbox_command and $command_execution_directory.
       Characters outside the allowed set are replaced by underscores.

command_time_limit (default: 1000s)
       Time limit for delivery to external commands. This limit is used by the
       local(8)	 delivery agent, and is the default time limit for delivery by
       the pipe(8) delivery agent.

       Note: if you set this time limit to a large value you must  update  the
       global ipc_timeout parameter as well.

config_directory (default: see postconf -d output)
       The default location of the Postfix main.cf and master.cf configuration
       files. This can be overruled via the following mechanisms:

       ·      The MAIL_CONFIG environment variable (daemon processes and  com‐
	      mands).

       ·      The "-c" command-line option (commands only).

       With  Postfix command that run with set-gid privileges, a config_direc‐
       tory override requires either root privileges, or it requires that  the
       directory  is listed with the alternate_config_directories parameter in
       the default main.cf file.

connection_cache_protocol_timeout (default: 5s)
       Time limit for connection cache connect, send  or  receive  operations.
       The time limit is enforced in the client.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

connection_cache_service_name (default: scache)
       The name of the scache(8) connection cache service.  This service main‐
       tains a limited pool of cached sessions.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

connection_cache_status_update_time (default: 600s)
       How frequently the scache(8) server logs usage statistics with  connec‐
       tion cache hit and miss rates for logical destinations and for physical
       endpoints.

connection_cache_ttl_limit (default: 2s)
       The maximal time-to-live value  that  the  scache(8)  connection	 cache
       server  allows.	Requests that specify a larger TTL will be stored with
       the maximum allowed TTL. The purpose of this additional control	is  to
       protect	the  infrastructure  against careless people. The cache TTL is
       already bounded by $max_idle.

content_filter (default: empty)
       After the message is queued, send the entire message to	the  specified
       transport:destination.  The transport name specifies the first field of
       a mail delivery agent definition in master.cf; the syntax of the	 next-
       hop  destination	 is  described in the manual page of the corresponding
       delivery agent.	More information about external content filters is  in
       the Postfix FILTER_README file.

       Notes:

       ·      This  setting  has lower precedence than a FILTER action that is
	      specified in an access(5),  header_checks(5)  or	body_checks(5)
	      table.

       ·      The  meaning  of an empty next-hop filter destination is version
	      dependent.  Postfix 2.7 and later will use the recipient domain;
	      earlier  versions	 will  use $myhostname.	 Specify "default_fil‐
	      ter_nexthop = $myhostname" for compatibility with Postfix 2.6 or
	      earlier,	or  specify  a	content_filter	value with an explicit
	      next-hop destination.

cyrus_sasl_config_path (default: empty)
       Search path for Cyrus SASL application configuration  files,  currently
       used  only  to  locate the $smtpd_sasl_path.conf file.  Specify zero or
       more directories separated by a colon character, or an empty  value  to
       use Cyrus SASL's built-in search path.

       This  feature  is available in Postfix 2.5 and later when compiled with
       Cyrus SASL 2.1.22 or later.

daemon_directory (default: see postconf -d output)
       The directory with Postfix support programs and daemon programs.	 These
       should  not  be invoked directly by humans. The directory must be owned
       by root.

daemon_table_open_error_is_fatal (default: no)
       How a Postfix  daemon  process  handles	errors	while  opening	lookup
       tables: gradual degradation or immediate termination.

	no  (default)
	      Gradual  degradation:  a	daemon	process logs a message of type
	      "error" and continues execution with reduced functionality. Fea‐
	      tures that do not depend on the unavailable table will work nor‐
	      mally, while features that depend on the table will result in  a
	      type "warning" message.
	      When  the	 notify_classes	 parameter  value  contains the "data"
	      class, the Postfix SMTP server  and  client  will	 report	 tran‐
	      scripts  of  sessions  with an error because a table is unavail‐
	      able.

	yes  (historical behavior)
	      Immediate termination: a daemon process logs a type "fatal" mes‐
	      sage and terminates immediately.	This option reduces the number
	      of possible code paths through Postfix,  and  may	 therefore  be
	      slightly more secure than the default.

       For  the sake of sanity, the number of type "error" messages is limited
       to 13 over the lifetime of a daemon process.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

daemon_timeout (default: 18000s)
       How much time a Postfix daemon process may take	to  handle  a  request
       before it is terminated by a built-in watchdog timer.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

data_directory (default: see postconf -d output)
       The directory with Postfix-writable data files  (for  example:  caches,
       pseudo-random numbers).	This directory must be owned by the mail_owner
       account, and must not be shared with non-Postfix software.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

debug_peer_level (default: 2)
       The increment in verbose logging level when a remote client  or	server
       matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.

debug_peer_list (default: empty)
       Optional	 list  of  remote client or server hostname or network address
       patterns that cause the verbose logging level to increase by the amount
       specified in $debug_peer_level.

       Specify	domain	names, network/netmask patterns, "/file/name" patterns
       or  "type:table"	 lookup	 tables.  The  right-hand  side	 result	  from
       "type:table" lookups is ignored.

       Pattern	 matching   of	 domain	  names	 is  controlled	 by  the  par‐
       ent_domain_matches_subdomains parameter.

       Examples:

       debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
       debug_peer_list = example.com

debugger_command (default: empty)
       The external command to	execute	 when  a  Postfix  daemon  program  is
       invoked with the -D option.

       Use  "command  .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before the
       process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to  set  up
       your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.

       Note: the command is subject to $name expansion, before it is passed to
       the default commmand interpreter. Specify "$$" to produce a single  "$"
       character.

       Example:

       debugger_command =
	   PATH=/usr/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
	   ddd $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5

default_database_type (default: see postconf -d output)
       The  default  database  type for use in newaliases(1), postalias(1) and
       postmap(1) commands. On many UNIX systems the default  type  is	either
       dbm  or	hash. The default setting is frozen when the Postfix system is
       built.

       Examples:

       default_database_type = hash
       default_database_type = dbm

default_delivery_slot_cost (default: 5)
       How often the Postfix queue manager's scheduler is allowed  to  preempt
       delivery of one message with another.

       Each  transport maintains a so-called "available delivery slot counter"
       for each message. One message can be preempted by another one when  the
       other  message  can  be	delivered  using no more delivery slots (i.e.,
       invocations of delivery agents) than the current	 message  counter  has
       accumulated  (or	 will  eventually  accumulate  -  see about slot loans
       below). This parameter controls how often is the counter incremented  -
       it  happens  after each default_delivery_slot_cost recipients have been
       delivered.

       The cost of 0 is used to disable the preempting scheduling  completely.
       The minimum value the scheduling algorithm can use is 2 - use it if you
       want to maximize the message throughput rate. Although there is no max‐
       imum, it doesn't make much sense to use values above say 50.

       The  only  reason why the value of 2 is not the default is the way this
       parameter affects the delivery of mailing-list mail. In the worst case,
       their   delivery	  can	take   somewhere   between  (cost+1/cost)  and
       (cost/cost-1) times more than if the preemptive scheduler was disabled.
       The default value of 5 turns out to provide reasonable message response
       times while making sure the mailing-list deliveries are not extended by
       more than 20-25 percent even in the worst case.

       Use  transport_delivery_slot_cost to specify a transport-specific over‐
       ride, where transport is the master.cf name  of	the  message  delivery
       transport.

       Examples:

       default_delivery_slot_cost = 0
       default_delivery_slot_cost = 2

default_delivery_slot_discount (default: 50)
       The  default  value for transport-specific _delivery_slot_discount set‐
       tings.

       This parameter speeds up the moment when a message preemption can  hap‐
       pen.  Instead  of  waiting  until  the  full  amount  of delivery slots
       required is available, the preemption can happen when  transport_deliv‐
       ery_slot_discount  percent of the required amount plus transport_deliv‐
       ery_slot_loan still remains to be  accumulated.	 Note  that  the  full
       amount  will still have to be accumulated before another preemption can
       take place later.

       Use transport_delivery_slot_discount to	specify	 a  transport-specific
       override, where transport is the master.cf name of the message delivery
       transport.

default_delivery_slot_loan (default: 3)
       The default value for transport-specific _delivery_slot_loan settings.

       This parameter speeds up the moment when a message preemption can  hap‐
       pen.  Instead  of  waiting  until  the  full  amount  of delivery slots
       required is available, the preemption can happen when  transport_deliv‐
       ery_slot_discount  percent of the required amount plus transport_deliv‐
       ery_slot_loan still remains to be  accumulated.	 Note  that  the  full
       amount  will still have to be accumulated before another preemption can
       take place later.

       Use transport_delivery_slot_loan to specify a transport-specific	 over‐
       ride,  where  transport	is  the master.cf name of the message delivery
       transport.

default_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit (default: 1)
       How many pseudo-cohorts must suffer  connection	or  handshake  failure
       before  a  specific  destination is considered unavailable (and further
       delivery is suspended). Specify zero to disable this feature. A	desti‐
       nation's pseudo-cohort failure count is reset each time a delivery com‐
       pletes without connection or handshake failure for that specific desti‐
       nation.

       A  pseudo-cohort	 is  the number of deliveries equal to a destination's
       delivery concurrency.

       Use transport_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit to specify  a
       transport-specific  override,  where transport is the master.cf name of
       the message delivery transport.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5. The default setting  is  com‐
       patible with earlier Postfix versions.

default_destination_concurrency_limit (default: 20)
       The  default maximal number of parallel deliveries to the same destina‐
       tion.  This is the default limit for delivery via the lmtp(8), pipe(8),
       smtp(8) and virtual(8) delivery agents.	With per-destination recipient
       limit > 1, a destination is a domain, otherwise it is a recipient.

       Use transport_destination_concurrency_limit to specify a transport-spe‐
       cific  override,	 where	transport is the master.cf name of the message
       delivery transport.

default_destination_concurrency_negative_feedback (default: 1)
       The per-destination amount of delivery concurrency  negative  feedback,
       after  a	 delivery  completes  with  a connection or handshake failure.
       Feedback values are in the range 0..1 inclusive.	 With  negative	 feed‐
       back,  concurrency  is  decremented  at	the beginning of a sequence of
       length 1/feedback. This is unlike positive feedback, where  concurrency
       is incremented at the end of a sequence of length 1/feedback.

       As  of  Postfix	version	 2.5, negative feedback cannot reduce delivery
       concurrency to zero.  Instead, a destination is	marked	dead  (further
       delivery	 suspended)  after  the	 failed	 pseudo-cohort	count  reaches
       $default_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit    (or     $trans‐
       port_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit).   To make the sched‐
       uler completely immune to connection or handshake failures,  specify  a
       zero feedback value and a zero failed pseudo-cohort limit.

       Specify one of the following forms:

       number

       number / number
	      Constant	feedback.  The	value must be in the range 0..1 inclu‐
	      sive.  The default setting of "1"	 is  compatible	 with  Postfix
	      versions	before 2.5, where a destination's delivery concurrency
	      is throttled down to zero (and further delivery suspended) after
	      a single failed pseudo-cohort.

       number / concurrency
	      Variable	feedback  of  "number  / (delivery concurrency)".  The
	      number must be in the range 0..1 inclusive. With number equal to
	      "1",  a  destination's  delivery concurrency is decremented by 1
	      after each failed pseudo-cohort.

       A pseudo-cohort is the number of deliveries equal  to  a	 destination's
       delivery concurrency.

       Use  transport_destination_concurrency_negative_feedback	 to  specify a
       transport-specific override, where transport is the master.cf  name  of
       the message delivery transport.

       This  feature  is available in Postfix 2.5. The default setting is com‐
       patible with earlier Postfix versions.

default_destination_concurrency_positive_feedback (default: 1)
       The per-destination amount of delivery concurrency  positive  feedback,
       after  a	 delivery  completes  without connection or handshake failure.
       Feedback values are in  the  range  0..1	 inclusive.   The  concurrency
       increases  until	 it  reaches  the  per-destination maximal concurrency
       limit. With positive feedback, concurrency is incremented at the end of
       a  sequence  with  length 1/feedback. This is unlike negative feedback,
       where concurrency is decremented at the start of a sequence  of	length
       1/feedback.

       Specify one of the following forms:

       number

       number / number
	      Constant	feedback.   The value must be in the range 0..1 inclu‐
	      sive. The default setting of "1" is compatible with Postfix ver‐
	      sions  before  2.5,  where  a destination's delivery concurrency
	      doubles after each successful pseudo-cohort.

       number / concurrency
	      Variable feedback of "number  /  (delivery  concurrency)".   The
	      number must be in the range 0..1 inclusive. With number equal to
	      "1", a destination's delivery concurrency is  incremented	 by  1
	      after each successful pseudo-cohort.

       A  pseudo-cohort	 is  the number of deliveries equal to a destination's
       delivery concurrency.

       Use transport_destination_concurrency_positive_feedback	to  specify  a
       transport-specific  override,  where transport is the master.cf name of
       the message delivery transport.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

default_destination_rate_delay (default: 0s)
       The default amount of delay that is inserted between individual	deliv‐
       eries  to  the  same destination; the resulting behavior depends on the
       value of the corresponding per-destination recipient limit.

       ·      With a corresponding per-destination recipient limit  >  1,  the
	      rate  delay  specifies  the  time between deliveries to the same
	      domain.  Different domains are delivered in parallel, subject to
	      the process limits specified in master.cf.

       ·      With a corresponding per-destination recipient limit equal to 1,
	      the rate delay specifies the time between deliveries to the same
	      recipient.  Different recipients are delivered in parallel, sub‐
	      ject to the process limits specified in master.cf.

       To enable the delay, specify a non-zero time value (an  integral	 value
       plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the time unit).

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

       NOTE: the delay is enforced by the queue manager. The delay timer state
       does not survive "postfix reload" or "postfix stop".

       Use  transport_destination_rate_delay  to  specify a transport-specific
       override, where transport is the master.cf name of the message delivery
       transport.

       NOTE: with a non-zero _destination_rate_delay, specify a transport_des‐
       tination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit of 10 or more to prevent Post‐
       fix  from  deferring  all  mail for the same destination after only one
       connection or handshake error.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

default_destination_recipient_limit (default: 50)
       The default maximal number of recipients per message delivery.  This is
       the  default  limit  for delivery via the lmtp(8), pipe(8), smtp(8) and
       virtual(8) delivery agents.

       Setting this parameter to a value of 1 affects email deliveries as fol‐
       lows:

       ·      It changes the meaning of the corresponding per-destination con‐
	      currency limit, from  concurrency	 of  deliveries	 to  the  same
	      domain  into  concurrency	 of  deliveries to the same recipient.
	      Different recipients are delivered in parallel, subject  to  the
	      process limits specified in master.cf.

       ·      It changes the meaning of the corresponding per-destination rate
	      delay, from the delay between deliveries to the same domain into
	      the delay between deliveries to the same recipient.  Again, dif‐
	      ferent recipients are delivered  in  parallel,  subject  to  the
	      process limits specified in master.cf.

       ·      It  changes  the	meaning of other corresponding per-destination
	      settings in a similar manner, from settings for delivery to  the
	      same domain into settings for delivery to the same recipient.

       Use  transport_destination_recipient_limit  to specify a transport-spe‐
       cific override, where transport is the master.cf name  of  the  message
       delivery transport.

default_extra_recipient_limit (default: 1000)
       The default value for the extra per-transport limit imposed on the num‐
       ber of in-memory recipients.  This extra recipient  space  is  reserved
       for  the	 cases when the Postfix queue manager's scheduler preempts one
       message with another and suddenly needs some extra recipients slots for
       the chosen message in order to avoid performance degradation.

       Use  transport_extra_recipient_limit  to	 specify  a transport-specific
       override, where transport is the master.cf name of the message delivery
       transport.

default_filter_nexthop (default: empty)
       When  a content_filter or FILTER request specifies no explicit next-hop
       destination, use $default_filter_nexthop instead; when  that  value  is
       empty,  use the domain in the recipient address.	 Specify "default_fil‐
       ter_nexthop = $myhostname" for compatibility with Postfix  version  2.6
       and earlier, or specify an explicit next-hop destination with each con‐
       tent_filter value or FILTER action.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

default_minimum_delivery_slots (default: 3)
       How many recipients a message must have in order to invoke the  Postfix
       queue  manager's	 scheduling  algorithm	at  all.  Messages which would
       never accumulate at least this many delivery  slots  (subject  to  slot
       cost parameter as well) are never preempted.

       Use  transport_minimum_delivery_slots  to  specify a transport-specific
       override, where transport is the master.cf name of the message delivery
       transport.

default_privs (default: nobody)
       The  default rights used by the local(8) delivery agent for delivery to
       external file or command.  These	 rights	 are  used  when  delivery  is
       requested from an aliases(5) file that is owned by root, or when deliv‐
       ery is done on behalf of root. DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR  THE
       POSTFIX OWNER.

default_process_limit (default: 100)
       The  default  maximal  number of Postfix child processes that provide a
       given service. This limit can be overruled for specific services in the
       master.cf file.

default_rbl_reply (default: see postconf -d output)
       The default Postfix SMTP server response template for a request that is
       rejected by an RBL-based restriction. This template can be overruled by
       specific entries in the optional rbl_reply_maps lookup table.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

       The template is subject to exactly one level of $name substitution:

       $client
	      The client hostname and IP address, formatted as name[address].

       $client_address
	      The client IP address.

       $client_name
	      The	client	     hostname	   or	   "unknown".	   See
	      reject_unknown_client_hostname for more details.

       $reverse_client_name
	      The client hostname from	address->name  lookup,	or  "unknown".
	      See reject_unknown_reverse_client_hostname for more details.

       $helo_name
	      The hostname given in HELO or EHLO command or empty string.

       $rbl_class
	      The  blacklisted	entity type: Client host, Helo command, Sender
	      address, or Recipient address.

       $rbl_code
	      The  numerical  SMTP  response  code,  as	 specified  with   the
	      maps_rbl_reject_code  configuration parameter. Note: The numeri‐
	      cal SMTP response code is required, and must appear at the start
	      of  the  reply. With Postfix version 2.3 and later this informa‐
	      tion may be followed by an RFC 3463 enhanced status code.

       $rbl_domain
	      The RBL domain where $rbl_what is blacklisted.

       $rbl_reason
	      The reason why $rbl_what is blacklisted, or an empty string.

       $rbl_what
	      The entity that is blacklisted (an IP  address,  a  hostname,  a
	      domain name, or an email address whose domain was blacklisted).

       $recipient
	      The recipient address or <> in case of the null address.

       $recipient_domain
	      The recipient domain or empty string.

       $recipient_name
	      The recipient address localpart or <> in case of null address.

       $sender
	      The sender address or <> in case of the null address.

       $sender_domain
	      The sender domain or empty string.

       $sender_name
	      The sender address localpart or <> in case of the null address.

       ${name?text}
	      Expands to `text' if $name is not empty.

       ${name:text}
	      Expands to `text' if $name is empty.

       Instead of $name you can also specify ${name} or $(name).

       Note:  when  an	enhanced status code is specified in an RBL reply tem‐
       plate, it is subject to modification.   The  following  transformations
       are  needed  when the same RBL reply template is used for client, helo,
       sender, or recipient access restrictions.

       ·      When rejecting a sender address, the Postfix  SMTP  server  will
	      transform	 a  recipient  DSN status (e.g., 4.1.1-4.1.6) into the
	      corresponding sender DSN status, and vice versa.

       ·      When rejecting non-address information (such as the HELO command
	      argument	or  the	 client	 hostname/address),  the  Postfix SMTP
	      server will transform a sender or recipient DSN  status  into  a
	      generic non-address DSN status (e.g., 4.0.0).

default_recipient_limit (default: 20000)
       The default per-transport upper limit on the number of in-memory recip‐
       ients.  These limits take priority over the global qmgr_message_recipi‐
       ent_limit  after the message has been assigned to the respective trans‐
       ports.  See also default_extra_recipient_limit and qmgr_message_recipi‐
       ent_minimum.

       Use transport_recipient_limit to specify a transport-specific override,
       where transport is the master.cf name of the  message  delivery	trans‐
       port.

default_recipient_refill_delay (default: 5s)
       The  default  per-transport  maximum  delay between recipients refills.
       When not all message recipients fit into the memory at once, keep load‐
       ing  more  of them at least once every this many seconds.  This is used
       to make sure the recipients are refilled in  timely  manner  even  when
       $default_recipient_refill_limit is too high for too slow deliveries.

       Use  transport_recipient_refill_delay  to  specify a transport-specific
       override, where transport is the master.cf name of the message delivery
       transport.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later.

default_recipient_refill_limit (default: 100)
       The default per-transport limit on the number of recipients refilled at
       once.  When not all message recipients fit into	the  memory  at	 once,
       keep  loading  more of them in batches of at least this many at a time.
       See also $default_recipient_refill_delay, which may result in recipient
       batches lower than this when this limit is too high for too slow deliv‐
       eries.

       Use transport_recipient_refill_limit to	specify	 a  transport-specific
       override, where transport is the master.cf name of the message delivery
       transport.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later.

default_transport (default: smtp)
       The default mail delivery transport and next-hop destination for desti‐
       nations	 that	do   not   match   $mydestination,   $inet_interfaces,
       $proxy_interfaces, $virtual_alias_domains, $virtual_mailbox_domains, or
       $relay_domains.	  This	 information   can   be	  overruled  with  the
       sender_dependent_default_transport_maps parameter and with  the	trans‐
       port(5) table.

       In  order  of  decreasing  precedence, the nexthop destination is taken
       from   $sender_dependent_default_transport_maps,	   $default_transport,
       $sender_dependent_relayhost_maps,  $relayhost,  or  from	 the recipient
       domain.

       Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is  the
       name  of	 a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf.  The :nexthop
       destination is optional; its syntax is documented in the manual page of
       the corresponding delivery agent.

       Example:

       default_transport = uucp:relayhostname

default_verp_delimiters (default: +=)
       The  two	 default  VERP	delimiter  characters.	These are used when no
       explicit delimiters are specified with the SMTP XVERP command  or  with
       the  "sendmail  -V"  command-line  option.  Specify characters that are
       allowed by the verp_delimiter_filter setting.

       This feature is available in Postfix 1.1 and later.

defer_code (default: 450)
       The numerical Postfix SMTP server response  code	 when  a  remote  SMTP
       client request is rejected by the "defer" restriction.

       Do  not	change	this  unless  you have a complete understanding of RFC
       5321.

defer_service_name (default: defer)
       The name of the defer service.  This  service  is  implemented  by  the
       bounce(8) daemon and maintains a record of failed delivery attempts and
       generates non-delivery notifications.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

defer_transports (default: empty)
       The names of message delivery transports that should not	 deliver  mail
       unless someone issues "sendmail -q" or equivalent. Specify zero or more
       names of mail delivery transports names that appear in the first	 field
       of master.cf.

       Example:

       defer_transports = smtp

delay_logging_resolution_limit (default: 2)
       The  maximal number of digits after the decimal point when logging sub-
       second delay values.  Specify a number in the range 0..6.

       Large delay values are rounded off to an integral number seconds; delay
       values  below the delay_logging_resolution_limit are logged as "0", and
       small delay values are logged with at most two-digit precision.

       The format of the "delays=a/b/c/d" logging is as follows:

       ·      a = time from message arrival to last active queue entry

       ·      b = time from last active queue entry to connection setup

       ·      c = time in connection setup, including DNS, EHLO and STARTTLS

       ·      d = time in message transmission

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

delay_notice_recipient (default: postmaster)
       The recipient of postmaster notifications with the message  headers  of
       mail that cannot be delivered within $delay_warning_time time units.

       See also: delay_warning_time, notify_classes.

delay_warning_time (default: 0h)
       The  time after which the sender receives a copy of the message headers
       of mail that is still queued.

       To enable this feature, specify a  non-zero  time  value	 (an  integral
       value plus an optional one-letter suffix that specifies the time unit).

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is h (hours).

       See also: delay_notice_recipient, notify_classes.

deliver_lock_attempts (default: 20)
       The maximal number of attempts to acquire an exclusive lock on a	 mail‐
       box file or bounce(8) logfile.

deliver_lock_delay (default: 1s)
       The  time  between  attempts  to acquire an exclusive lock on a mailbox
       file or bounce(8) logfile.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

destination_concurrency_feedback_debug (default: no)
       Make  the  queue	 manager's  feedback algorithm verbose for performance
       analysis purposes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

detect_8bit_encoding_header (default: yes)
       Automatically detect 8BITMIME body content by looking at Content-Trans‐
       fer-Encoding:  message  headers;	 historically, this behavior was hard-
       coded to be "always on".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

disable_dns_lookups (default: no)
       Disable DNS lookups in the Postfix SMTP and  LMTP  clients.  When  dis‐
       abled,  hosts  are looked up with the getaddrinfo() system library rou‐
       tine which normally also looks in /etc/hosts.

       DNS lookups are enabled by default.

disable_mime_input_processing (default: no)
       Turn off MIME processing while receiving mail. This means that no  spe‐
       cial  treatment is given to Content-Type: message headers, and that all
       text after the initial message headers is considered to be part of  the
       message body.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

       Mime  input processing is enabled by default, and is needed in order to
       recognize MIME headers in message content.

disable_mime_output_conversion (default: no)
       Disable the conversion of 8BITMIME format to 7BIT format.  Mime	output
       conversion  is  needed when the destination does not advertise 8BITMIME
       support.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

disable_verp_bounces (default: no)
       Disable sending one bounce report per recipient.

       The default, one per recipient, is what ezmlm needs.

       This feature is available in Postfix 1.1 and later.

disable_vrfy_command (default: no)
       Disable the SMTP VRFY command. This stops some techniques used to  har‐
       vest email addresses.

       Example:

       disable_vrfy_command = no

dnsblog_reply_delay (default: 0s)
       A debugging aid to artificially delay DNS responses.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

dnsblog_service_name (default: dnsblog)
       The  name  of  the  dnsblog(8) service entry in master.cf. This service
       performs DNS white/blacklist lookups.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

dont_remove (default: 0)
       Don't remove queue files and save them to the "saved" mail queue.  This
       is a debugging aid.  To inspect the envelope information and content of
       a Postfix queue file, use the postcat(1) command.

double_bounce_sender (default: double-bounce)
       The sender address of postmaster notifications that  are	 generated  by
       the  mail  system.  All	mail to this address is silently discarded, in
       order to terminate mail bounce loops.

duplicate_filter_limit (default: 1000)
       The maximal number of addresses remembered  by  the  address  duplicate
       filter  for  aliases(5)	or virtual(5) alias expansion, or for showq(8)
       queue displays.

empty_address_default_transport_maps_lookup_key (default: <;>)
       The sender_dependent_default_transport_maps search string that will  be
       used instead of the null sender address.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

empty_address_recipient (default: MAILER-DAEMON)
       The  recipient of mail addressed to the null address.  Postfix does not
       accept such addresses in SMTP commands, but they may still  be  created
       locally as the result of configuration or software error.

empty_address_relayhost_maps_lookup_key (default: <;>)
       The  sender_dependent_relayhost_maps  search  string  that will be used
       instead of the null sender address.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later. With	 earlier  ver‐
       sions,  sender_dependent_relayhost_maps	lookups	 were  skipped for the
       null sender address.

enable_errors_to (default: no)
       Report mail delivery errors to the address specified with the non-stan‐
       dard  Errors-To: message header, instead of the envelope sender address
       (this feature is removed with Postfix version 2.2,  is  turned  off  by
       default	with  Postfix  version 2.1, and is always turned on with older
       Postfix versions).

enable_long_queue_ids (default: no)
       Enable long, non-repeating, queue IDs (queue file names).  The  benefit
       of  non-repeating  names	 is  simpler logfile analysis and easier queue
       migration (there is no need to run "postsuper"  to  change  queue  file
       names that don't match their message file inode number).

       Note:  see below for how to prepare long queue file names for migration
       to Postfix <= 2.8.

       Changing the parameter value to "yes" has the following effects:

       ·      Existing queue file names are not affected.

       ·      New queue files are created with names such as  3Pt2mN2VXxznjll.
	      These  are encoded in a 52-character alphabet that contains dig‐
	      its (0-9), upper-case letters (B-Z) and lower-case  letters  (b-
	      z). For safety reasons the vowels (AEIOUaeiou) are excluded from
	      the alphabet.  The name format is: 6 or more characters for  the
	      time  in seconds, 4 characters for the time in microseconds, the
	      'z'; the remainder is the file inode number encoded in the first
	      51 characters of the 52-character alphabet.

       ·      New messages have a Message-ID header with queueID@myhostname.

       ·      The  mailq  (postqueue  -p)  output has a wider Queue ID column.
	      The number of whitespace-separated fields is not changed.

       ·      The hash_queue_depth algorithm uses the first characters of  the
	      queue  file creation time in microseconds, after conversion into
	      hexadecimal representation. This produces the same queue hashing
	      behavior	 as   if   the	 queue	file  name  was	 created  with
	      "enable_long_queue_ids = no".

       Changing the parameter value to "no" has the following effects:

       ·      Existing long queue file names are renamed  to  the  short  form
	      (while running "postfix reload" or "postsuper").

       ·      New  queue files are created with names such as C3CD21F3E90 from
	      a hexadecimal alphabet that contains digits (0-9) and upper-case
	      letters  (A-F). The name format is: 5 characters for the time in
	      microseconds; the remainder is the file inode number.

       ·      New  messages  have  a  Message-ID   header   with   YYYYMMDDHH‐
	      MMSS.queueid@myhostname,	where  YYYYMMDDHHMMSS  are  the	 year,
	      month, day, hour, minute and second.

       ·      The mailq (postqueue -p) output has  the	same  format  as  with
	      Postfix <= 2.8.

       ·      The  hash_queue_depth algorithm uses the first characters of the
	      queue file name, with the hexadecimal representation of the file
	      creation time in microseconds.

       Before migration to Postfix <= 2.8, the following commands are required
       to convert long queue file names into short names:

       # postfix stop
       # postconf enable_long_queue_ids=no
       # postsuper

       Repeat the postsuper command until it reports no more queue  file  name
       changes.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

enable_original_recipient (default: yes)
       Enable  support	for  the  X-Original-To message header. This header is
       needed for multi-recipient mailboxes.

       When this parameter is set  to  yes,  the  cleanup(8)  daemon  performs
       duplicate elimination on distinct pairs of (original recipient, rewrit‐
       ten recipient), and generates non-empty original recipient  queue  file
       records.

       When this parameter is set to no, the cleanup(8) daemon performs dupli‐
       cate elimination on the rewritten recipient address only, and generates
       empty original recipient queue file records.

       This  feature  is available in Postfix 2.1 and later. With Postfix ver‐
       sion 2.0, support for the X-Original-To message header is always turned
       on.  Postfix  versions before 2.0 have no support for the X-Original-To
       message header.

error_notice_recipient (default: postmaster)
       The recipient of postmaster notifications about mail delivery  problems
       that  are  caused  by  policy,  resource,  software or protocol errors.
       These notifications are enabled with the notify_classes parameter.

error_service_name (default: error)
       The name of the error(8) pseudo delivery	 agent.	 This  service	always
       returns mail as undeliverable.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

execution_directory_expansion_filter (default: see postconf -d output)
       Restrict	 the  characters  that	the  local(8) delivery agent allows in
       $name expansions of $command_execution_directory.   Characters  outside
       the allowed set are replaced by underscores.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

expand_owner_alias (default: no)
       When  delivering	 to an alias "aliasname" that has an "owner-aliasname"
       companion alias, set the envelope sender address to  the	 expansion  of
       the "owner-aliasname" alias. Normally, Postfix sets the envelope sender
       address to the name of the "owner-aliasname" alias.

export_environment (default: see postconf -d output)
       The list of environment variables that a Postfix process will export to
       non-Postfix  processes. The TZ variable is needed for sane time keeping
       on System-V-ish systems.

       Specify a list of names and/or name=value pairs,	 separated  by	white‐
       space  or  comma. The name=value form is supported with Postfix version
       2.1 and later.

       Example:

       export_environment = TZ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin

extract_recipient_limit (default: 10240)
       The maximal number of recipient addresses  that	Postfix	 will  extract
       from message headers when mail is submitted with "sendmail -t".

       This feature was removed in Postfix version 2.1.

fallback_relay (default: empty)
       Optional	 list of relay hosts for SMTP destinations that can't be found
       or that are unreachable. With Postfix 2.3 this parameter is renamed  to
       smtp_fallback_relay.

       By  default,  mail  is returned to the sender when a destination is not
       found, and delivery is deferred when a destination is unreachable.

       The fallback relays must be SMTP destinations. Specify a domain,	 host,
       host:port,  [host]:port,	 [address]  or [address]:port; the form [host]
       turns off MX lookups.  If you specify multiple SMTP destinations, Post‐
       fix will try them in the specified order.

       Note:  before  Postfix  2.2, do not use the fallback_relay feature when
       relaying mail for a backup  or  primary	MX  domain.  Mail  would  loop
       between	the Postfix MX host and the fallback_relay host when the final
       destination is unavailable.

       ·      In main.cf specify "relay_transport = relay",

       ·      In master.cf specify "-o fallback_relay =" (i.e., empty) at  the
	      end of the relay entry.

       ·      In transport maps, specify "relay:nexthop..."  as the right-hand
	      side for backup or primary MX domain entries.

       Postfix version 2.2 and later will not use the  fallback_relay  feature
       for destinations that it is MX host for.

fallback_transport (default: empty)
       Optional	 message  delivery  transport that the local(8) delivery agent
       should use for names that are not found in the aliases(5) or UNIX pass‐
       word database.

       The  precedence	of  local(8)  delivery	features  from high to low is:
       aliases,	 .forward  files,  mailbox_transport_maps,  mailbox_transport,
       mailbox_command_maps,  mailbox_command, home_mailbox, mail_spool_direc‐
       tory, fallback_transport_maps, fallback_transport and luser_relay.

fallback_transport_maps (default: empty)
       Optional lookup tables with per-recipient message  delivery  transports
       for  recipients	that the local(8) delivery agent could not find in the
       aliases(5) or UNIX password database.

       The precedence of local(8) delivery  features  from  high  to  low  is:
       aliases,	 .forward  files,  mailbox_transport_maps,  mailbox_transport,
       mailbox_command_maps, mailbox_command, home_mailbox,  mail_spool_direc‐
       tory, fallback_transport_maps, fallback_transport and luser_relay.

       For  safety  reasons, this feature does not allow $number substitutions
       in regular expression maps.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

fast_flush_domains (default: $relay_domains)
       Optional list of destinations that  are	eligible  for  per-destination
       logfiles with mail that is queued to those destinations.

       By  default,  Postfix maintains "fast flush" logfiles only for destina‐
       tions that the Postfix SMTP server is willing to	 relay	to  (i.e.  the
       default	  is:	"fast_flush_domains   =	  $relay_domains";   see   the
       relay_domains parameter in the postconf(5) manual).

       Specify a list of hosts or domains, "/file/name" patterns or  "type:ta‐
       ble"  lookup  tables,  separated by commas and/or whitespace.  Continue
       long lines by starting the next line with  whitespace.  A  "/file/name"
       pattern	is  replaced  by  its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is
       matched when the domain or its parent domain appears as lookup key.

       Specify "fast_flush_domains =" (i.e., empty)  to	 disable  the  feature
       altogether.

fast_flush_purge_time (default: 7d)
       The  time  after which an empty per-destination "fast flush" logfile is
       deleted.

       You can specify the time as a number, or as a number followed by a let‐
       ter  that  indicates  the  time	unit:  s=seconds,  m=minutes, h=hours,
       d=days, w=weeks.	 The default time unit is days.

fast_flush_refresh_time (default: 12h)
       The time after which  a	non-empty  but	unread	per-destination	 "fast
       flush"  logfile	needs  to be refreshed.	 The contents of a logfile are
       refreshed by requesting delivery of all messages listed in the logfile.

       You can specify the time as a number, or as a number followed by a let‐
       ter  that  indicates  the  time	unit:  s=seconds,  m=minutes, h=hours,
       d=days, w=weeks.	 The default time unit is hours.

fault_injection_code (default: 0)
       Force specific internal tests to fail, to test the handling  of	errors
       that are difficult to reproduce otherwise.

flush_service_name (default: flush)
       The  name  of the flush(8) service. This service maintains per-destina‐
       tion logfiles with the queue file names of  mail	 that  is  queued  for
       those destinations.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

fork_attempts (default: 5)
       The maximal number of attempts to fork() a child process.

fork_delay (default: 1s)
       The delay between attempts to fork() a child process.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

forward_expansion_filter (default: see postconf -d output)
       Restrict the characters that the	 local(8)  delivery  agent  allows  in
       $name  expansions of $forward_path.  Characters outside the allowed set
       are replaced by underscores.

forward_path (default: see postconf -d output)
       The local(8) delivery agent search list for  finding  a	.forward  file
       with  user-specified  delivery methods. The first file that is found is
       used.

       The following $name expansions are  done	 on  forward_path  before  the
       search actually happens. The result of $name expansion is filtered with
       the character set that is specified with	 the  forward_expansion_filter
       parameter.

       $user  The recipient's username.

       $shell The recipient's login shell pathname.

       $home  The recipient's home directory.

       $recipient
	      The full recipient address.

       $extension
	      The optional recipient address extension.

       $domain
	      The recipient domain.

       $local The entire recipient localpart.

       $recipient_delimiter
	      The system-wide recipient address extension delimiter.

       ${name?value}
	      Expands to value when $name is non-empty.

       ${name:value}
	      Expands to value when $name is empty.

       Instead of $name you can also specify ${name} or $(name).

       Examples:

       forward_path = /var/forward/$user
       forward_path =
	   /var/forward/$user/.forward$recipient_delimiter$extension,
	   /var/forward/$user/.forward

frozen_delivered_to (default: yes)
       Update  the local(8) delivery agent's idea of the Delivered-To: address
       (see prepend_delivered_header) only once, at the start  of  a  delivery
       attempt;	 do  not  update  the  Delivered-To:  address  while expanding
       aliases or .forward files.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. With older  Postfix
       releases,  the behavior is as if this parameter is set to "no". The old
       setting can be expensive with deeply nested aliases or .forward	files.
       When  an	 alias	or .forward file changes the Delivered-To: address, it
       ties up one queue file and one cleanup process instance while  mail  is
       being forwarded.

hash_queue_depth (default: 1)
       The number of subdirectory levels for queue directories listed with the
       hash_queue_names parameter. Queue hashing is  implemented  by  creating
       one  or	more  levels  of directories with one-character names.	Origi‐
       nally, these directory names were equal to the first characters of  the
       queue  file  name, with the hexadecimal representation of the file cre‐
       ation time in microseconds.

       With long queue file names, queue hashing produces the same results  as
       with  short  names. The file creation time in microseconds is converted
       into hexadecimal form before the result is used for queue hashing.  The
       base  16 encoding gives finer control over the number of subdirectories
       than is possible with the base 52 encoding of long queue file names.

       After changing the hash_queue_names or hash_queue_depth parameter, exe‐
       cute the command "postfix reload".

hash_queue_names (default: deferred, defer)
       The names of queue directories that are split across multiple subdirec‐
       tory levels.

       Before Postfix version 2.2, the default list of hashed queues was  sig‐
       nificantly  larger. Claims about improvements in file system technology
       suggest that hashing of the incoming and active	queues	is  no	longer
       needed.	Fewer  hashed  directories speed up the time needed to restart
       Postfix.

       After changing the hash_queue_names or hash_queue_depth parameter, exe‐
       cute the command "postfix reload".

header_address_token_limit (default: 10240)
       The  maximal number of address tokens are allowed in an address message
       header. Information that exceeds the limit is discarded.	 The limit  is
       enforced by the cleanup(8) server.

header_checks (default: empty)
       Optional	 lookup tables for content inspection of primary non-MIME mes‐
       sage headers, as specified in the header_checks(5) manual page.

header_size_limit (default: 102400)
       The maximal amount of memory in bytes for storing a message header.  If
       a  header is larger, the excess is discarded.  The limit is enforced by
       the cleanup(8) server.

helpful_warnings (default: yes)
       Log warnings about  problematic	configuration  settings,  and  provide
       helpful suggestions.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

home_mailbox (default: empty)
       Optional	 pathname of a mailbox file relative to a local(8) user's home
       directory.

       Specify a pathname ending in "/" for qmail-style delivery.

       The precedence of local(8) delivery  features  from  high  to  low  is:
       aliases,	 .forward  files,  mailbox_transport_maps,  mailbox_transport,
       mailbox_command_maps, mailbox_command, home_mailbox,  mail_spool_direc‐
       tory, fallback_transport_maps, fallback_transport and luser_relay.

       Examples:

       home_mailbox = Mailbox
       home_mailbox = Maildir/

hopcount_limit (default: 50)
       The maximal number of Received:	message headers that is allowed in the
       primary message headers. A message that exceeds the limit  is  bounced,
       in order to stop a mailer loop.

html_directory (default: see postconf -d output)
       The  location of Postfix HTML files that describe how to build, config‐
       ure or operate a specific Postfix subsystem or feature.

ignore_mx_lookup_error (default: no)
       Ignore DNS MX lookups that produce no response.	By default, the	 Post‐
       fix SMTP client defers delivery and tries again after some delay.  This
       behavior is required by the SMTP standard.

       Specify "ignore_mx_lookup_error = yes" to force a DNS A	record	lookup
       instead. This violates the SMTP standard and can result in mis-delivery
       of mail.

import_environment (default: see postconf -d output)
       The list of environment parameters that a Postfix process  will	import
       from a non-Postfix parent process. Examples of relevant parameters:

       TZ     Needed for sane time keeping on most System-V-ish systems.

       DISPLAY
	      Needed for debugging Postfix daemons with an X-windows debugger.

       XAUTHORITY
	      Needed for debugging Postfix daemons with an X-windows debugger.

       MAIL_CONFIG
	      Needed to make "postfix -c" work.

       Specify	a  list	 of names and/or name=value pairs, separated by white‐
       space or comma. The name=value form is supported with  Postfix  version
       2.1 and later.

in_flow_delay (default: 1s)
       Time  to pause before accepting a new message, when the message arrival
       rate exceeds the message delivery rate. This feature is	turned	on  by
       default (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due to an SCO bug).

       With  the default 100 Postfix SMTP server process limit, "in_flow_delay
       = 1s" limits the mail inflow to 100 messages per second above the  num‐
       ber of messages delivered per second.

       Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.

inet_interfaces (default: all)
       The network interface addresses that this mail system receives mail on.
       Specify "all" to receive mail on all network interfaces (default),  and
       "loopback-only"	to  receive  mail  on loopback network interfaces only
       (Postfix version 2.2 and later).	 The parameter also controls  delivery
       of mail to user@[ip.address].

       Note 1: you need to stop and start Postfix when this parameter changes.

       Note 2: address information may be enclosed inside [], but this form is
       not required here.

       When inet_interfaces specifies just one IPv4 and/or IPv6	 address  that
       is  not	a  loopback  address,  the  Postfix  SMTP client will use this
       address as the IP source address for outbound mail. Support for IPv6 is
       available in Postfix version 2.2 and later.

       On  a multi-homed firewall with separate Postfix instances listening on
       the "inside" and "outside" interfaces, this can prevent	each  instance
       from being able to reach remote SMTP servers on the "other side" of the
       firewall. Setting smtp_bind_address to  0.0.0.0	avoids	the  potential
       problem for IPv4, and setting smtp_bind_address6 to :: solves the prob‐
       lem for IPv6.

       A better solution for multi-homed firewalls is to leave inet_interfaces
       at  the default value and instead use explicit IP addresses in the mas‐
       ter.cf SMTP  server  definitions.   This	 preserves  the	 Postfix  SMTP
       client's	 loop  detection,  by  ensuring that each side of the firewall
       knows that the other  IP	 address  is  still  the  same	host.  Setting
       $inet_interfaces to a single IPv4 and/or IPV6 address is primarily use‐
       ful with virtual hosting of domains on  secondary  IP  addresses,  when
       each IP address serves a different domain (and has a different $myhost‐
       name setting).

       See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that are
       forwarded to Postfix by way of a proxy or address translator.

       Examples:

       inet_interfaces = all (DEFAULT)
       inet_interfaces = loopback-only (Postfix version 2.2 and later)
       inet_interfaces = 127.0.0.1
       inet_interfaces = 127.0.0.1, [::1] (Postfix version 2.2 and later)
       inet_interfaces = 192.168.1.2, 127.0.0.1

inet_protocols (default: all)
       The  Internet  protocols	 Postfix  will	attempt	 to use when making or
       accepting connections. Specify one or more of "ipv4" or	"ipv6",	 sepa‐
       rated  by  whitespace or commas. The form "all" is equivalent to "ipv4,
       ipv6" or "ipv4", depending on whether the operating  system  implements
       IPv6.

       With  Postfix 2.8 and earlier the default is "ipv4". For backwards com‐
       patibility with these releases, the Postfix 2.9 and later upgrade  pro‐
       cedure  appends	an explicit "inet_protocols = ipv4" setting to main.cf
       when no explicit setting is present. This compatibility workaround will
       be phased out as IPv6 deployment becomes more common.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Note: you MUST stop and start Postfix after changing this parameter.

       On systems that pre-date IPV6_V6ONLY support (RFC 3493), an IPv6 server
       will also accept IPv4 connections, even when IPv4 is  turned  off  with
       the  inet_protocols  parameter.	 On  systems with IPV6_V6ONLY support,
       Postfix will use separate server sockets for IPv6 and  IPv4,  and  each
       will accept only connections for the corresponding protocol.

       When  IPv4 support is enabled via the inet_protocols parameter, Postfix
       will look up DNS type A records, and will convert  IPv4-in-IPv6	client
       IP  addresses  (::ffff:1.2.3.4)	to their original IPv4 form (1.2.3.4).
       The latter is needed on hosts that pre-date  IPV6_V6ONLY	 support  (RFC
       3493).

       When  IPv6 support is enabled via the inet_protocols parameter, Postfix
       will do DNS type AAAA record lookups.

       When both IPv4 and IPv6 support are enabled, the	 Postfix  SMTP	client
       will attempt to connect via IPv6 before attempting to use IPv4.

       Examples:

       inet_protocols = ipv4
       inet_protocols = all (DEFAULT)
       inet_protocols = ipv6
       inet_protocols = ipv4, ipv6

initial_destination_concurrency (default: 5)
       The  initial per-destination concurrency level for parallel delivery to
       the same destination.  With per-destination recipient limit > 1, a des‐
       tination is a domain, otherwise it is a recipient.

       Use  transport_initial_destination_concurrency  to specify a transport-
       specific override, where transport is the master.cf name of the message
       delivery transport (Postfix 2.5 and later).

       Warning:	 with concurrency of 1, one bad message can be enough to block
       all mail to a site.

internal_mail_filter_classes (default: empty)
       What categories of Postfix-generated mail are subject  to  before-queue
       content inspection by non_smtpd_milters, header_checks and body_checks.
       Specify zero or more of	the  following,	 separated  by	whitespace  or
       comma.

       bounce Inspect the content of delivery status notifications.

       notify Inspect  the  content of postmaster notifications by the smtp(8)
	      and smtpd(8) processes.

       NOTE: It's generally not safe to enable content inspection of  Postfix-
       generated email messages. The user is warned.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

invalid_hostname_reject_code (default: 501)
       The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when the client HELO or
       EHLO command parameter is rejected by the  reject_invalid_helo_hostname
       restriction.

       Do  not	change	this  unless  you have a complete understanding of RFC
       5321.

ipc_idle (default: version dependent)
       The time after which a client closes  an	 idle  internal	 communication
       channel.	 The purpose is to allow Postfix daemon processes to terminate
       voluntarily after they become idle. This is used, for example,  by  the
       Postfix address resolving and rewriting clients.

       With Postfix 2.4 the default value was reduced from 100s to 5s.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

ipc_timeout (default: 3600s)
       The time limit for sending or receiving information  over  an  internal
       communication  channel.	The purpose is to break out of deadlock situa‐
       tions. If the time limit is exceeded the software aborts with  a	 fatal
       error.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

ipc_ttl (default: 1000s)
       The time after which a client closes an active  internal	 communication
       channel.	 The purpose is to allow Postfix daemon processes to terminate
       voluntarily after reaching their client limit.  This is used, for exam‐
       ple, by the Postfix address resolving and rewriting clients.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

line_length_limit (default: 2048)
       Upon input, long lines are chopped up  into  pieces  of	at  most  this
       length; upon delivery, long lines are reconstructed.

lmtp_address_preference (default: ipv6)
       The  LMTP-specific version of the smtp_address_preference configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

lmtp_assume_final (default: no)
       When a remote LMTP server announces no DSN  support,  assume  that  the
       server  performs	 final	delivery, and send "delivered" delivery status
       notifications instead of "relayed". The default	setting	 is  backwards
       compatible  to avoid the infinitesimal possibility of breaking existing
       LMTP-based content filters.

lmtp_bind_address (default: empty)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_bind_address configuration param‐
       eter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_bind_address6 (default: empty)
       The  LMTP-specific  version  of	the  smtp_bind_address6	 configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_body_checks (default: empty)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_body_checks configuration parame‐
       ter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_cache_connection (default: yes)
       Keep  Postfix LMTP client connections open for up to $max_idle seconds.
       When the LMTP client receives a request for  the	 same  connection  the
       connection is reused.

       This  parameter	is available in Postfix version 2.2 and earlier.  With
       Postfix version 2.3  and	 later,	 see  lmtp_connection_cache_on_demand,
       lmtp_connection_cache_destinations,	  or	   lmtp_connection_re‐
       use_time_limit.

       The effectiveness of cached connections will be determined by the  num‐
       ber  of remote LMTP servers in use, and the concurrency limit specified
       for the Postfix LMTP client. Cached connections are closed under any of
       the following conditions:

       ·      The  Postfix LMTP client idle time limit is reached.  This limit
	      is specified with the Postfix max_idle configuration parameter.

       ·      A delivery request specifies a different	destination  than  the
	      one currently cached.

       ·      The  per-process	limit  on  the	number of delivery requests is
	      reached.	This limit is specified with the Postfix max_use  con‐
	      figuration parameter.

       ·      Upon  the	 onset	of  another  delivery request, the remote LMTP
	      server associated with the current session does not  respond  to
	      the RSET command.

       Most of these limitations have been with the Postfix a connection cache
       that is shared among multiple LMTP client programs.

lmtp_cname_overrides_servername (default: yes)
       The LMTP-specific version of the	 smtp_cname_overrides_servername  con‐
       figuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_connect_timeout (default: 0s)
       The  Postfix LMTP client time limit for completing a TCP connection, or
       zero (use the operating system built-in time limit).  When  no  connec‐
       tion  can  be  made within the deadline, the LMTP client tries the next
       address on the mail exchanger list.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

       Example:

       lmtp_connect_timeout = 30s

lmtp_connection_cache_destinations (default: empty)
       The  LMTP-specific  version  of	the smtp_connection_cache_destinations
       configuration parameter.	 See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_connection_cache_on_demand (default: yes)
       The LMTP-specific version of the	 smtp_connection_cache_on_demand  con‐
       figuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_connection_cache_time_limit (default: 2s)
       The  LMTP-specific version of the smtp_connection_cache_time_limit con‐
       figuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_connection_reuse_time_limit (default: 300s)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_connection_reuse_time_limit  con‐
       figuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_data_done_timeout (default: 600s)
       The  Postfix  LMTP  client time limit for sending the LMTP ".", and for
       receiving the  remote  LMTP  server  response.	When  no  response  is
       received	 within the deadline, a warning is logged that the mail may be
       delivered multiple times.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

lmtp_data_init_timeout (default: 120s)
       The  Postfix  LMTP client time limit for sending the LMTP DATA command,
       and for receiving the remote LMTP server response.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

lmtp_data_xfer_timeout (default: 180s)
       The  Postfix  LMTP  client time limit for sending the LMTP message con‐
       tent.  When the connection stalls for more than $lmtp_data_xfer_timeout
       the LMTP client terminates the transfer.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

lmtp_defer_if_no_mx_address_found (default: no)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_defer_if_no_mx_address_found con‐
       figuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_destination_concurrency_limit    (default:	  $default_destination_concur‐
       rency_limit)
       The maximal number of parallel deliveries to the same  destination  via
       the  lmtp  message  delivery  transport.	 This limit is enforced by the
       queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the  first	 field
       in the entry in the master.cf file.

lmtp_destination_recipient_limit     (default:	  $default_destination_recipi‐
       ent_limit)
       The maximal number of recipients	 per  message  for  the	 lmtp  message
       delivery	 transport.  This  limit is enforced by the queue manager. The
       message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in  the
       master.cf file.

       Setting this parameter to a value of 1 changes the meaning of lmtp_des‐
       tination_concurrency_limit from concurrency per domain into concurrency
       per recipient.

lmtp_discard_lhlo_keyword_address_maps (default: empty)
       Lookup  tables,	indexed	 by  the remote LMTP server address, with case
       insensitive lists of LHLO keywords (pipelining, starttls,  auth,	 etc.)
       that  the  Postfix  LMTP client will ignore in the LHLO response from a
       remote LMTP server. See lmtp_discard_lhlo_keywords for details. The ta‐
       ble  is	not  indexed  by  hostname  for	 consistency  with  smtpd_dis‐
       card_ehlo_keyword_address_maps.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_discard_lhlo_keywords (default: empty)
       A case insensitive list of LHLO keywords (pipelining,  starttls,	 auth,
       etc.)  that  the	 Postfix  LMTP client will ignore in the LHLO response
       from a remote LMTP server.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

       Notes:

       ·      Specify the silent-discard pseudo keyword to prevent this action
	      from being logged.

       ·      Use  the	lmtp_discard_lhlo_keyword_address_maps feature to dis‐
	      card LHLO keywords selectively.

lmtp_dns_resolver_options (default: empty)
       The LMTP-specific version of the	 smtp_dns_resolver_options  configura‐
       tion parameter.	See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

lmtp_enforce_tls (default: no)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_enforce_tls configuration parame‐
       ter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_generic_maps (default: empty)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_generic_maps configuration param‐
       eter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_header_checks (default: empty)
       The  LMTP-specific  version  of	the  smtp_header_checks	 configuration
       parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_host_lookup (default: dns)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_host_lookup configuration parame‐
       ter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_lhlo_name (default: $myhostname)
       The hostname to send in the LMTP LHLO command.

       The  default  value  is	the  machine  hostname.	 Specify a hostname or
       [ip.add.re.ss].

       This information can be specified in the	 main.cf  file	for  all  LMTP
       clients,	 or  it	 can be specified in the master.cf file for a specific
       client, for example:

	   /etc/postfix/master.cf:
	       mylmtp ... lmtp -o lmtp_lhlo_name=foo.bar.com

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_lhlo_timeout (default: 300s)
       The Postfix LMTP client time limit for sending the  LHLO	 command,  and
       for receiving the initial remote LMTP server response.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

lmtp_line_length_limit (default: 990)
       The LMTP-specific version of the	 smtp_line_length_limit	 configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_mail_timeout (default: 300s)
       The  Postfix  LMTP client time limit for sending the MAIL FROM command,
       and for receiving the remote LMTP server response.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

lmtp_mime_header_checks (default: empty)
       The  LMTP-specific version of the smtp_mime_header_checks configuration
       parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_mx_address_limit (default: 5)
       The LMTP-specific version of  the  smtp_mx_address_limit	 configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_mx_session_limit (default: 2)
       The  LMTP-specific  version  of the smtp_mx_session_limit configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_nested_header_checks (default: empty)
       The LMTP-specific version of the	 smtp_nested_header_checks  configura‐
       tion parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_per_record_deadline (default: no)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_per_record_deadline configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

lmtp_pix_workaround_delay_time (default: 10s)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_pix_workaround_delay_time config‐
       uration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_pix_workaround_maps (default: empty)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_pix_workaround_maps configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later.

lmtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time (default: 500s)
       The LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time
       configuration parameter.	 See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_pix_workarounds (default: empty)
       The  LMTP-specific  version  of	the  smtp_pix_workaround configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later.

lmtp_quit_timeout (default: 300s)
       The Postfix LMTP client time limit for sending the  QUIT	 command,  and
       for receiving the remote LMTP server response.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

lmtp_quote_rfc821_envelope (default: yes)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_quote_rfc821_envelope  configura‐
       tion parameter.	See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_randomize_addresses (default: yes)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_randomize_addresses configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_rcpt_timeout (default: 300s)
       The Postfix LMTP client time limit for sending the RCPT TO command, and
       for receiving the remote LMTP server response.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

lmtp_reply_filter (default: empty)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_reply_filter configuration param‐
       eter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

lmtp_rset_timeout (default: 20s)
       The  Postfix  LMTP  client time limit for sending the RSET command, and
       for receiving the remote LMTP server response. The  LMTP	 client	 sends
       RSET  in order to finish a recipient address probe, or to verify that a
       cached connection is still alive.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

lmtp_sasl_auth_cache_name (default: empty)
       The  LMTP-specific  version of the smtp_sasl_auth_cache_name configura‐
       tion parameter.	See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_sasl_auth_cache_time (default: 90d)
       The LMTP-specific version of the	 smtp_sasl_auth_cache_time  configura‐
       tion parameter.	See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_sasl_auth_enable (default: no)
       Enable SASL authentication in the Postfix LMTP client.

lmtp_sasl_auth_soft_bounce (default: yes)
       The  LMTP-specific version of the smtp_sasl_auth_soft_bounce configura‐
       tion parameter.	See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_sasl_mechanism_filter (default: empty)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter  configura‐
       tion parameter.	See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_sasl_password_maps (default: empty)
       Optional	 Postfix  LMTP client lookup tables with one username:password
       entry per host or domain.  If a remote host  or	domain	has  no	 user‐
       name:password  entry,  then the Postfix LMTP client will not attempt to
       authenticate to the remote host.

lmtp_sasl_path (default: empty)
       Implementation-specific information that is passed through to the  SASL
       plug-in implementation that is selected with lmtp_sasl_type.  Typically
       this specifies the name of a configuration file or rendezvous point.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_sasl_security_options (default: noplaintext, noanonymous)
       SASL security options; as of Postfix 2.3 the list of available features
       depends	on  the	 SASL  client  implementation  that  is	 selected with
       lmtp_sasl_type.

       The following security features are defined for the cyrus  client  SASL
       implementation:

       noplaintext
	      Disallow authentication methods that use plaintext passwords.

       noactive
	      Disallow	authentication methods that are vulnerable to non-dic‐
	      tionary active attacks.

       nodictionary
	      Disallow authentication methods that are vulnerable  to  passive
	      dictionary attack.

       noanonymous
	      Disallow anonymous logins.

       Example:

       lmtp_sasl_security_options = noplaintext

lmtp_sasl_tls_security_options (default: $lmtp_sasl_security_options)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_sasl_tls_security_options config‐
       uration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_sasl_tls_verified_security_options	    (default:	  $lmtp_sasl_tls_secu‐
       rity_options)
       The   LMTP-specific   version   of   the	  smtp_sasl_tls_verified_secu‐
       rity_options configuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_sasl_type (default: cyrus)
       The SASL plug-in type that the  Postfix	LMTP  client  should  use  for
       authentication.	 The available types are listed with the "postconf -A"
       command.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_send_dummy_mail_auth (default: no)
       The LMTP-specific version of the	 smtp_send_dummy_mail_auth  configura‐
       tion parameter.	See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

lmtp_send_xforward_command (default: no)
       Send  an	 XFORWARD command to the remote LMTP server when the LMTP LHLO
       server response announces XFORWARD support.   This  allows  an  lmtp(8)
       delivery	 agent,	 used for content filter message injection, to forward
       the name, address, protocol and HELO name of the original client to the
       content	filter	and downstream queuing LMTP server.  Before you change
       the value to yes, it is best to make sure that your content filter sup‐
       ports this command.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

lmtp_sender_dependent_authentication (default: no)
       The  LMTP-specific  version of the smtp_sender_dependent_authentication
       configuration parameter.	 See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_skip_5xx_greeting (default: yes)
       The LMTP-specific version of the	 smtp_skip_5xx_greeting	 configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_skip_quit_response (default: no)
       Wait for the response to the LMTP QUIT command.

lmtp_starttls_timeout (default: 300s)
       The  LMTP-specific  version  of the smtp_starttls_timeout configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tcp_port (default: 24)
       The default TCP port that the Postfix LMTP client connects to.

lmtp_tls_CAfile (default: empty)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_CAfile configuration  parame‐
       ter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_CApath (default: empty)
       The  LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_CApath configuration parame‐
       ter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_block_early_mail_reply (default: empty)
       The LMTP-specific version of the	 smtp_tls_block_early_mail_reply  con‐
       figuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

lmtp_tls_cert_file (default: empty)
       The  LMTP-specific  version  of	the  smtp_tls_cert_file	 configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_ciphers (default: export)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_ciphers configuration parame‐
       ter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

lmtp_tls_dcert_file (default: empty)
       The  LMTP-specific  version  of	the  smtp_tls_dcert_file configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_dkey_file (default: $lmtp_tls_dcert_file)
       The  LMTP-specific  version  of	the  smtp_tls_dkey_file	 configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_eccert_file (default: empty)
       The  LMTP-specific  version  of	the smtp_tls_eccert_file configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and  later,  when  Postfix  is
       compiled and linked with OpenSSL 1.0.0 or later.

lmtp_tls_eckey_file (default: empty)
       The  LMTP-specific  version  of	the  smtp_tls_eckey_file configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and  later,  when  Postfix  is
       compiled and linked with OpenSSL 1.0.0 or later.

lmtp_tls_enforce_peername (default: yes)
       The  LMTP-specific  version of the smtp_tls_enforce_peername configura‐
       tion parameter.	See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_exclude_ciphers (default: empty)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_fingerprint_cert_match (default: empty)
       The  LMTP-specific  version of the smtp_tls_fingerprint_cert_match con‐
       figuration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_tls_fingerprint_digest (default: md5)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest configura‐
       tion parameter.	See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

lmtp_tls_key_file (default: $lmtp_tls_cert_file)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_key_file configuration param‐
       eter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_loglevel (default: 0)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_loglevel configuration param‐
       eter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers (default: empty)
       The  LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers configura‐
       tion parameter.	See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers (default: empty)
       The LMTP-specific  version  of  the  smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers
       configuration parameter.	 See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_mandatory_protocols (default: !SSLv2)
       The  LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols configu‐
       ration parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_note_starttls_offer (default: no)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_note_starttls_offer  configu‐
       ration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_per_site (default: empty)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_per_site configuration param‐
       eter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_policy_maps (default: empty)
       The LMTP-specific version  of  the  smtp_tls_policy_maps	 configuration
       parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_protocols (default: empty)
       The  LMTP-specific  version  of	the  smtp_tls_protocols	 configuration
       parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

lmtp_tls_scert_verifydepth (default: 9)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_scert_verifydepth  configura‐
       tion parameter.	See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_secure_cert_match (default: nexthop)
       The  LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_secure_cert_match configura‐
       tion parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_security_level (default: empty)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_security_level	 configuration
       parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_session_cache_database (default: empty)
       The  LMTP-specific  version of the smtp_tls_session_cache_database con‐
       figuration parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_session_cache_timeout (default: 3600s)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_session_cache_timeout config‐
       uration parameter.  See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_tls_verify_cert_match (default: hostname)
       The  LMTP-specific version of the smtp_tls_verify_cert_match configura‐
       tion parameter. See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_use_tls (default: no)
       The LMTP-specific version of the smtp_use_tls configuration  parameter.
       See there for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

lmtp_xforward_timeout (default: 300s)
       The  Postfix  LMTP  client time limit for sending the XFORWARD command,
       and for receiving the remote LMTP server response.

       In case of problems the client does NOT try the	next  address  on  the
       mail exchanger list.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

local_command_shell (default: empty)
       Optional shell program for local(8) delivery  to	 non-Postfix  command.
       By  default,  non-Postfix  commands are executed directly; commands are
       given to given to the default shell (typically, /bin/sh) only when they
       contain shell meta characters or shell built-in commands.

       "sendmail's  restricted	shell" (smrsh) is what most people will use in
       order to restrict what programs can be run  from	 e.g.  .forward	 files
       (smrsh is part of the Sendmail distribution).

       Note:  when  a  shell program is specified, it is invoked even when the
       command contains no shell built-in commands or meta characters.

       Example:

       local_command_shell = /some/where/smrsh -c
       local_command_shell = /bin/bash -c

local_destination_concurrency_limit (default: 2)
       The maximal number of parallel deliveries via the local	mail  delivery
       transport   to  the  same  recipient  (when  "local_destination_recipi‐
       ent_limit = 1") or the maximal number of	 parallel  deliveries  to  the
       same  local domain (when "local_destination_recipient_limit > 1"). This
       limit is enforced by the queue manager. The message delivery  transport
       name is the first field in the entry in the master.cf file.

       A  low limit of 2 is recommended, just in case someone has an expensive
       shell command in a .forward file or in an alias (e.g., a	 mailing  list
       manager).  You don't want to run lots of those at the same time.

local_destination_recipient_limit (default: 1)
       The  maximal  number  of	 recipients per message delivery via the local
       mail delivery transport. This limit is enforced by the  queue  manager.
       The  message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in
       the master.cf file.

       Setting this parameter to a value > 1 changes the meaning of local_des‐
       tination_concurrency_limit  from concurrency per recipient into concur‐
       rency per domain.

local_header_rewrite_clients (default: permit_inet_interfaces)
       Rewrite message header addresses in mail from these clients and	update
       incomplete  addresses  with  the domain name in $myorigin or $mydomain;
       either don't rewrite message headers from other clients at all, or  re‐
       write  message  headers and update incomplete addresses with the domain
       specified in the remote_header_rewrite_domain parameter.

       See  the	 append_at_myorigin  and  append_dot_mydomain  parameters  for
       details of how domain names are appended to incomplete addresses.

       Specify a list of zero or more of the following:

       permit_inet_interfaces
	      Append the domain name in $myorigin or $mydomain when the client
	      IP address matches $inet_interfaces. This is enabled by default.

       permit_mynetworks
	      Append the domain name in $myorigin or $mydomain when the client
	      IP  address  matches  any	 network  or network address listed in
	      $mynetworks. This setting will not prevent  remote  mail	header
	      address rewriting when mail from a remote client is forwarded by
	      a neighboring system.

       permit_sasl_authenticated
	      Append the domain name in $myorigin or $mydomain when the client
	      is successfully authenticated via the RFC 4954 (AUTH) protocol.

       permit_tls_clientcerts
	      Append the domain name in $myorigin or $mydomain when the remote
	      SMTP client TLS certificate fingerprint or  public  key  finger‐
	      print  (Postfix  2.9 and later) is listed in $relay_clientcerts.
	      The  fingerprint	digest	algorithm  is  configurable  via   the
	      smtpd_tls_fingerprint_digest  parameter (hard-coded as md5 prior
	      to Postfix version 2.5).

       permit_tls_all_clientcerts
	      Append the domain name in $myorigin or $mydomain when the remote
	      SMTP client TLS certificate is successfully verified, regardless
	      of whether it is listed on the server,  and  regardless  of  the
	      certifying authority.

       check_address_map type:table

       type:table
	      Append the domain name in $myorigin or $mydomain when the client
	      IP address matches  the  specified  lookup  table.   The	lookup
	      result  is  ignored, and no subnet lookup is done. This is suit‐
	      able for, e.g., pop-before-smtp lookup tables.

       Examples:

       The Postfix < 2.2 backwards compatible setting: always rewrite  message
       headers,	  and  always  append  my  own	domain	to  incomplete	header
       addresses.

	   local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all

       The purist (and default) setting: rewrite headers  only	in  mail  from
       Postfix sendmail and in SMTP mail from this machine.

	   local_header_rewrite_clients = permit_inet_interfaces

       The intermediate setting: rewrite header addresses and append $myorigin
       or $mydomain information only with mail	from  Postfix  sendmail,  from
       local clients, or from authorized SMTP clients.

       Note:  this setting will not prevent remote mail header address rewrit‐
       ing when mail from a remote client is forwarded by a  neighboring  sys‐
       tem.

	   local_header_rewrite_clients = permit_mynetworks,
	       permit_sasl_authenticated permit_tls_clientcerts
	       check_address_map hash:/etc/postfix/pop-before-smtp

local_recipient_maps (default: proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps)
       Lookup tables with all names or addresses of local recipients: a recip‐
       ient  address  is  local	 when  its  domain   matches   $mydestination,
       $inet_interfaces	 or $proxy_interfaces.	Specify @domain as a wild-card
       for domains that do not have  a	valid  recipient  list.	  Technically,
       tables  listed  with  $local_recipient_maps  are used as lists: Postfix
       needs to know only if a lookup string is found or not, but it does  not
       use the result from table lookup.

       If  this	 parameter  is	non-empty (the default), then the Postfix SMTP
       server will reject mail for unknown local users.

       To turn off local recipient checking in the Postfix SMTP server,	 spec‐
       ify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty).

       The  default  setting  assumes  that  you use the default Postfix local
       delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the local_recipi‐
       ent_maps setting if:

       ·      You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.

       ·      You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.

       ·      You   use	 the  "luser_relay",  "mailbox_transport",  or	"fall‐
	      back_transport" feature of the Postfix local(8) delivery agent.

       Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.

       Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you  need  to	access
       the  passwd  file  via  the  proxymap(8)	 service, in order to overcome
       chroot access restrictions. The alternative, maintaining a copy of  the
       system password file in the chroot jail is not practical.

       Examples:

       local_recipient_maps =

local_transport (default: local:$myhostname)
       The  default mail delivery transport and next-hop destination for final
       delivery to domains listed with mydestination, and for [ipaddress] des‐
       tinations  that	match  $inet_interfaces	 or  $proxy_interfaces.	  This
       information can be overruled with the transport(5) table.

       By default, local mail is delivered to the  transport  called  "local",
       which is just the name of a service that is defined the master.cf file.

       Specify	a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is the
       name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf.	 The  :nexthop
       destination is optional; its syntax is documented in the manual page of
       the corresponding delivery agent.

       Beware: if you override the default local delivery agent then you  need
       to  review  the	LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README	document,  otherwise  the SMTP
       server may reject mail for local recipients.

luser_relay (default: empty)
       Optional catch-all destination for  unknown  local(8)  recipients.   By
       default,	 mail for unknown recipients in domains that match $mydestina‐
       tion, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces is returned	as  undeliver‐
       able.

       The following $name expansions are done on luser_relay:

       $domain
	      The recipient domain.

       $extension
	      The recipient address extension.

       $home  The recipient's home directory.

       $local The entire recipient address localpart.

       $recipient
	      The full recipient address.

       $recipient_delimiter
	      The system-wide recipient address extension delimiter.

       $shell The recipient's login shell.

       $user  The recipient username.

       ${name?value}
	      Expands to value when $name has a non-empty value.

       ${name:value}
	      Expands to value when $name has an empty value.

       Instead of $name you can also specify ${name} or $(name).

       Note: luser_relay works only for the Postfix local(8) delivery agent.

       Note:  if  you  use  this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
       file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps ="  (i.e.  empty)  in
       the  main.cf  file,  otherwise the Postfix SMTP server will reject mail
       for non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".

       Examples:

       luser_relay = $user@other.host
       luser_relay = $local@other.host
       luser_relay = admin+$local

mail_name (default: Postfix)
       The mail system name that is displayed in  Received:  headers,  in  the
       SMTP greeting banner, and in bounced mail.

mail_owner (default: postfix)
       The  UNIX  system  account that owns the Postfix queue and most Postfix
       daemon processes.  Specify the name of  an  unprivileged	 user  account
       that  does  not	share a user or group ID with other accounts, and that
       owns no other files or processes on the system.	In  particular,	 don't
       specify nobody or daemon.  PLEASE USE A DEDICATED USER ID AND GROUP ID.

       When  this  parameter value is changed you need to re-run "postfix set-
       permissions" (with Postfix version 2.0 and earlier: "/etc/postfix/post-
       install set-permissions".

mail_release_date (default: see postconf -d output)
       The Postfix release date, in "YYYYMMDD" format.

mail_spool_directory (default: see postconf -d output)
       The directory where local(8) UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default
       setting depends on the system type. Specify a  name  ending  in	/  for
       maildir-style delivery.

       Note:  maildir  delivery	 is done with the privileges of the recipient.
       If you use the mail_spool_directory setting for maildir style delivery,
       then  you must create the top-level maildir directory in advance. Post‐
       fix will not create it.

       Examples:

       mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
       mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail

mail_version (default: see postconf -d output)
       The  version  of	 the  mail   system.   Stable	releases   are	 named
       major.minor.patchlevel.	Experimental releases also include the release
       date. The version string can be used in, for example, the SMTP greeting
       banner.

mailbox_command (default: empty)
       Optional	 external  command that the local(8) delivery agent should use
       for mailbox delivery.  The command is run with the user ID and the pri‐
       mary group ID privileges of the recipient.  Exception: command delivery
       for root executes with $default_privs privileges.  This is not a	 prob‐
       lem,  because  1) mail for root should always be aliased to a real user
       and 2) don't log in as root, use "su" instead.

       The following environment variables are exported to the command:

       CLIENT_ADDRESS
	      Remote client network address. Available in Postfix version  2.2
	      and later.

       CLIENT_HELO
	      Remote  client EHLO command parameter. Available in Postfix ver‐
	      sion 2.2 and later.

       CLIENT_HOSTNAME
	      Remote client hostname. Available in  Postfix  version  2.2  and
	      later.

       CLIENT_PROTOCOL
	      Remote  client  protocol.	 Available  in Postfix version 2.2 and
	      later.

       DOMAIN The domain part of the recipient address.

       EXTENSION
	      The optional address extension.

       HOME   The recipient home directory.

       LOCAL  The recipient address localpart.

       LOGNAME
	      The recipient's username.

       ORIGINAL_RECIPIENT
	      The entire recipient address, before any	address	 rewriting  or
	      aliasing.

       RECIPIENT
	      The full recipient address.

       SASL_METHOD
	      SASL  authentication  method specified in the remote client AUTH
	      command. Available in Postfix version 2.2 and later.

       SASL_SENDER
	      SASL sender address specified in the  remote  client  MAIL  FROM
	      command. Available in Postfix version 2.2 and later.

       SASL_USER
	      SASL  username  specified	 in  the  remote  client AUTH command.
	      Available in Postfix version 2.2 and later.

       SENDER The full sender address.

       SHELL  The recipient's login shell.

       USER   The recipient username.

       Unlike other  Postfix  configuration  parameters,  the  mailbox_command
       parameter  is  not subjected to $name substitutions. This is to make it
       easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).

       If you can, avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix
       to  run	an  expensive shell process. If you're delivering via Procmail
       then running a shell won't make a noticeable difference	in  the	 total
       cost.

       Note:  if  you  use the mailbox_command feature to deliver mail system-
       wide, you must set up an alias that forwards mail for root  to  a  real
       user.

       The  precedence	of  local(8)  delivery	features  from high to low is:
       aliases,	 .forward  files,  mailbox_transport_maps,  mailbox_transport,
       mailbox_command_maps,  mailbox_command, home_mailbox, mail_spool_direc‐
       tory, fallback_transport_maps, fallback_transport and luser_relay.

       Examples:

       mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail
       mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
       mailbox_command = /some/where/maildrop -d "$USER"
	       -f "$SENDER" "$EXTENSION"

mailbox_command_maps (default: empty)
       Optional lookup tables with per-recipient external commands to use  for
       local(8) mailbox delivery.  Behavior is as with mailbox_command.

       The  precedence	of  local(8)  delivery	features  from high to low is:
       aliases,	 .forward  files,  mailbox_transport_maps,  mailbox_transport,
       mailbox_command_maps,  mailbox_command, home_mailbox, mail_spool_direc‐
       tory, fallback_transport_maps, fallback_transport and luser_relay.

mailbox_delivery_lock (default: see postconf -d output)
       How to lock a UNIX-style local(8) mailbox before	 attempting  delivery.
       For  a  list  of	 available file locking methods, use the "postconf -l"
       command.

       This setting is ignored	with  maildir  style  delivery,	 because  such
       deliveries are safe without explicit locks.

       Note:  The  dotlock  method  requires that the recipient UID or GID has
       write access to the parent directory of the mailbox file.

       Note: the default setting of this parameter is system dependent.

mailbox_size_limit (default: 51200000)
       The maximal size of any local(8) individual mailbox or maildir file, or
       zero  (no  limit).   In	fact, this limits the size of any file that is
       written to upon local delivery, including  files	 written  by  external
       commands that are executed by the local(8) delivery agent.

       This limit must not be smaller than the message size limit.

mailbox_transport (default: empty)
       Optional	 message  delivery  transport that the local(8) delivery agent
       should use for mailbox delivery to all local recipients, whether or not
       they are found in the UNIX passwd database.

       The  precedence	of  local(8)  delivery	features  from high to low is:
       aliases,	 .forward  files,  mailbox_transport_maps,  mailbox_transport,
       mailbox_command_maps,  mailbox_command, home_mailbox, mail_spool_direc‐
       tory, fallback_transport_maps, fallback_transport and luser_relay.

mailbox_transport_maps (default: empty)
       Optional lookup tables with per-recipient message  delivery  transports
       to use for local(8) mailbox delivery, whether or not the recipients are
       found in the UNIX passwd database.

       The precedence of local(8) delivery  features  from  high  to  low  is:
       aliases,	 .forward  files,  mailbox_transport_maps,  mailbox_transport,
       mailbox_command_maps, mailbox_command, home_mailbox,  mail_spool_direc‐
       tory, fallback_transport_maps, fallback_transport and luser_relay.

       For  safety  reasons, this feature does not allow $number substitutions
       in regular expression maps.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

mailq_path (default: see postconf -d output)
       Sendmail	 compatibility	feature	 that  specifies  where	 the   Postfix
       mailq(1)	 command  is  installed.  This command can be used to list the
       Postfix mail queue.

manpage_directory (default: see postconf -d output)
       Where the Postfix manual pages are installed.

maps_rbl_domains (default: empty)
       Obsolete feature: use the reject_rbl_client feature instead.

maps_rbl_reject_code (default: 554)
       The numerical Postfix SMTP server response  code	 when  a  remote  SMTP
       client	  request     is    blocked    by    the    reject_rbl_client,
       reject_rhsbl_client,  reject_rhsbl_reverse_client,  reject_rhsbl_sender
       or reject_rhsbl_recipient restriction.

       Do  not	change	this  unless  you have a complete understanding of RFC
       5321.

masquerade_classes (default: envelope_sender, header_sender, header_recipient)

       What addresses are subject to address masquerading.

       By   default,  address  masquerading  is	 limited  to  envelope	sender
       addresses, and to header sender and header recipient  addresses.	  This
       allows  you  to	use address masquerading on a mail gateway while still
       being able to forward mail to users on individual machines.

       Specify	zero  or   more	  of:	envelope_sender,   envelope_recipient,
       header_sender, header_recipient

masquerade_domains (default: empty)
       Optional list of domains whose subdomain structure will be stripped off
       in email addresses.

       The list is processed left to right, and processing stops at the	 first
       match.  Thus,

	   masquerade_domains = foo.example.com example.com

       strips  "user@any.thing.foo.example.com" to "user@foo.example.com", but
       strips "user@any.thing.else.example.com" to "user@example.com".

       A domain name prefixed with ! means do not masquerade  this  domain  or
       its subdomains. Thus,

	   masquerade_domains = !foo.example.com example.com

       does  not  change  "user@any.thing.foo.example.com"  or "user@foo.exam‐
       ple.com", but strips "user@any.thing.else.example.com"  to  "user@exam‐
       ple.com".

       Note:  with  Postfix  version  2.2, message header address masquerading
       happens only when message header address rewriting is enabled:

       ·      The message is received with the Postfix sendmail(1) command,

       ·      The message is received  from  a	network	 client	 that  matches
	      $local_header_rewrite_clients,

       ·      The   message   is   received   from   the   network,   and  the
	      remote_header_rewrite_domain  parameter  specifies  a  non-empty
	      value.

       To   get	  the	behavior   before   Postfix   version	2.2,   specify
       "local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all".

       Example:

       masquerade_domains = $mydomain

masquerade_exceptions (default: empty)
       Optional list of user names that are  not  subjected  to	 address  mas‐
       querading, even when their address matches $masquerade_domains.

       By default, address masquerading makes no exceptions.

       Specify	a  list	 of user names, "/file/name" or "type:table" patterns,
       separated by commas and/or whitespace. The  list	 is  matched  left  to
       right,  and the search stops on the first match. A "/file/name" pattern
       is replaced by its contents; a "type:table"  lookup  table  is  matched
       when  a name matches a lookup key (the lookup result is ignored).  Con‐
       tinue long lines by starting the next  line  with  whitespace.  Specify
       "!pattern"  to  exclude a name from the list. The form "!/file/name" is
       supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Examples:

       masquerade_exceptions = root, mailer-daemon
       masquerade_exceptions = root

master_service_disable (default: empty)
       Selectively disable master(8) listener ports by service type or by ser‐
       vice  name  and type.  Specify a list of service types ("inet", "unix",
       "fifo", or "pass") or "name.type" tuples, where	"name"	is  the	 first
       field  of a master.cf entry and "type" is a service type. As with other
       Postfix matchlists, a search stops at the first match.  Specify	"!pat‐
       tern"  to  exclude  a  service from the list. By default, all master(8)
       listener ports are enabled.

       Note: this feature does not support "/file/name" or  "type:table"  pat‐
       terns,  nor  does  it  support  wildcards such as "*" or "all". This is
       intentional.

       Examples:

       # Turn on all master(8) listener ports (the default).
       master_service_disable =
       # Turn off only the main SMTP listener port.
       master_service_disable = smtp.inet
       # Turn off all TCP/IP listener ports.
       master_service_disable = inet
       # Turn off all TCP/IP listener ports except "foo".
       master_service_disable = !foo.inet, inet

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

max_idle (default: 100s)
       The maximum amount of time that an idle Postfix	daemon	process	 waits
       for an incoming connection before terminating voluntarily.  This param‐
       eter is ignored by the Postfix queue manager and	 by  other  long-lived
       Postfix daemon processes.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

max_use (default: 100)
       The maximal number  of  incoming	 connections  that  a  Postfix	daemon
       process will service before terminating voluntarily.  This parameter is
       ignored by the Postfix queue manager and by  other  long-lived  Postfix
       daemon processes.

maximal_backoff_time (default: 4000s)
       The maximal time between attempts to deliver a deferred message.

       This parameter should be set to a value greater than or equal to $mini‐
       mal_backoff_time. See also $queue_run_delay.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

maximal_queue_lifetime (default: 5d)
       Consider	 a message as undeliverable, when delivery fails with a tempo‐
       rary  error,  and  the  time  in	 the  queue  has  reached  the	 maxi‐
       mal_queue_lifetime limit.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is d (days).

       Specify 0 when mail delivery should be tried only once.

message_reject_characters (default: empty)
       The set of characters that Postfix will reject in message content.  The
       usual C-like escape sequences are recognized: \a \b \f \n \r \t \v \ddd
       (up to three octal digits) and \\.

       Note 1: this feature does not recognize text that requires MIME	decod‐
       ing.  It	 inspects  raw	message	 content,  just like header_checks and
       body_checks.

       Note 2: this  feature  is  disabled  with  "receive_override_options  =
       no_header_body_checks".

       Example:

       message_reject_characters = \0

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

message_size_limit (default: 10240000)
       The maximal size in bytes of a message, including envelope information.

       Note:  be  careful  when making changes.	 Excessively small values will
       result in the loss of non-delivery notifications, when a bounce message
       size exceeds the local or remote MTA's message size limit.

message_strip_characters (default: empty)
       The  set	 of  characters that Postfix will remove from message content.
       The usual C-like escape sequences are recognized: \a \b \f \n \r \t  \v
       \ddd (up to three octal digits) and \\.

       Note  1: this feature does not recognize text that requires MIME decod‐
       ing. It inspects raw  message  content,	just  like  header_checks  and
       body_checks.

       Note  2:	 this  feature	is  disabled  with "receive_override_options =
       no_header_body_checks".

       Example:

       message_strip_characters = \0

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_command_timeout (default: 30s)
       The time limit for sending an SMTP command to a	Milter	(mail  filter)
       application, and for receiving the response.

       Specify	a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-
       letter suffix that specifies the time unit).

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_connect_macros (default: see postconf -d output)
       The  macros  that  are  sent to Milter (mail filter) applications after
       completion of an SMTP connection.  See  MILTER_README  for  a  list  of
       available macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_connect_timeout (default: 30s)
       The  time  limit	 for connecting to a Milter (mail filter) application,
       and for negotiating protocol options.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional  one-
       letter suffix that specifies the time unit).

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_content_timeout (default: 300s)
       The time limit for sending message content to a	Milter	(mail  filter)
       application, and for receiving the response.

       Specify	a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-
       letter suffix that specifies the time unit).

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_data_macros (default: see postconf -d output)
       The  macros  that  are sent to version 4 or higher Milter (mail filter)
       applications after the SMTP DATA command. See MILTER_README for a  list
       of available macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_default_action (default: tempfail)
       The  default action when a Milter (mail filter) application is unavail‐
       able or mis-configured. Specify one of the following:

       accept Proceed as if the mail filter was not present.

       reject Reject all further commands in this  session  with  a  permanent
	      status code.

       tempfail
	      Reject  all  further  commands  in this session with a temporary
	      status code.

       quarantine
	      Like "accept", but freeze	 the  message  in  the	"hold"	queue.
	      Available with Postfix 2.6 and later.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_end_of_data_macros (default: see postconf -d output)
       The macros that are sent to Milter (mail filter) applications after the
       message end-of-data. See MILTER_README for a list  of  available	 macro
       names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_end_of_header_macros (default: see postconf -d output)
       The macros that are sent to Milter (mail filter) applications after the
       end of the message header. See MILTER_README for a  list	 of  available
       macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

milter_header_checks (default: empty)
       Optional	 lookup	 tables for content inspection of message headers that
       are produced by Milter applications.  See the  header_checks(5)	manual
       page available actions. Currently, PREPEND is not implemented.

       The  following  example sends all mail that is marked as SPAM to a spam
       handling machine. Note that matches are case-insensitive by default.

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
	   milter_header_checks = pcre:/etc/postfix/milter_header_checks

       /etc/postfix/milter_header_checks:
	   /^X-SPAM-FLAG:\s+YES/ FILTER mysmtp:sanitizer.example.com:25

       The milter_header_checks mechanism could also be used for whitelisting.
       For example it could be used to skip heavy content inspection for DKIM-
       signed mail from known friendly domains.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7, and as an optional patch  for
       Postfix 2.6.

milter_helo_macros (default: see postconf -d output)
       The macros that are sent to Milter (mail filter) applications after the
       SMTP HELO or EHLO command. See MILTER_README for a  list	 of  available
       macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_macro_daemon_name (default: $myhostname)
       The  {daemon_name}  macro  value for Milter (mail filter) applications.
       See MILTER_README for a list of available macro names and  their	 mean‐
       ings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_macro_v (default: $mail_name $mail_version)
       The  {v}	 macro	value for Milter (mail filter) applications.  See MIL‐
       TER_README for a list of available macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_mail_macros (default: see postconf -d output)
       The macros that are sent to Milter (mail filter) applications after the
       SMTP MAIL FROM command. See MILTER_README for a list of available macro
       names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_protocol (default: 6)
       The mail filter protocol version and optional protocol  extensions  for
       communication  with  a  Milter  application;  prior  to Postfix 2.6 the
       default protocol is 2. Postfix sends this  version  number  during  the
       initial protocol handshake.  It should match the version number that is
       expected by the mail filter application (or by its Milter library).

       Protocol versions:

       2      Use Sendmail 8 mail filter  protocol  version  2	(default  with
	      Sendmail version 8.11 .. 8.13 and Postfix version 2.3 ..	2.5).

       3      Use Sendmail 8 mail filter protocol version 3.

       4      Use Sendmail 8 mail filter protocol version 4.

       6      Use  Sendmail  8	mail  filter  protocol version 6 (default with
	      Sendmail version 8.14 and Postfix version 2.6).

       Protocol extensions:

       no_header_reply
	      Specify this when the Milter application will not reply for each
	      individual message header.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_rcpt_macros (default: see postconf -d output)
       The macros that are sent to Milter (mail filter) applications after the
       SMTP RCPT TO command. See MILTER_README for a list of  available	 macro
       names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

milter_unknown_command_macros (default: see postconf -d output)
       The  macros  that  are sent to version 3 or higher Milter (mail filter)
       applications after an unknown SMTP command.  See	 MILTER_README	for  a
       list of available macro names and their meanings.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

mime_boundary_length_limit (default: 2048)
       The maximal length of MIME multipart boundary strings. The MIME proces‐
       sor is unable to distinguish between boundary strings that do not  dif‐
       fer in the first $mime_boundary_length_limit characters.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

mime_header_checks (default: $header_checks)
       Optional	 lookup	 tables for content inspection of MIME related message
       headers, as described in the header_checks(5) manual page.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

mime_nesting_limit (default: 100)
       The maximal recursion level that the MIME processor will handle.	 Post‐
       fix refuses mail that is nested deeper than the specified limit.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

minimal_backoff_time (default: 300s)
       The  minimal time between attempts to deliver a deferred message; prior
       to Postfix 2.4 the default value was 1000s.

       This parameter also limits the time an unreachable destination is  kept
       in the short-term, in-memory, destination status cache.

       This parameter should be set greater than or equal to $queue_run_delay.
       See also $maximal_backoff_time.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

multi_instance_directories (default: empty)
       An  optional  list  of  non-default  Postfix configuration directories;
       these directories belong to additional Postfix instances that share the
       Postfix	executable  files  and	documentation with the default Postfix
       instance, and that  are	started,  stopped,  etc.,  together  with  the
       default	Postfix	 instance.   Specify  a list of pathnames separated by
       comma or whitespace.

       When $multi_instance_directories is empty, the postfix(1) command  runs
       in single-instance mode and operates on a single Postfix instance only.
       Otherwise, the postfix(1)  command  runs	 in  multi-instance  mode  and
       invokes	  the	 multi-instance	   manager    specified	   with	   the
       multi_instance_wrapper parameter. The multi-instance  manager  in  turn
       executes postfix(1) commands for the default instance and for all Post‐
       fix instances in $multi_instance_directories.

       Currently, this parameter setting is ignored  except  for  the  default
       main.cf file.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

multi_instance_enable (default: no)
       Allow  this  Postfix instance to be started, stopped, etc., by a multi-
       instance manager.  By default, new instances  are  created  in  a  safe
       state that prevents them from being started inadvertently.  This param‐
       eter is reserved for the multi-instance manager.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

multi_instance_group (default: empty)
       The optional instance group name of  this  Postfix  instance.  A	 group
       identifies  closely-related  Postfix  instances that the multi-instance
       manager can start, stop, etc., as a unit.  This parameter  is  reserved
       for the multi-instance manager.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

multi_instance_name (default: empty)
       The  optional instance name of this Postfix instance. This name becomes
       also the default value for the syslog_name parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

multi_instance_wrapper (default: empty)
       The pathname of a multi-instance manager command	 that  the  postfix(1)
       command	invokes when the multi_instance_directories parameter value is
       non-empty. The pathname may be followed by  initial  command  arguments
       separated  by  whitespace;  shell metacharacters such as quotes are not
       supported in this context.

       The postfix(1) command invokes the manager command with the  postfix(1)
       non-option  command arguments on the manager command line, and with all
       installation configuration parameters exported into the manager command
       process environment. The manager command in turn invokes the postfix(1)
       command for individual Postfix instances as "postfix  -c	 config_direc‐
       tory command".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

multi_recipient_bounce_reject_code (default: 550)
       The  numerical  Postfix	SMTP  server  response code when a remote SMTP
       client request is blocked by the reject_multi_recipient_bounce restric‐
       tion.

       Do  not	change	this  unless  you have a complete understanding of RFC
       5321.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

mydestination (default: $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost)
       The list of domains that are delivered via  the	$local_transport  mail
       delivery	 transport.  By	 default this is the Postfix local(8) delivery
       agent which looks up all recipients in  /etc/passwd  and	 /etc/aliases.
       The  SMTP  server  validates  recipient	addresses  with $local_recipi‐
       ent_maps and rejects non-existent recipients. See also the local domain
       class in the ADDRESS_CLASS_README file.

       The  default  mydestination value specifies names for the local machine
       only.  On a mail domain gateway, you should also include $mydomain.

       The  $local_transport  delivery	method	is  also  selected  for	  mail
       addressed  to  user@[the.net.work.address]  of  the mail system (the IP
       addresses  specified  with  the	inet_interfaces	 and  proxy_interfaces
       parameters).

       Warnings:

       ·      Do  not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
	      specified elsewhere. See VIRTUAL_README for more information.

       ·      Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is	backup
	      MX host for. See STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README for how to set up
	      backup MX hosts.

       ·      By default, the Postfix SMTP server rejects mail for  recipients
	      not  listed  with	 the  local_recipient_maps parameter.  See the
	      postconf(5) manual for a description of the local_recipient_maps
	      and unknown_local_recipient_reject_code parameters.

       Specify	a  list	 of host or domain names, "/file/name" or "type:table"
       patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A "/file/name" pattern
       is  replaced  by	 its  contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched
       when a name matches a lookup key (the lookup result is ignored).	  Con‐
       tinue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.

       Examples:

       mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain $mydomain
       mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain

mydomain (default: see postconf -d output)
       The  internet  domain  name of this mail system.	 The default is to use
       $myhostname minus the first component, or  "localdomain"	 (Postfix  2.3
       and  later).   $mydomain is used as a default value for many other con‐
       figuration parameters.

       Example:

       mydomain = domain.tld

myhostname (default: see postconf -d output)
       The internet hostname of this mail system. The default is  to  use  the
       fully-qualified	domain	name  (FQDN) from gethostname(), or to use the
       non-FQDN result from gethostname() and append  ".$mydomain".   $myhost‐
       name  is	 used  as a default value for many other configuration parame‐
       ters.

       Example:

       myhostname = host.example.com

mynetworks (default: see postconf -d output)
       The list of "trusted" remote SMTP clients  that	have  more  privileges
       than "strangers".

       In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail through
       Postfix.	 See the smtpd_relay_restrictions parameter description in the
       postconf(5) manual.

       You  can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand or you
       can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).  See the descrip‐
       tion of the mynetworks_style parameter for more information.

       If  you specify the mynetworks list by hand, Postfix ignores the mynet‐
       works_style setting.

       Specify a list of network addresses or network/netmask patterns,	 sepa‐
       rated  by commas and/or whitespace. Continue long lines by starting the
       next line with whitespace.

       The netmask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a  host
       address.	  You  can also specify "/file/name" or "type:table" patterns.
       A "/file/name" pattern is replaced  by  its  contents;  a  "type:table"
       lookup table is matched when a table entry matches a lookup string (the
       lookup result is ignored).

       The list is matched left to right, and the search stops	on  the	 first
       match.	Specify "!pattern" to exclude an address or network block from
       the list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in  Postfix  version
       2.4 and later.

       Note:  IP  version 6 address information must be specified inside [] in
       the mynetworks value, and in files  specified  with  "/file/name".   IP
       version	6  addresses contain the ":" character, and would otherwise be
       confused with a "type:table" pattern.

       Examples:

       mynetworks = 127.0.0.0/8 168.100.189.0/28
       mynetworks = !192.168.0.1, 192.168.0.0/28
       mynetworks = 127.0.0.0/8 168.100.189.0/28 [::1]/128 [2001:240:587::]/64
       mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
       mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table

mynetworks_style (default: subnet)
       The method to generate the default value for the mynetworks  parameter.
       This is the list of trusted networks for relay access control etc.

       ·      Specify  "mynetworks_style  =  host" when Postfix should "trust"
	      only the local machine.

       ·      Specify "mynetworks_style = subnet" when Postfix should  "trust"
	      remote  SMTP  clients  in	 the  same IP subnetworks as the local
	      machine.	On Linux, this works correctly	only  with  interfaces
	      specified with the "ifconfig" command.

       ·      Specify  "mynetworks_style  = class" when Postfix should "trust"
	      remote SMTP clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks  as  the
	      local  machine.	Don't  do  this	 with a dialup site - it would
	      cause  Postfix  to  "trust"  your	 entire	 provider's   network.
	      Instead,	specify	 an  explicit  mynetworks  list	 by  hand,  as
	      described with the mynetworks configuration parameter.

myorigin (default: $myhostname)
       The domain name that locally-posted mail appears to come from, and that
       locally	posted mail is delivered to. The default, $myhostname, is ade‐
       quate for small sites.  If you run a domain with multiple machines, you
       should  (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up a domain-wide alias
       database that aliases each user to user@that.users.mailhost.

       Example:

       myorigin = $mydomain

nested_header_checks (default: $header_checks)
       Optional lookup tables for content inspection of non-MIME message head‐
       ers  in	attached messages, as described in the header_checks(5) manual
       page.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

newaliases_path (default: see postconf -d output)
       Sendmail compatibility feature  that  specifies	the  location  of  the
       newaliases(1) command. This command can be used to rebuild the local(8)
       aliases(5) database.

non_fqdn_reject_code (default: 504)
       The numerical Postfix SMTP server reply code when a client  request  is
       rejected	 by  the reject_non_fqdn_helo_hostname, reject_non_fqdn_sender
       or reject_non_fqdn_recipient restriction.

non_smtpd_milters (default: empty)
       A list of Milter (mail filter) applications for new mail that does  not
       arrive  via the Postfix smtpd(8) server. This includes local submission
       via the sendmail(1) command line, new mail that arrives via the Postfix
       qmqpd(8)	 server,  and old mail that is re-injected into the queue with
       "postsuper -r".	Specify space or comma	as  separator.	See  the  MIL‐
       TER_README document for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

notify_classes (default: resource, software)
       The  list  of  error  classes  that are reported to the postmaster. The
       default is to report only the most serious problems. The	 paranoid  may
       wish  to	 turn on the policy (UCE and mail relaying) and protocol error
       (broken mail software) reports.

       NOTE: postmaster notifications  may  contain  confidential  information
       such  as	 SASL passwords or message content.  It is the system adminis‐
       trator's responsibility to treat such information with care.

       The error classes are:

       bounce (also implies 2bounce)
	      Send the postmaster copies of the headers of bounced  mail,  and
	      send transcripts of SMTP sessions when Postfix rejects mail. The
	      notification  is	sent  to  the  address	specified   with   the
	      bounce_notice_recipient  configuration parameter (default: post‐
	      master).

       2bounce
	      Send undeliverable bounced mail to the postmaster. The notifica‐
	      tion    is    sent   to	the   address	specified   with   the
	      2bounce_notice_recipient configuration parameter (default: post‐
	      master).

       data   Send  the	 postmaster  a	transcript of the SMTP session with an
	      error because a critical data file was unavailable. The  notifi‐
	      cation   is   sent   to	the   address	specified   with   the
	      error_notice_recipient configuration parameter  (default:	 post‐
	      master).
	      This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

       delay  Send  the	 postmaster copies of the headers of delayed mail (see
	      delay_warning_time). The notification is	sent  to  the  address
	      specified	 with the delay_notice_recipient configuration parame‐
	      ter (default: postmaster).

       policy Send the postmaster a transcript of  the	SMTP  session  when  a
	      client request was rejected because of (UCE) policy. The notifi‐
	      cation   is   sent   to	the   address	specified   with   the
	      error_notice_recipient  configuration  parameter (default: post‐
	      master).

       protocol
	      Send the postmaster a transcript of the SMTP session in case  of
	      client  or  server  protocol errors. The notification is sent to
	      the address specified with the error_notice_recipient configura‐
	      tion parameter (default: postmaster).

       resource
	      Inform  the  postmaster  of  mail	 not delivered due to resource
	      problems.	 The notification is sent  to  the  address  specified
	      with    the   error_notice_recipient   configuration   parameter
	      (default: postmaster).

       software
	      Inform the postmaster of mail  not  delivered  due  to  software
	      problems.	  The  notification  is	 sent to the address specified
	      with   the   error_notice_recipient   configuration    parameter
	      (default: postmaster).

       Examples:

       notify_classes = bounce, delay, policy, protocol, resource, software
       notify_classes = 2bounce, resource, software

owner_request_special (default: yes)
       Give  special  treatment to owner-listname and listname-request address
       localparts: don't split such addresses when the recipient_delimiter  is
       set to "-".  This feature is useful for mailing lists.

parent_domain_matches_subdomains (default: see postconf -d output)
       What  Postfix  features match subdomains of "domain.tld" automatically,
       instead of  requiring  an  explicit  ".domain.tld"  pattern.   This  is
       planned	backwards compatibility:  eventually, all Postfix features are
       expected to require explicit  ".domain.tld"  style  patterns  when  you
       really want to match subdomains.

permit_mx_backup_networks (default: empty)
       Restrict	 the  use  of the permit_mx_backup SMTP access feature to only
       domains whose primary MX hosts match the listed networks.  The  parame‐
       ter  value  syntax  is the same as with the mynetworks parameter; note,
       however, that the default value is empty.

pickup_service_name (default: pickup)
       The name of the pickup(8) service. This service	picks  up  local  mail
       submissions from the Postfix maildrop queue.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

plaintext_reject_code (default: 450)
       The  numerical  Postfix	SMTP  server  response	code when a request is
       rejected by the reject_plaintext_session restriction.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

postmulti_control_commands (default: reload flush)
       The postfix(1) commands that the postmulti(1) instance  manager	treats
       as  "control"  commands,	 that  operate on running instances. For these
       commands, disabled instances are skipped.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

postmulti_start_commands (default: start)
       The postfix(1) commands that the postmulti(1) instance  manager	treats
       as  "start"  commands.  For  these  commands,  disabled	instances  are
       "checked" rather than  "started",  and  failure	to  "start"  a	member
       instance	 of  an	 instance  group  will	abort  the  start-up  of later
       instances.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

postmulti_stop_commands (default: see postconf -d output)
       The postfix(1) commands that the postmulti(1) instance  manager	treats
       as "stop" commands. For these commands, disabled instances are skipped,
       and enabled instances are processed in reverse order.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

postscreen_access_list (default: permit_mynetworks)
       Permanent  white/blacklist  for	remote	SMTP  client   IP   addresses.
       postscreen(8) searches this list immediately after a remote SMTP client
       connects.  Specify a comma- or whitespace-separated  list  of  commands
       (in  upper  or  lower case) or lookup tables. The search stops upon the
       first command that fires for the client IP address.

	permit_mynetworks
	      Whitelist the client and terminate the search if the  client  IP
	      address  matches	$mynetworks.  Do not subject the client to any
	      before/after 220 greeting tests.	Pass  the  connection  immedi‐
	      ately to a Postfix SMTP server process.

	type:table
	      Query the specified lookup table. Each table lookup result is an
	      access list, except that access  lists  inside  a	 table	cannot
	      specify type:table entries.
	      To  discourage  the use of hash, btree, etc. tables, there is no
	      support for substring matching like smtpd(8).  Use  CIDR	tables
	      instead.

	permit
	      Whitelist	 the  client  and terminate the search. Do not subject
	      the client to any before/after 220 greeting tests. Pass the con‐
	      nection immediately to a Postfix SMTP server process.

	reject
	      Blacklist	 the  client  and  terminate  the  search. Subject the
	      client to	 the  action  configured  with	the  postscreen_black‐
	      list_action configuration parameter.

	dunno All  postscreen(8)  access lists implicitly have this command at
	      the end.
	      When  dunno is executed inside a lookup table, return  from  the
	      lookup table and evaluate the next command.
	      When   dunno   is executed outside a lookup table, terminate the
	      search, and subject the client to	 the  configured  before/after
	      220 greeting tests.

       Example:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
	   postscreen_access_list = permit_mynetworks,
		 cidr:/etc/postfix/postscreen_access.cidr
	   postscreen_blacklist_action = enforce

       /etc/postfix/postscreen_access.cidr:
	   # Rules are evaluated in the order as specified.
	   # Blacklist 192.168.* except 192.168.0.1.
	   192.168.0.1	       dunno
	   192.168.0.0/16      reject

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_bare_newline_action (default: ignore)
       The  action  that postscreen(8) takes when a remote SMTP client sends a
       bare newline character, that is, a newline  not	preceded  by  carriage
       return.	Specify one of the following:

       ignore Ignore  the failure of this test. Allow other tests to complete.
	      Do not repeat this test before some the result from  some	 other
	      test  expires.  This option is useful for testing and collecting
	      statistics without blocking mail permanently.

       enforce
	      Allow other tests to complete. Reject attempts to	 deliver  mail
	      with  a 550 SMTP reply, and log the helo/sender/recipient infor‐
	      mation.  Repeat this test the next time the client connects.

       drop   Drop the connection immediately with a 521  SMTP	reply.	Repeat
	      this test the next time the client connects.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_bare_newline_enable (default: no)
       Enable  "bare newline" SMTP protocol tests in the postscreen(8) server.
       These tests are expensive: a remote SMTP client must  disconnect	 after
       it passes the test, before it can talk to a real Postfix SMTP server.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_bare_newline_ttl (default: 30d)
       The  amount  of time that postscreen(8) will use the result from a suc‐
       cessful "bare newline" SMTP protocol test. During this time, the client
       IP  address  is	excluded from this test. The default is long because a
       remote SMTP client must disconnect after it passes the test, before  it
       can talk to a real Postfix SMTP server.

       Specify	a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-
       letter suffix that specifies the time unit).  Time units: s  (seconds),
       m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_blacklist_action (default: ignore)
       The action that postscreen(8) takes when a remote SMTP client is perma‐
       nently blacklisted with the postscreen_access_list parameter.   Specify
       one of the following:

       ignore (default)
	      Ignore  this result. Allow other tests to complete.  Repeat this
	      test the next time the client connects.  This option  is	useful
	      for testing and collecting statistics without blocking mail.

       enforce
	      Allow  other  tests to complete. Reject attempts to deliver mail
	      with a 550 SMTP reply, and log the helo/sender/recipient	infor‐
	      mation.  Repeat this test the next time the client connects.

       drop   Drop  the	 connection  immediately with a 521 SMTP reply. Repeat
	      this test the next time the client connects.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_cache_cleanup_interval (default: 12h)
       The amount of time between postscreen(8)	 cache	cleanup	 runs.	 Cache
       cleanup	increases  the load on the cache database and should therefore
       not be run frequently. This feature requires that  the  cache  database
       supports	 the "delete" and "sequence" operators.	 Specify a zero inter‐
       val to disable cache cleanup.

       After each cache cleanup run, the postscreen(8) daemon logs the	number
       of  entries  that were retained and dropped. A cleanup run is logged as
       "partial" when the daemon  terminates  early  after  "postfix  reload",
       "postfix stop", or no requests for $max_idle seconds.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_cache_map (default: btree:$data_directory/postscreen_cache)
       Persistent storage for the postscreen(8) server decisions.

       To   share   a	postscreen(8)  cache  between  multiple	 postscreen(8)
       instances,  use	"postscreen_cache_map  =   proxy:btree:/path/to/file".
       This  requires Postfix version 2.9 or later; earlier proxymap(8) imple‐
       mentations don't support cache cleanup. For an alternative approach see
       the memcache_table(5) manpage.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_cache_retention_time (default: 7d)
       The  amount  of time that postscreen(8) will cache an expired temporary
       whitelist entry before it is removed. This prevents clients from	 being
       logged  as "NEW" just because their cache entry expired an hour ago. It
       also prevents the cache from filling up with clients that  passed  some
       deep protocol test once and never came back.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_client_connection_count_limit    (default:	 $smtpd_client_connec‐
       tion_count_limit)
       How many simultaneous connections any remote SMTP client is allowed  to
       have  with the postscreen(8) daemon. By default, this limit is the same
       as with the Postfix SMTP server. Note that the triage process can  take
       several	seconds,  with	the time spent in postscreen_greet_wait delay,
       and with the time spent talking to  the	postscreen(8)  built-in	 dummy
       SMTP protocol engine.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_command_count_limit (default: 20)
       The  limit  on  the  total  number  of  commands	 per  SMTP session for
       postscreen(8)'s built-in SMTP protocol engine.  This SMTP engine defers
       or  rejects all attempts to deliver mail, therefore there is no need to
       enforce separate limits on the number of junk commands and  error  com‐
       mands.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_command_filter (default: $smtpd_command_filter)
       A  mechanism  to	 transform  commands  from  remote  SMTP clients.  See
       smtpd_command_filter for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

postscreen_command_time_limit (default: ${stress?10}${stress:300}s)
       The time limit to read an  entire  command  line	 with  postscreen(8)'s
       built-in SMTP protocol engine.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_disable_vrfy_command (default: $disable_vrfy_command)
       Disable	the  SMTP  VRFY command in the postscreen(8) daemon.  See dis‐
       able_vrfy_command for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps	   (default:	   $smtpd_dis‐
       card_ehlo_keyword_address_maps)
       Lookup  tables,	indexed	 by  the remote SMTP client address, with case
       insensitive lists of EHLO keywords (pipelining, starttls,  auth,	 etc.)
       that  the  postscreen(8) server will not send in the EHLO response to a
       remote SMTP client. See smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords for	details.   The
       table is not searched by hostname for robustness reasons.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

postscreen_discard_ehlo_keywords (default: $smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords)
       A  case	insensitive list of EHLO keywords (pipelining, starttls, auth,
       etc.) that the postscreen(8) server will not send in the EHLO  response
       to a remote SMTP client. See smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

postscreen_dnsbl_action (default: ignore)
       The  action  that  postscreen(8) takes when a remote SMTP client's com‐
       bined DNSBL score is equal to or greater than a threshold  (as  defined
       with  the postscreen_dnsbl_sites and postscreen_dnsbl_threshold parame‐
       ters).  Specify one of the following:

       ignore (default)
	      Ignore the failure of this test. Allow other tests to  complete.
	      Repeat this test the next time the client connects.  This option
	      is useful for testing and collecting statistics without blocking
	      mail.

       enforce
	      Allow  other  tests to complete. Reject attempts to deliver mail
	      with a 550 SMTP reply, and log the helo/sender/recipient	infor‐
	      mation.  Repeat this test the next time the client connects.

       drop   Drop  the	 connection  immediately with a 521 SMTP reply. Repeat
	      this test the next time the client connects.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_dnsbl_reply_map (default: empty)
       A mapping from actual DNSBL domain name which includes a	 secret	 pass‐
       word,  to the DNSBL domain name that postscreen will reply with when it
       rejects mail.  When no mapping is found, the actual DNSBL  domain  will
       be used.

       For maximal stability it is best to use a file that is read into memory
       such as pcre:, regexp: or texthash: (texthash:  is  similar  to	hash:,
       except  a)  there  is  no need to run postmap(1) before the file can be
       used, and b) texthash: does not detect changes after the file is read).

       Example:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
	   postscreen_dnsbl_reply_map = texthash:/etc/postfix/dnsbl_reply

       /etc/postfix/dnsbl_reply:
	  secret.zen.spamhaus.org    zen.spamhaus.org

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_dnsbl_sites (default: empty)
       Optional list of DNS white/blacklist domains, filters and  weight  fac‐
       tors.  When  the	 list  is  non-empty, the dnsblog(8) daemon will query
       these domains with  the	IP  addresses  of  remote  SMTP	 clients,  and
       postscreen(8)  will  update an SMTP client's DNSBL score with each non-
       error reply.

       Caution: when postscreen rejects mail, it replies with the DNSBL domain
       name.  Use  the	postscreen_dnsbl_reply_map  feature to hide "password"
       information in DNSBL domain names.

       When a client's score is equal to or greater than the threshold	speci‐
       fied  with  postscreen_dnsbl_threshold, postscreen(8) can drop the con‐
       nection with the remote SMTP client.

       Specify a list of domain=filter*weight entries, separated by  comma  or
       whitespace.

       ·      When  no "=filter" is specified, postscreen(8) will use any non-
	      error DNSBL reply.  Otherwise,  postscreen(8)  uses  only	 DNSBL
	      replies  that match the filter. The filter has the form d.d.d.d,
	      where each d is a number, or a pattern inside []	that  contains
	      one or more ";"-separated numbers or number..number ranges.

       ·      When  no	"*weight"  is  specified, postscreen(8) increments the
	      remote SMTP client's DNSBL score by 1.   Otherwise,  the	weight
	      must be an integral number, and postscreen(8) adds the specified
	      weight to the remote SMTP client's DNSBL score.  Specify a nega‐
	      tive number for whitelisting.

       ·      When  one	 postscreen_dnsbl_sites	 entry produces multiple DNSBL
	      responses, postscreen(8) applies the weight at most once.

       Examples:

       To use example.com as a high-confidence blocklist, and  to  block  mail
       with example.net and example.org only when both agree:

       postscreen_dnsbl_threshold = 2
       postscreen_dnsbl_sites = example.com*2, example.net, example.org

       To filter only DNSBL replies containing 127.0.0.4:

       postscreen_dnsbl_sites = example.com=127.0.0.4

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_dnsbl_threshold (default: 1)
       The  inclusive  lower bound for blocking a remote SMTP client, based on
       its combined DNSBL score as  defined  with  the	postscreen_dnsbl_sites
       parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_dnsbl_ttl (default: 1h)
       The  amount  of time that postscreen(8) will use the result from a suc‐
       cessful DNS blocklist test. During this time, the client IP address  is
       excluded	 from  this  test.  The default is relatively short, because a
       good client can immediately talk to a real Postfix SMTP server.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional  one-
       letter  suffix that specifies the time unit).  Time units: s (seconds),
       m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_enforce_tls (default: $smtpd_enforce_tls)
       Mandatory TLS: announce STARTTLS support to remote  SMTP	 clients,  and
       require	    that      clients	  use	  TLS	  encryption.	   See
       smtpd_postscreen_enforce_tls for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and  later.   Preferably,  use
       postscreen_tls_security_level instead.

postscreen_expansion_filter (default: see postconf -d output)
       List  of	 characters  that  are	permitted  in postscreen_reject_footer
       attribute expansions.  See smtpd_expansion_filter for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

postscreen_forbidden_commands (default: $smtpd_forbidden_commands)
       List of commands that the postscreen(8) server considers	 in  violation
       of  the	SMTP  protocol.	 See  smtpd_forbidden_commands for syntax, and
       postscreen_non_smtp_command_action for possible actions.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_greet_action (default: ignore)
       The action that postscreen(8) takes when a remote  SMTP	client	speaks
       before	 its	turn	within	  the	 time	specified   with   the
       postscreen_greet_wait parameter.	 Specify one of the following:

       ignore (default)
	      Ignore the failure of this test. Allow other tests to  complete.
	      Repeat this test the next time the client connects.  This option
	      is useful for testing and collecting statistics without blocking
	      mail.

       enforce
	      Allow  other  tests to complete. Reject attempts to deliver mail
	      with a 550 SMTP reply, and log the helo/sender/recipient	infor‐
	      mation.  Repeat this test the next time the client connects.

       drop   Drop  the	 connection  immediately with a 521 SMTP reply. Repeat
	      this test the next time the client connects.

       In either case, postscreen(8) will not whitelist the remote SMTP client
       IP address.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_greet_banner (default: $smtpd_banner)
       The   text   in	 the   optional	 "220-text..."	server	response  that
       postscreen(8) sends ahead  of  the  real	 Postfix  SMTP	server's  "220
       text..."	 response,  in	an attempt to confuse bad SMTP clients so that
       they speak before their turn (pre-greet).  Specify an  empty  value  to
       disable this feature.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_greet_ttl (default: 1d)
       The  amount  of time that postscreen(8) will use the result from a suc‐
       cessful PREGREET test. During this  time,  the  client  IP  address  is
       excluded	 from  this  test.  The default is relatively short, because a
       good client can immediately talk to a real Postfix SMTP server.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional  one-
       letter  suffix that specifies the time unit).  Time units: s (seconds),
       m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_greet_wait (default: ${stress?2}${stress:6}s)
       The amount of time that postscreen(8) will wait for an SMTP  client  to
       send a command before its turn, and for DNS blocklist lookup results to
       arrive (default: up to 2 seconds under stress, up to 6  seconds	other‐
       wise).

       Specify	a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-
       letter suffix that specifies the time unit).

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_helo_required (default: $smtpd_helo_required)
       Require that a remote SMTP client sends HELO or EHLO before  commencing
       a MAIL transaction.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_non_smtp_command_action (default: drop)
       The  action  that  postscreen(8)	 takes when a remote SMTP client sends
       non-SMTP commands as specified with  the	 postscreen_forbidden_commands
       parameter.  Specify one of the following:

       ignore Ignore  the failure of this test. Allow other tests to complete.
	      Do not repeat this test before some the result from  some	 other
	      test  expires.  This option is useful for testing and collecting
	      statistics without blocking mail permanently.

       enforce
	      Allow other tests to complete. Reject attempts to	 deliver  mail
	      with  a 550 SMTP reply, and log the helo/sender/recipient infor‐
	      mation.  Repeat this test the next time the client connects.

       drop   Drop the connection immediately with a 521  SMTP	reply.	Repeat
	      this  test the next time the client connects. This action is the
	      same as with the Postfix SMTP server's  smtpd_forbidden_commands
	      feature.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_non_smtp_command_enable (default: no)
       Enable  "non-SMTP  command"  tests  in  the postscreen(8) server. These
       tests are expensive: a client must disconnect after it passes the test,
       before it can talk to a real Postfix SMTP server.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_non_smtp_command_ttl (default: 30d)
       The  amount  of time that postscreen(8) will use the result from a suc‐
       cessful "non_smtp_command" SMTP protocol test. During  this  time,  the
       client  IP  address  is	excluded  from	this test. The default is long
       because a client must disconnect after it passes the  test,  before  it
       can talk to a real Postfix SMTP server.

       Specify	a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-
       letter suffix that specifies the time unit).  Time units: s  (seconds),
       m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_pipelining_action (default: enforce)
       The  action  that  postscreen(8)	 takes when a remote SMTP client sends
       multiple commands instead of sending one command and  waiting  for  the
       server to respond.  Specify one of the following:

       ignore Ignore  the failure of this test. Allow other tests to complete.
	      Do not repeat this test before some the result from  some	 other
	      test  expires.  This option is useful for testing and collecting
	      statistics without blocking mail permanently.

       enforce
	      Allow other tests to complete. Reject attempts to	 deliver  mail
	      with  a 550 SMTP reply, and log the helo/sender/recipient infor‐
	      mation.  Repeat this test the next time the client connects.

       drop   Drop the connection immediately with a 521  SMTP	reply.	Repeat
	      this test the next time the client connects.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_pipelining_enable (default: no)
       Enable  "pipelining"  SMTP  protocol tests in the postscreen(8) server.
       These tests are expensive: a  good  client  must	 disconnect  after  it
       passes the test, before it can talk to a real Postfix SMTP server.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_pipelining_ttl (default: 30d)
       The  amount  of time that postscreen(8) will use the result from a suc‐
       cessful "pipelining" SMTP protocol test. During this time,  the	client
       IP  address  is	excluded from this test. The default is long because a
       good client must disconnect after it passes the	test,  before  it  can
       talk to a real Postfix SMTP server.

       Specify	a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional one-
       letter suffix that specifies the time unit).  Time units: s  (seconds),
       m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_post_queue_limit (default: $default_process_limit)
       The number of clients that can be waiting for service from a real Post‐
       fix SMTP server process. When this queue	 is  full,  all	 clients  will
       receive a 421 response.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_pre_queue_limit (default: $default_process_limit)
       The  number  of non-whitelisted clients that can be waiting for a deci‐
       sion whether they will receive service from a real Postfix SMTP	server
       process.	 When  this  queue  is	full, all non-whitelisted clients will
       receive a 421 response.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_reject_footer (default: $smtpd_reject_footer)
       Optional information that is appended after a 4XX or 5XX	 postscreen(8)
       server response. See smtpd_reject_footer for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

postscreen_tls_security_level (default: $smtpd_tls_security_level)
       The  SMTP  TLS security level for the postscreen(8) server; when a non-
       empty value  is	specified,  this  overrides  the  obsolete  parameters
       postscreen_use_tls   and	 postscreen_enforce_tls.  See  smtpd_tls_secu‐
       rity_level for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

postscreen_upstream_proxy_protocol (default: empty)
       The name of the proxy protocol used by  an  optional  before-postscreen
       proxy  agent.  When  a proxy agent is used, this protocol conveys local
       and    remote	 address     and     port     information.     Specify
       "postscreen_upstream_proxy_protocol  =  haproxy"	 to enable the haproxy
       protocol.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.10 and later.

postscreen_upstream_proxy_timeout (default: 5s)
       The  time  limit	 for   the   proxy   protocol	specified   with   the
       postscreen_upstream_proxy_protocol parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.10 and later.

postscreen_use_tls (default: $smtpd_use_tls)
       Opportunistic  TLS:  announce  STARTTLS support to remote SMTP clients,
       but do not require that clients use TLS encryption.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and  later.   Preferably,  use
       postscreen_tls_security_level instead.

postscreen_watchdog_timeout (default: 10s)
       How  much  time a postscreen(8) process may take to respond to a remote
       SMTP client command or to perform a cache operation before it is termi‐
       nated  by  a  built-in watchdog timer.  This is a safety mechanism that
       prevents postscreen(8) from becoming non-responsive due	to  a  bug  in
       Postfix itself or in system software.  To avoid false alarms and unnec‐
       essary cache corruption this limit cannot be set under 10s.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional  one-
       letter  suffix that specifies the time unit).  Time units: s (seconds),
       m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

postscreen_whitelist_interfaces (default: static:all)
       A list  of  local  postscreen(8)	 server	 IP  addresses	where  a  non-
       whitelisted  remote  SMTP  client  can obtain postscreen(8)'s temporary
       whitelist status. This status is required before the client can talk to
       a  Postfix  SMTP	 server	 process.   By	default,  a  client can obtain
       postscreen(8)'s whitelist status on any local postscreen(8)  server  IP
       address.

       When postscreen(8) listens on both primary and backup MX addresses, the
       postscreen_whitelist_interfaces parameter can be configured to give the
       temporary  whitelist status only when a client connects to a primary MX
       address. Once a client is whitelisted it can talk  to  a	 Postfix  SMTP
       server  on  any	address.  Thus, clients that connect only to backup MX
       addresses will never become whitelisted, and will never be  allowed  to
       talk to a Postfix SMTP server process.

       Specify	a list of network addresses or network/netmask patterns, sepa‐
       rated by commas and/or whitespace. The netmask specifies the number  of
       bits  in	 the  network  part  of a host address. Continue long lines by
       starting the next line with whitespace.

       You  can	 also  specify	"/file/name"  or  "type:table"	patterns.    A
       "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup
       table is matched when a table entry matches a lookup string (the lookup
       result is ignored).

       The  list  is  matched left to right, and the search stops on the first
       match. Specify "!pattern" to exclude an address or network  block  from
       the list.

       Note:  IP  version 6 address information must be specified inside [] in
       the postscreen_whitelist_interfaces value, and in files specified  with
       "/file/name".   IP  version  6 addresses contain the ":" character, and
       would otherwise be confused with a "type:table" pattern.

       Example:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
	   # Don't whitelist connections to the backup IP address.
	   postscreen_whitelist_interfaces = !168.100.189.8, static:all

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

prepend_delivered_header (default: command, file, forward)
       The message delivery contexts where the Postfix local(8) delivery agent
       prepends a Delivered-To:	 message header with the address that the mail
       was delivered to. This information  is  used  for  mail	delivery  loop
       detection.

       By  default,  the Postfix local delivery agent prepends a Delivered-To:
       header when forwarding mail and when delivering to file	(mailbox)  and
       command.	 Turning  off the Delivered-To: header when forwarding mail is
       not recommended.

       Specify zero or more of forward, file, or command.

       Example:

       prepend_delivered_header = forward

process_id (read-only)
       The process ID of a Postfix command or daemon process.

process_id_directory (default: pid)
       The location of Postfix PID files relative to  $queue_directory.	  This
       is a read-only parameter.

process_name (read-only)
       The process name of a Postfix command or daemon process.

propagate_unmatched_extensions (default: canonical, virtual)
       What  address  lookup  tables copy an address extension from the lookup
       key to the lookup result.

       For  example,  with  a  virtual(5)  mapping  of	 "joe@example.com   =>
       joe.user@example.net",  the address "joe+foo@example.com" would rewrite
       to "joe.user+foo@example.net".

       Specify zero or more of canonical, virtual, alias, forward, include  or
       generic.	 These	cause address extension propagation with canonical(5),
       virtual(5), and aliases(5) maps, with local(8) .forward	and  :include:
       file lookups, and with smtp(8) generic maps, respectively.

       Note:  enabling this feature for types other than canonical and virtual
       is likely to cause problems when mail  is  forwarded  to	 other	sites,
       especially with mail that is sent to a mailing list exploder address.

       Examples:

       propagate_unmatched_extensions = canonical, virtual, alias,
	       forward, include
       propagate_unmatched_extensions = canonical, virtual

proxy_interfaces (default: empty)
       The  network interface addresses that this mail system receives mail on
       by way of a proxy or network address translation unit.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

       You must specify your "outside" proxy/NAT addresses when your system is
       a  backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops will
       happen when the primary MX host is down.

       Example:

       proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4

proxy_read_maps (default: see postconf -d output)
       The lookup tables that the proxymap(8) server is allowed to access  for
       the  read-only  service.	 Table references that don't begin with proxy:
       are ignored.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

proxy_write_maps (default: see postconf -d output)
       The lookup tables that the proxymap(8) server is allowed to access  for
       the  read-write	service.  Postfix-owned local database files should be
       stored under the Postfix-owned data_directory.  Table  references  that
       don't begin with proxy: are ignored.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

proxymap_service_name (default: proxymap)
       The  name of the proxymap read-only table lookup service.  This service
       is normally implemented by the proxymap(8) daemon.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

proxywrite_service_name (default: proxywrite)
       The name of the proxywrite read-write table lookup service.  This  ser‐
       vice is normally implemented by the proxymap(8) daemon.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

qmgr_clog_warn_time (default: 300s)
       The minimal delay between warnings that a specific destination is clog‐
       ging up the Postfix active queue. Specify 0 to disable.

       This feature is enabled with the helpful_warnings parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

qmgr_daemon_timeout (default: 1000s)
       How much time a Postfix queue manager process  may  take	 to  handle  a
       request before it is terminated by a built-in watchdog timer.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

qmgr_fudge_factor (default: 100)
       Obsolete feature: the percentage of delivery resources that a busy mail
       system will use up for delivery of a large mailing  list message.

       This feature exists only in the oqmgr(8) old queue manager. The current
       queue manager solves the problem in a better way.

qmgr_ipc_timeout (default: 60s)
       The time limit for the queue manager to	send  or  receive  information
       over an internal communication channel.	The purpose is to break out of
       deadlock situations. If the time limit is exceeded the software	either
       retries or aborts the operation.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

qmgr_message_active_limit (default: 20000)
       The maximal number of messages in the active queue.

qmgr_message_recipient_limit (default: 20000)
       The maximal number of recipients held in memory by  the	Postfix	 queue
       manager,	 and the maximal size of the short-term, in-memory "dead" des‐
       tination status cache.

qmgr_message_recipient_minimum (default: 10)
       The minimal number of in-memory recipients for any message. This	 takes
       priority	 over  any  other in-memory recipient limits (i.e., the global
       qmgr_message_recipient_limit and the per transport _recipient_limit) if
       necessary. The minimum value allowed for this parameter is 1.

qmqpd_authorized_clients (default: empty)
       What  remote  QMQP  clients  are allowed to connect to the Postfix QMQP
       server port.

       By default, no client is allowed to use the service.  This  is  because
       the QMQP server will relay mail to any destination.

       Specify	a  list	 of  client  patterns. A list pattern specifies a host
       name, a domain name, an internet address, or  a	network/mask  pattern,
       where  the mask specifies the number of bits in the network part.  When
       a pattern specifies a file name, its contents are substituted  for  the
       file  name; when a pattern is a "type:table" table specification, table
       lookup is used instead.

       Patterns are separated by whitespace and/or commas. In order to reverse
       the  result,  precede a pattern with an exclamation point (!). The form
       "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Example:

       qmqpd_authorized_clients = !192.168.0.1, 192.168.0.0/24

qmqpd_client_port_logging (default: no)
       Enable logging of the remote QMQP client port in addition to the	 host‐
       name and IP address. The logging format is "host[address]:port".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

qmqpd_error_delay (default: 1s)
       How  long  the Postfix QMQP server will pause before sending a negative
       reply to the remote QMQP client. The purpose is to slow	down  confused
       or malicious clients.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

qmqpd_timeout (default: 300s)
       The time limit for sending or receiving information over	 the  network.
       If  a  read or write operation blocks for more than $qmqpd_timeout sec‐
       onds the Postfix QMQP server gives up and disconnects.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

queue_directory (default: see postconf -d output)
       The location of the Postfix top-level queue directory. This is the root
       directory of Postfix daemon processes that run chrooted.

queue_file_attribute_count_limit (default: 100)
       The maximal number of (name=value) attributes that may be stored	 in  a
       Postfix queue file. The limit is enforced by the cleanup(8) server.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

queue_minfree (default: 0)
       The minimal amount of free space in bytes in the queue file system that
       is needed to receive mail.  This is currently used by the Postfix  SMTP
       server to decide if it will accept any mail at all.

       By default, the Postfix SMTP server rejects MAIL FROM commands when the
       amount of free space is less than 1.5*$message_size_limit (Postfix ver‐
       sion  2.1  and  later).	 To specify a higher minimum free space limit,
       specify a queue_minfree value that is at least 1.5*$message_size_limit.

       With Postfix versions 2.0 and earlier, a queue_minfree  value  of  zero
       means there is no minimum required amount of free space.

queue_run_delay (default: 300s)
       The  time  between  deferred queue scans by the queue manager; prior to
       Postfix 2.4 the default value was 1000s.

       This parameter should be set  less  than	 or  equal  to	$minimal_back‐
       off_time. See also $maximal_backoff_time.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

queue_service_name (default: qmgr)
       The name of the qmgr(8) service. This service manages the Postfix queue
       and schedules delivery requests.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

rbl_reply_maps (default: empty)
       Optional	 lookup	 tables	 with  RBL  response templates. The tables are
       indexed by the RBL domain name. By default, Postfix  uses  the  default
       template	 as specified with the default_rbl_reply configuration parame‐
       ter. See there for a discussion of the syntax of RBL reply templates.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

readme_directory (default: see postconf -d output)
       The location of Postfix README files that describe how to  build,  con‐
       figure or operate a specific Postfix subsystem or feature.

receive_override_options (default: empty)
       Enable  or disable recipient validation, built-in content filtering, or
       address mapping. Typically, these are specified in  master.cf  as  com‐
       mand-line arguments for the smtpd(8), qmqpd(8) or pickup(8) daemons.

       Specify	zero  or  more of the following options.  The options override
       main.cf settings and are either implemented by smtpd(8),	 qmqpd(8),  or
       pickup(8) themselves, or they are forwarded to the cleanup server.

       no_unknown_recipient_checks
	      Do  not  try  to	reject	unknown recipients (SMTP server only).
	      This is typically specified AFTER an external content filter.

       no_address_mappings
	      Disable canonical address mapping, virtual alias map  expansion,
	      address  masquerading,  and  automatic  BCC  (blind carbon-copy)
	      recipients. This is typically specified BEFORE an external  con‐
	      tent filter.

       no_header_body_checks
	      Disable header/body_checks. This is typically specified AFTER an
	      external content filter.

       no_milters
	      Disable Milter (mail filter)  applications.  This	 is  typically
	      specified AFTER an external content filter.

       Note: when the "BEFORE content filter" receive_override_options setting
       is specified in the main.cf file, specify the  "AFTER  content  filter"
       receive_override_options setting in master.cf (and vice versa).

       Examples:

       receive_override_options =
	   no_unknown_recipient_checks, no_header_body_checks
       receive_override_options = no_address_mappings

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

recipient_bcc_maps (default: empty)
       Optional	 BCC  (blind  carbon-copy)  address  lookup tables, indexed by
       recipient address.  The BCC address  (multiple  results	are  not  sup‐
       ported) is added when mail enters from outside of Postfix.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       The table search order is as follows:

       ·      Look  up	the  "user+extension@domain.tld" address including the
	      optional address extension.

       ·      Look up  the  "user@domain.tld"  address	without	 the  optional
	      address extension.

       ·      Look up the "user+extension" address local part when the recipi‐
	      ent domain equals $myorigin, $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or
	      $proxy_interfaces.

       ·      Look  up the "user" address local part when the recipient domain
	      equals   $myorigin,    $mydestination,	$inet_interfaces    or
	      $proxy_interfaces.

       ·      Look up the "@domain.tld" part.

       Specify	the  types  and	 names of databases to use.  After change, run
       "postmap /etc/postfix/recipient_bcc".

       Note: with Postfix 2.3 and later the BCC address is added as if it  was
       specified  with	NOTIFY=NONE.  The sender will not be notified when the
       BCC address is undeliverable,  as  long	as  all	 down-stream  software
       implements RFC 3461.

       Note: with Postfix 2.2 and earlier the sender will be notified when the
       BCC address is undeliverable.

       Note: automatic BCC recipients are produced  only  for  new  mail.   To
       avoid  mailer  loops,  automatic BCC recipients are not generated after
       Postfix forwards mail  internally,  or  after  Postfix  generates  mail
       itself.

       Example:

       recipient_bcc_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/recipient_bcc

recipient_canonical_classes (default: envelope_recipient, header_recipient)
       What addresses are subject to recipient_canonical_maps address mapping.
       By default, recipient_canonical_maps  address  mapping  is  applied  to
       envelope recipient addresses, and to header recipient addresses.

       Specify one or more of: envelope_recipient, header_recipient

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

recipient_canonical_maps (default: empty)
       Optional	 address mapping lookup tables for envelope and header recipi‐
       ent addresses.  The table format and lookups are documented in  canoni‐
       cal(5).

       Note: $recipient_canonical_maps is processed before $canonical_maps.

       Example:

       recipient_canonical_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/recipient_canonical

recipient_delimiter (default: empty)
       The  separator  between	user  names and address extensions (user+foo).
       See canonical(5), local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects
       this has on aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and on .forward file
       lookups.	 Basically,  the  software  tries  user+foo  and  .forward+foo
       before trying user and .forward.

       Example:

       recipient_delimiter = +

reject_code (default: 554)
       The  numerical  Postfix	SMTP  server  response code when a remote SMTP
       client request is rejected by the "reject" restriction.

       Do not change this unless you have  a  complete	understanding  of  RFC
       5321.

reject_tempfail_action (default: defer_if_permit)
       The  Postfix  SMTP server's action when a reject-type restriction fails
       due to a temporary error condition. Specify "defer" to defer the remote
       SMTP  client  request  immediately.  With the default "defer_if_permit"
       action, the Postfix SMTP server continues to look for opportunities  to
       reject  mail,  and defers the client request only if it would otherwise
       be accepted.

       For finer control, see:	unverified_recipient_tempfail_action,  unveri‐
       fied_sender_tempfail_action,    unknown_address_tempfail_action,	   and
       unknown_helo_hostname_tempfail_action.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

relay_clientcerts (default: empty)
       List of tables with remote SMTP client-certificate fingerprints or pub‐
       lic key fingerprints (Postfix 2.9 and later) for which the Postfix SMTP
       server will allow access with the permit_tls_clientcerts feature.   The
       fingerprint  digest algorithm is configurable via the smtpd_tls_finger‐
       print_digest parameter (hard-coded as  md5  prior  to  Postfix  version
       2.5).

       Postfix	lookup tables are in the form of (key, value) pairs.  Since we
       only need the key, the value can be chosen freely, e.g.	 the  name  of
       the   user   or	host:  D7:04:2F:A7:0B:8C:A5:21:FA:31:77:E1:41:8A:EE:80
       lutzpc.at.home

       Example:

       relay_clientcerts = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_clientcerts

       For more fine-grained control,  use  check_ccert_access	to  select  an
       appropriate   access(5)	 policy	  for	each   client.	 See  RESTRIC‐
       TION_CLASS_README.

       Note: Postfix 2.9.0–2.9.5 computed	 the  public  key  fingerprint
       incorrectly.  To	 use public-key fingerprints, upgrade to Postfix 2.9.6
       or later.

       This feature is available with Postfix version 2.2.

relay_destination_concurrency_limit   (default:	  $default_destination_concur‐
       rency_limit)
       The  maximal  number of parallel deliveries to the same destination via
       the relay message delivery transport. This limit	 is  enforced  by  the
       queue  manager.	The message delivery transport name is the first field
       in the entry in the master.cf file.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

relay_destination_recipient_limit    (default:	  $default_destination_recipi‐
       ent_limit)
       The  maximal  number  of	 recipients  per message for the relay message
       delivery transport. This limit is enforced by the  queue	 manager.  The
       message	delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in the
       master.cf file.

       Setting this  parameter	to  a  value  of  1  changes  the  meaning  of
       relay_destination_concurrency_limit  from  concurrency  per domain into
       concurrency per recipient.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

relay_domains (default: $mydestination)
       What destination domains (and  subdomains  thereof)  this  system  will
       relay   mail  to.  Subdomain  matching  is  controlled  with  the  par‐
       ent_domain_matches_subdomains parameter.	 For  details  about  how  the
       relay_domains   value   is  used,  see  the  description	 of  the  per‐
       mit_auth_destination  and  reject_unauth_destination   SMTP   recipient
       restrictions.

       Domains	that match $relay_domains are delivered with the $relay_trans‐
       port mail delivery  transport.  The  SMTP  server  validates  recipient
       addresses  with	$relay_recipient_maps and rejects non-existent recipi‐
       ents.   See   also   the	  relay	  domains   address   class   in   the
       ADDRESS_CLASS_README file.

       Note: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that list
       this  system  as	 their	primary	 or  backup  MX	 host.	See  the  per‐
       mit_mx_backup restriction in the postconf(5) manual page.

       Specify	a  list	 of  host  or  domain  names, "/file/name" patterns or
       "type:table" lookup tables,  separated  by  commas  and/or  whitespace.
       Continue	 long  lines  by  starting  the	 next  line with whitespace. A
       "/file/name" pattern is replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup
       table  is matched when a (parent) domain appears as lookup key. Specify
       "!pattern" to exclude a domain from the list. The form "!/file/name" is
       supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

relay_domains_reject_code (default: 554)
       The  numerical  Postfix SMTP server response code when a client request
       is rejected by the reject_unauth_destination recipient restriction.

       Do not change this unless you have  a  complete	understanding  of  RFC
       5321.

relay_recipient_maps (default: empty)
       Optional	 lookup	 tables	 with  all valid addresses in the domains that
       match $relay_domains. Specify @domain as a wild-card for	 domains  that
       have  no valid recipient list, and become a source of backscatter mail:
       Postfix accepts spam for non-existent recipients and then floods	 inno‐
       cent  people  with undeliverable mail.  Technically, tables listed with
       $relay_recipient_maps are used as lists: Postfix needs to know only  if
       a  lookup  string  is found or not, but it does not use the result from
       table lookup.

       If this parameter is non-empty,	then  the  Postfix  SMTP  server  will
       reject mail to unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.

       See  also  the  relay domains address class in the ADDRESS_CLASS_README
       file.

       Example:

       relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

relay_transport (default: relay)
       The default mail delivery transport and next-hop destination for remote
       delivery	 to domains listed with $relay_domains. In order of decreasing
       precedence, the nexthop destination  is	taken  from  $relay_transport,
       $sender_dependent_relayhost_maps,  $relayhost,  or  from	 the recipient
       domain. This information can be overruled with the transport(5) table.

       Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is  the
       name  of	 a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf.  The :nexthop
       destination is optional; its syntax is documented in the manual page of
       the corresponding delivery agent.

       See  also  the  relay domains address class in the ADDRESS_CLASS_README
       file.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

relayhost (default: empty)
       The next-hop destination of non-local mail; overrides non-local domains
       in recipient addresses. This information is overruled with relay_trans‐
       port,	sender_dependent_default_transport_maps,    default_transport,
       sender_dependent_relayhost_maps and with the transport(5) table.

       On  an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your inter‐
       nal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of	the  intranet  gateway
       host instead.

       In  the	case  of SMTP, specify a domain name, hostname, hostname:port,
       [hostname]:port, [hostaddress] or [hostaddress]:port. The  form	[host‐
       name] turns off MX lookups.

       If  you're  connected  via  UUCP,  see  the UUCP_README file for useful
       information.

       Examples:

       relayhost = $mydomain
       relayhost = [gateway.example.com]
       relayhost = uucphost
       relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]

relocated_maps (default: empty)
       Optional lookup tables  with  new  contact  information	for  users  or
       domains	that  no longer exist.	The table format and lookups are docu‐
       mented in relocated(5).

       If you use this feature, run "postmap /etc/postfix/relocated" to	 build
       the  necessary  DBM  or	DB file after change, then "postfix reload" to
       make the changes visible.

       Examples:

       relocated_maps = dbm:/etc/postfix/relocated
       relocated_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relocated

remote_header_rewrite_domain (default: empty)
       Don't rewrite message headers from remote  clients  at  all  when  this
       parameter  is  empty; otherwise, rewrite message headers and append the
       specified domain name to incomplete  addresses.	 The  local_header_re‐
       write_clients parameter controls what clients Postfix considers local.

       Examples:

       The   safe   setting:  append  "domain.invalid"	to  incomplete	header
       addresses from remote SMTP clients, so that those addresses  cannot  be
       confused with local addresses.

	   remote_header_rewrite_domain = domain.invalid

       The default, purist, setting: don't rewrite headers from remote clients
       at all.

	   remote_header_rewrite_domain =

require_home_directory (default: no)
       Require that a local(8) recipient's home directory exists  before  mail
       delivery	 is  attempted.	 By  default this test is disabled.  It can be
       useful for environments that import home directories to the mail server
       (IMPORTING HOME DIRECTORIES IS NOT RECOMMENDED).

reset_owner_alias (default: no)
       Reset  the local(8) delivery agent's idea of the owner-alias attribute,
       when delivering mail to a child alias that does not have its own	 owner
       alias.

       This  feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later. With older Postfix
       releases, the behavior is as if this parameter is set to "yes".

       As documented in aliases(5), when an alias name has a  companion	 alias
       named  owner-name,  delivery errors will be reported to the owner alias
       instead of the sender. This configuration is  recommended  for  mailing
       lists.

       A  less	known  property	 of the owner alias is that it also forces the
       local(8) delivery agent to write local and remote addresses from	 alias
       expansion to a new queue file, instead of attempting to deliver mail to
       local addresses as soon as they come out of alias expansion.

       Writing local addresses from alias expansion to a new queue file allows
       for robust handling of temporary delivery errors: errors with one local
       member have no effect on deliveries to other members of the  list.   On
       the other hand, delivery to local addresses as soon as they come out of
       alias expansion is fragile: a temporary error with  one	local  address
       from alias expansion will cause the entire alias to be expanded repeat‐
       edly until the error goes away, or until the  message  expires  in  the
       queue.	In that case, a problem with one list member results in multi‐
       ple message deliveries to other list members.

       The default behavior of Postfix 2.8 and later is	 to  keep  the	owner-
       alias  attribute	 of  the parent alias, when delivering mail to a child
       alias that does not have its own owner  alias.  Then,  local  addresses
       from that child alias will be written to a new queue file, and a tempo‐
       rary error with one local address will not  affect  delivery  to	 other
       mailing list members.

       Unfortunately,  older  Postfix releases reset the owner-alias attribute
       when delivering mail to a child alias that does not have its own	 owner
       alias.	The  local(8)  delivery	 agent	then attempts to deliver local
       addresses as soon as they come out of child alias expansion.  If deliv‐
       ery  to	any  address from child alias expansion fails with a temporary
       error condition, the entire mailing list	 may  be  expanded  repeatedly
       until  the  mail expires in the queue, resulting in multiple deliveries
       of the same message to mailing list members.

resolve_dequoted_address (default: yes)
       Resolve a recipient address safely instead  of  correctly,  by  looking
       inside quotes.

       By  default,  the  Postfix  address resolver does not quote the address
       localpart as per RFC 822, so that additional @ or  %  or	 !   operators
       remain visible. This behavior is safe but it is also technically incor‐
       rect.

       If you  specify	"resolve_dequoted_address  =  no",  then  the  Postfix
       resolver will not know about additional @ etc. operators in the address
       localpart. This opens opportunities for obscure mail relay attacks with
       user@domain@domain  addresses  when  Postfix provides backup MX service
       for Sendmail systems.

resolve_null_domain (default: no)
       Resolve an address that ends in the "@" null domain  as	if  the	 local
       hostname were specified, instead of rejecting the address as invalid.

       This  feature  is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.  Earlier versions
       always resolve the null domain as the local hostname.

       The Postfix SMTP server uses this feature to reject  mail  from	or  to
       addresses  that end in the "@" null domain, and from addresses that re‐
       write into a form that ends in the "@" null domain.

resolve_numeric_domain (default: no)
       Resolve "user@ipaddress" as "user@[ipaddress]",	instead	 of  rejecting
       the address as invalid.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

rewrite_service_name (default: rewrite)
       The  name  of  the  address  rewriting  service.	 This service rewrites
       addresses to standard form and resolves them  to	 a  (delivery  method,
       next-hop host, recipient) triple.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

sample_directory (default: /etc/postfix)
       The  name  of  the  directory with example Postfix configuration files.
       Starting with Postfix 2.1, these files  have  been  replaced  with  the
       postconf(5) manual page.

send_cyrus_sasl_authzid (default: no)
       When  authenticating  to	 a remote SMTP or LMTP server with the default
       setting "no", send no SASL authoriZation ID (authzid);  send  only  the
       SASL authentiCation ID (authcid) plus the authcid's password.

       The  non-default	 setting  "yes"	 enables the behavior of older Postfix
       versions.  These always send a SASL authzid that is equal to  the  SASL
       authcid,	 but  this  causes  inter-operability  problems with some SMTP
       servers.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4.4 and later.

sender_based_routing (default: no)
       This parameter should not be used. It  was  replaced  by	 sender_depen‐
       dent_relayhost_maps in Postfix version 2.3.

sender_bcc_maps (default: empty)
       Optional	 BCC  (blind  carbon-copy)  address  lookup tables, indexed by
       sender address.	The BCC address (multiple results are  not  supported)
       is added when mail enters from outside of Postfix.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       The table search order is as follows:

       ·      Look  up	the  "user+extension@domain.tld" address including the
	      optional address extension.

       ·      Look up  the  "user@domain.tld"  address	without	 the  optional
	      address extension.

       ·      Look  up the "user+extension" address local part when the sender
	      domain equals  $myorigin,	 $mydestination,  $inet_interfaces  or
	      $proxy_interfaces.

       ·      Look  up	the  "user"  address local part when the sender domain
	      equals   $myorigin,    $mydestination,	$inet_interfaces    or
	      $proxy_interfaces.

       ·      Look up the "@domain.tld" part.

       Specify	the  types  and	 names of databases to use.  After change, run
       "postmap /etc/postfix/sender_bcc".

       Note: with Postfix 2.3 and later the BCC address is added as if it  was
       specified  with	NOTIFY=NONE.  The sender will not be notified when the
       BCC address is undeliverable,  as  long	as  all	 down-stream  software
       implements RFC 3461.

       Note: with Postfix 2.2 and earlier the sender will be notified when the
       BCC address is undeliverable.

       Note: automatic BCC recipients are produced  only  for  new  mail.   To
       avoid  mailer  loops,  automatic BCC recipients are not generated after
       Postfix forwards mail  internally,  or  after  Postfix  generates  mail
       itself.

       Example:

       sender_bcc_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/sender_bcc

sender_canonical_classes (default: envelope_sender, header_sender)
       What  addresses	are  subject to sender_canonical_maps address mapping.
       By default, sender_canonical_maps address mapping is applied  to	 enve‐
       lope sender addresses, and to header sender addresses.

       Specify one or more of: envelope_sender, header_sender

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

sender_canonical_maps (default: empty)
       Optional	 address  mapping lookup tables for envelope and header sender
       addresses.  The table format and	 lookups  are  documented  in  canoni‐
       cal(5).

       Example:	 you  want to rewrite the SENDER address "user@ugly.domain" to
       "user@pretty.domain", while still being able to send mail to the RECIP‐
       IENT address "user@ugly.domain".

       Note: $sender_canonical_maps is processed before $canonical_maps.

       Example:

       sender_canonical_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/sender_canonical

sender_dependent_default_transport_maps (default: empty)
       A  sender-dependent override for the global default_transport parameter
       setting. The tables are searched by the	envelope  sender  address  and
       @domain.	 A  lookup result of DUNNO terminates the search without over‐
       riding the global default_transport parameter setting.	This  informa‐
       tion is overruled with the transport(5) table.

       Note:  this overrides default_transport, not transport_maps, and there‐
       fore the expected syntax is that of default_transport, not  the	syntax
       of  transport_maps.   Specifically,  this  does	not support the trans‐
       port_maps syntax for  null  transport,  null  nexthop,  or  null	 email
       addresses.

       For  safety  reasons, this feature does not allow $number substitutions
       in regular expression maps.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

sender_dependent_relayhost_maps (default: empty)
       A sender-dependent override for the global relayhost parameter setting.
       The  tables  are searched by the envelope sender address and @domain. A
       lookup result of DUNNO terminates the  search  without  overriding  the
       global relayhost parameter setting (Postfix 2.6 and later). This infor‐
       mation	 is    overruled    with    relay_transport,	 sender_depen‐
       dent_default_transport_maps,  default_transport	and  with  the	trans‐
       port(5) table.

       For safety reasons, this feature does not allow	$number	 substitutions
       in regular expression maps.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

sendmail_fix_line_endings (default: always)
       Controls	 how  the Postfix sendmail command converts email message line
       endings from <CR><LF> into UNIX format (<LF>).

       always Always convert message lines ending in <CR><LF>. This setting is
	      the default with Postfix 2.9 and later.

       strict Convert message lines ending in <CR><LF> only if the first input
	      line ends in <CR><LF>. This setting is backwards-compatible with
	      Postfix 2.8 and earlier.

       never  Never  convert  message  lines  ending in <CR><LF>. This setting
	      exists for completeness only.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

sendmail_path (default: see postconf -d output)
       A Sendmail compatibility feature that specifies	the  location  of  the
       Postfix	sendmail(1)  command.  This command can be used to submit mail
       into the Postfix queue.

service_throttle_time (default: 60s)
       How long the Postfix master(8)  waits  before  forking  a  server  that
       appears to be malfunctioning.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

setgid_group (default: postdrop)
       The group ownership of set-gid Postfix commands and  of	group-writable
       Postfix	directories.  When this parameter value is changed you need to
       re-run "postfix set-permissions" (with Postfix version 2.0 and earlier:
       "/etc/postfix/post-install set-permissions".

show_user_unknown_table_name (default: yes)
       Display	the  name  of  the  recipient  table  in  the  "User  unknown"
       responses.  The extra detail makes trouble  shooting  easier  but  also
       reveals information that is nobody elses business.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

showq_service_name (default: showq)
       The name of the showq(8) service. This service produces mail queue sta‐
       tus reports.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

smtp_address_preference (default: any)
       The address type ("ipv6", "ipv4" or "any") that the Postfix SMTP client
       will  try  first,  when	a destination has IPv6 and IPv4 addresses with
       equal MX preference. This feature has no effect unless the  inet_proto‐
       cols  setting enables both IPv4 and IPv6.  With Postfix 2.8 the default
       is "ipv6".

       Notes for mail delivery between sites that have both IPv4 and IPv6 con‐
       nectivity:

       ·      The  setting "smtp_address_preference = ipv6" is unsafe.	It can
	      fail to deliver mail when there is an outage that affects	 IPv6,
	      while the destination is still reachable over IPv4.

       ·      The  setting "smtp_address_preference = any" is safe. With this,
	      mail will eventually be delivered even if	 there	is  an	outage
	      that affects IPv6 or IPv4, as long as it does not affect both.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

smtp_always_send_ehlo (default: yes)
       Always send EHLO at the start of an SMTP session.

       With  "smtp_always_send_ehlo  = no", the Postfix SMTP client sends EHLO
       only when the word "ESMTP" appears in the server greeting banner (exam‐
       ple: 220 spike.porcupine.org ESMTP Postfix).

smtp_bind_address (default: empty)
       An  optional  numerical	network	 address  that the Postfix SMTP client
       should bind to when making an IPv4 connection.

       This can be specified in the main.cf file for all SMTP clients,	or  it
       can be specified in the master.cf file for a specific client, for exam‐
       ple:

	   /etc/postfix/master.cf:
	       smtp ... smtp -o smtp_bind_address=11.22.33.44

       Note 1: when inet_interfaces specifies no more than one	IPv4  address,
       and that address is a non-loopback address, it is automatically used as
       the smtp_bind_address.  This supports virtual IP hosting, but can be  a
       problem on multi-homed firewalls. See the inet_interfaces documentation
       for more detail.

       Note 2: address information may be enclosed inside [], but this form is
       not required here.

smtp_bind_address6 (default: empty)
       An  optional  numerical	network	 address  that the Postfix SMTP client
       should bind to when making an IPv6 connection.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       This can be specified in the main.cf file for all SMTP clients,	or  it
       can be specified in the master.cf file for a specific client, for exam‐
       ple:

	   /etc/postfix/master.cf:
	       smtp ... smtp -o smtp_bind_address6=1:2:3:4:5:6:7:8

       Note 1: when inet_interfaces specifies no more than one	IPv6  address,
       and that address is a non-loopback address, it is automatically used as
       the smtp_bind_address6.	This supports virtual IP hosting, but can be a
       problem on multi-homed firewalls. See the inet_interfaces documentation
       for more detail.

       Note 2: address information may be enclosed inside [], but this form is
       not recommended here.

smtp_body_checks (default: empty)
       Restricted  body_checks(5)  tables  for the Postfix SMTP client.	 These
       tables are searched while mail is being delivered.  Actions that change
       the delivery time or destination are not available.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_cname_overrides_servername (default: version dependent)
       Allow  DNS  CNAME  records  to override the servername that the Postfix
       SMTP client uses for logging, SASL password lookup,  TLS	 policy	 deci‐
       sions,  or TLS certificate verification. The value "no" hardens Postfix
       smtp_tls_per_site hostname-based policies against false hostname infor‐
       mation  in DNS CNAME records, and makes SASL password file lookups more
       predictable. This is the default setting as of Postfix 2.3.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2.9 and later.

smtp_connect_timeout (default: 30s)
       The Postfix SMTP client time limit for completing a TCP connection,  or
       zero (use the operating system built-in time limit).

       When  no	 connection  can be made within the deadline, the Postfix SMTP
       client tries the next address on the mail exchanger list. Specify 0  to
       disable the time limit (i.e. use whatever timeout is implemented by the
       operating system).

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

smtp_connection_cache_destinations (default: empty)
       Permanently  enable  SMTP connection caching for the specified destina‐
       tions.  With SMTP connection caching, a connection is not closed	 imme‐
       diately	after  completion of a mail transaction.  Instead, the connec‐
       tion is kept open for up to $smtp_connection_cache_time_limit  seconds.
       This  allows  connections  to  be  reused for other deliveries, and can
       improve mail delivery performance.

       Specify a comma or  white  space	 separated  list  of  destinations  or
       pseudo-destinations:

       ·      if  mail is sent without a relay host: a domain name (the right-
	      hand side of an email address, without the [] around  a  numeric
	      IP address),

       ·      if  mail is sent via a relay host: a relay host name (without []
	      or non-default TCP port), as specified  in  main.cf  or  in  the
	      transport map,

       ·      if  mail	is  sent via a UNIX-domain socket: a pathname (without
	      the unix: prefix),

       ·      a /file/name with	 domain	 names	and/or	relay  host  names  as
	      defined above,

       ·      a	 "type:table" with domain names and/or relay host names on the
	      left-hand side.  The right-hand side  result  from  "type:table"
	      lookups is ignored.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_connection_cache_on_demand (default: yes)
       Temporarily  enable  SMTP  connection caching while a destination has a
       high volume of mail in the active queue.	 With SMTP connection caching,
       a  connection  is  not  closed  immediately  after completion of a mail
       transaction.  Instead, the connection is kept open for up to $smtp_con‐
       nection_cache_time_limit seconds.  This allows connections to be reused
       for other deliveries, and can improve mail delivery performance.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_connection_cache_reuse_limit (default: 10)
       When SMTP connection caching is enabled, the number of  times  that  an
       SMTP session may be reused before it is closed.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2. In Postfix 2.3 it is replaced
       by $smtp_connection_reuse_time_limit.

smtp_connection_cache_time_limit (default: 2s)
       When SMTP connection caching is enabled, the amount  of	time  that  an
       unused  SMTP  client  socket  is kept open before it is closed.	Do not
       specify larger values without permission from the remote sites.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_connection_reuse_time_limit (default: 300s)
       The amount of time during which Postfix will  use  an  SMTP  connection
       repeatedly.  The timer starts when the connection is initiated (i.e. it
       includes the connect, greeting and helo latency,	 in  addition  to  the
       latencies of subsequent mail delivery transactions).

       This feature addresses a performance stability problem with remote SMTP
       servers. This problem is not specific to Postfix: it  can  happen  when
       any  MTA	 sends large amounts of SMTP email to a site that has multiple
       MX hosts.

       The problem starts when one of a set of MX hosts	 becomes  slower  than
       the  rest.   Even though SMTP clients connect to fast and slow MX hosts
       with equal probability, the slow MX host ends up with more simultaneous
       inbound	connections than the faster MX hosts, because the slow MX host
       needs more time to serve each client request.

       The slow MX host becomes	 a  connection	attractor.   If	 one  MX  host
       becomes	N  times  slower  than	the  rest,  it dominates mail delivery
       latency unless there are more than N  fast  MX  hosts  to  counter  the
       effect.	And  if	 the  number  of  MX hosts is smaller than N, the mail
       delivery latency becomes	 effectively  that  of	the  slowest  MX  host
       divided by the total number of MX hosts.

       The solution uses connection caching in a way that differs from Postfix
       version 2.2.  By limiting the amount of time during which a  connection
       can  be	used  repeatedly (instead of limiting the number of deliveries
       over that connection), Postfix not only restores fairness in  the  dis‐
       tribution of simultaneous connections across a set of MX hosts, it also
       favors deliveries over connections that perform well, which is  exactly
       what we want.

       The  default  reuse time limit, 300s, is comparable to the various smtp
       transaction timeouts which are fair estimates of maximum excess latency
       for  a slow delivery.  Note that hosts may accept thousands of messages
       over a single connection	 within	 the  default  connection  reuse  time
       limit.  This number is much larger than the default Postfix version 2.2
       limit of 10 messages per cached connection. It may prove	 necessary  to
       lower the limit to avoid interoperability issues with MTAs that exhibit
       bugs when many messages are delivered via a single connection.  A lower
       reuse  time limit risks losing the benefit of connection reuse when the
       average connection and mail delivery latency  exceeds  the  reuse  time
       limit.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_data_done_timeout (default: 600s)
       The  Postfix  SMTP  client time limit for sending the SMTP ".", and for
       receiving the remote SMTP server response.

       When no response is received within the deadline, a warning  is	logged
       that the mail may be delivered multiple times.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

smtp_data_init_timeout (default: 120s)
       The Postfix SMTP client time limit for sending the SMTP	DATA  command,
       and for receiving the remote SMTP server response.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

smtp_data_xfer_timeout (default: 180s)
       The Postfix SMTP client time limit for sending the  SMTP	 message  con‐
       tent.	When   the   connection	  makes	 no  progress  for  more  than
       $smtp_data_xfer_timeout seconds the Postfix SMTP client terminates  the
       transfer.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

smtp_defer_if_no_mx_address_found (default: no)
       Defer mail delivery when no MX record resolves to an IP address.

       The default (no) is to return the mail  as  undeliverable.  With	 older
       Postfix	versions  the  default	was to keep trying to deliver the mail
       until someone fixed the MX record or until the mail was too old.

       Note: the Postfix SMTP client always ignores MX records with  equal  or
       worse preference than the local MTA itself.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtp_destination_concurrency_limit    (default:	  $default_destination_concur‐
       rency_limit)
       The maximal number of parallel deliveries to the same  destination  via
       the  smtp  message  delivery  transport.	 This limit is enforced by the
       queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the  first	 field
       in the entry in the master.cf file.

smtp_destination_recipient_limit     (default:	  $default_destination_recipi‐
       ent_limit)
       The maximal number of recipients	 per  message  for  the	 smtp  message
       delivery	 transport.  This  limit is enforced by the queue manager. The
       message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in  the
       master.cf file.

       Setting this parameter to a value of 1 changes the meaning of smtp_des‐
       tination_concurrency_limit from concurrency per domain into concurrency
       per recipient.

smtp_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps (default: empty)
       Lookup  tables,	indexed	 by  the remote SMTP server address, with case
       insensitive lists of EHLO keywords (pipelining, starttls,  auth,	 etc.)
       that  the  Postfix  SMTP client will ignore in the EHLO response from a
       remote SMTP server. See smtp_discard_ehlo_keywords for details. The ta‐
       ble  is	not  indexed  by  hostname  for	 consistency  with  smtpd_dis‐
       card_ehlo_keyword_address_maps.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_discard_ehlo_keywords (default: empty)
       A case insensitive list of EHLO keywords (pipelining,  starttls,	 auth,
       etc.)  that  the	 Postfix  SMTP client will ignore in the EHLO response
       from a remote SMTP server.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Notes:

       ·      Specify the silent-discard pseudo keyword to prevent this action
	      from being logged.

       ·      Use  the	smtp_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps feature to dis‐
	      card EHLO keywords selectively.

smtp_dns_resolver_options (default: empty)
       DNS Resolver options for the Postfix SMTP client.  Specify zero or more
       of  the	following  options,  separated by comma or whitespace.	Option
       names are case-sensitive. Some options refer to domain names  that  are
       specified in the file /etc/resolv.conf or equivalent.

       res_defnames
	      Append  the current domain name to single-component names (those
	      that do not contain a "." character). This can produce incorrect
	      results, and is the hard-coded behavior prior to Postfix 2.8.

       res_dnsrch
	      Search  for  host	 names	in  the	 current  domain and in parent
	      domains. This can produce incorrect results and is therefore not
	      recommended.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

smtp_enforce_tls (default: no)
       Enforcement  mode: require that remote SMTP servers use TLS encryption,
       and never send mail in the clear.  This also requires that  the	remote
       SMTP  server hostname matches the information in the remote server cer‐
       tificate, and that the remote SMTP server certificate was issued	 by  a
       CA  that	 is  trusted  by  the  Postfix SMTP client. If the certificate
       doesn't verify or the hostname doesn't match, delivery is deferred  and
       mail stays in the queue.

       The  server  hostname is matched against all names provided as dNSNames
       in the SubjectAlternativeName.  If no dNSNames are specified, the  Com‐
       monName	 is   checked.	  The	behavior   may	be  changed  with  the
       smtp_tls_enforce_peername option.

       This option is useful only if you are definitely	 sure  that  you  will
       only  connect to servers that support RFC 2487 _and_ that provide valid
       server certificates.  Typical use is for clients that  send  all	 their
       email to a dedicated mailhub.

       This  feature  is  available in Postfix 2.2 and later. With Postfix 2.3
       and later use smtp_tls_security_level instead.

smtp_fallback_relay (default: $fallback_relay)
       Optional list of relay hosts for SMTP destinations that can't be	 found
       or that are unreachable. With Postfix 2.2 and earlier this parameter is
       called fallback_relay.

       By default, mail is returned to the sender when a  destination  is  not
       found, and delivery is deferred when a destination is unreachable.

       With  bulk  email  deliveries, it can be beneficial to run the fallback
       relay MTA on the same host, so that it can reuse the sender IP address.
       This  speeds up deliveries that are delayed by IP-based reputation sys‐
       tems (greylist, etc.).

       The fallback relays must be SMTP destinations. Specify a domain,	 host,
       host:port,  [host]:port,	 [address]  or [address]:port; the form [host]
       turns off MX lookups.  If you specify multiple SMTP destinations, Post‐
       fix will try them in the specified order.

       To  prevent  mailer loops between MX hosts and fall-back hosts, Postfix
       version 2.2 and later will not use the fallback relays for destinations
       that it is MX host for (assuming DNS lookup is turned on).

smtp_generic_maps (default: empty)
       Optional	 lookup	 tables	 that perform address rewriting in the Postfix
       SMTP client, typically to transform a  locally  valid  address  into  a
       globally	 valid address when sending mail across the Internet.  This is
       needed when the local machine does not have  its	 own  Internet	domain
       name, but uses something like localdomain.local instead.

       The table format and lookups are documented in generic(5); examples are
       shown in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README
       documents.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_header_checks (default: empty)
       Restricted  header_checks(5) tables for the Postfix SMTP client.	 These
       tables are searched while mail is being delivered.  Actions that change
       the delivery time or destination are not available.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_helo_name (default: $myhostname)
       The hostname to send in the SMTP EHLO or HELO command.

       The  default  value  is	the  machine  hostname.	 Specify a hostname or
       [ip.add.re.ss].

       This information can be specified in the	 main.cf  file	for  all  SMTP
       clients,	 or  it	 can be specified in the master.cf file for a specific
       client, for example:

	   /etc/postfix/master.cf:
	       mysmtp ... smtp -o smtp_helo_name=foo.bar.com

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

smtp_helo_timeout (default: 300s)
       The Postfix SMTP client time limit for sending the HELO	or  EHLO  com‐
       mand, and for receiving the initial remote SMTP server response.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

smtp_host_lookup (default: dns)
       What mechanisms the Postfix SMTP client uses to look  up	 a  host's  IP
       address.	 This parameter is ignored when DNS lookups are disabled (see:
       disable_dns_lookups).

       Specify one of the following:

       dns    Hosts can be found in the DNS (preferred).

       native Use the native naming service only (nsswitch.conf, or equivalent
	      mechanism).

       dns, native
	      Use the native service for hosts not found in the DNS.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtp_line_length_limit (default: 998)
       The  maximal  length of message header and body lines that Postfix will
       send via SMTP. This limit does not include the <CR><LF> at the  end  of
       each  line.  Longer lines are broken by inserting "<CR><LF><SPACE>", to
       minimize the damage to MIME formatted mail.

       The Postfix limit of 998 characters not including <CR><LF>  is  consis‐
       tent  with  the	SMTP limit of 1000 characters including <CR><LF>.  The
       Postfix limit was 990 with Postfix 2.8 and earlier.

smtp_mail_timeout (default: 300s)
       The Postfix SMTP client time limit for sending the MAIL	FROM  command,
       and for receiving the remote SMTP server response.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

smtp_mime_header_checks (default: empty)
       Restricted mime_header_checks(5) tables for the	Postfix	 SMTP  client.
       These  tables are searched while mail is being delivered.  Actions that
       change the delivery time or destination are not available.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_mx_address_limit (default: 5)
       The maximal number of MX (mail exchanger) IP addresses that can	result
       from  Postfix  SMTP  client mail exchanger lookups, or zero (no limit).
       Prior to Postfix version 2.3, this limit was disabled by default.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtp_mx_session_limit (default: 2)
       The maximal number of SMTP sessions per	delivery  request  before  the
       Postfix	SMTP client gives up or delivers to a fall-back relay host, or
       zero (no limit). This restriction ignores sessions that	fail  to  com‐
       plete  the  SMTP initial handshake (Postfix version 2.2 and earlier) or
       that fail to complete the EHLO and TLS handshake (Postfix  version  2.3
       and later).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtp_nested_header_checks (default: empty)
       Restricted  nested_header_checks(5) tables for the Postfix SMTP client.
       These tables are searched while mail is being delivered.	 Actions  that
       change the delivery time or destination are not available.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_never_send_ehlo (default: no)
       Never  send  EHLO  at  the  start  of  an  SMTP	session.  See also the
       smtp_always_send_ehlo parameter.

smtp_per_record_deadline (default: no)
       Change the behavior of the smtp_*_timeout  time	limits,	 from  a  time
       limit per read or write system call, to a time limit to send or receive
       a complete record (an SMTP command line, SMTP response line, SMTP  mes‐
       sage  content  line,  or TLS protocol message).	This limits the impact
       from hostile peers that trickle data one byte at a time.

       Note: when per-record deadlines are enabled, a short timeout may	 cause
       problems	 with TLS over very slow network connections.  The reasons are
       that a TLS protocol message can be up to 16 kbytes long	(with  TLSv1),
       and that an entire TLS protocol message must be sent or received within
       the per-record deadline.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later. With older  Postfix
       releases, the behavior is as if this parameter is set to "no".

smtp_pix_workaround_delay_time (default: 10s)
       How  long  the Postfix SMTP client pauses before sending ".<CR><LF>" in
       order to work around the PIX firewall "<CR><LF>.<CR><LF>" bug.

       Choosing a too short time makes this workaround ineffective when	 send‐
       ing large messages over slow network connections.

smtp_pix_workaround_maps (default: empty)
       Lookup tables, indexed by the remote SMTP server address, with per-des‐
       tination workarounds for CISCO PIX firewall bugs.   The	table  is  not
       indexed	 by   hostname	for  consistency  with	smtp_discard_ehlo_key‐
       word_address_maps.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later.

smtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time (default: 500s)
       How long a message must be queued before the Postfix SMTP client	 turns
       on  the	PIX  firewall  "<CR><LF>.<CR><LF>" bug workaround for delivery
       through firewalls with "smtp fixup" mode turned on.

       By default, the workaround is turned off for mail that  is  queued  for
       less  than  500	seconds.  In  other  words, the workaround is normally
       turned off for the first delivery attempt.

       Specify 0 to enable the PIX firewall "<CR><LF>.<CR><LF>" bug workaround
       upon the first delivery attempt.

smtp_pix_workarounds (default: disable_esmtp, delay_dotcrlf)
       A  list	that specifies zero or more workarounds for CISCO PIX firewall
       bugs. These workarounds are implemented by  the	Postfix	 SMTP  client.
       Workaround names are separated by comma or space, and are case insensi‐
       tive.  This parameter setting can  be  overruled	 with  per-destination
       smtp_pix_workaround_maps settings.

       delay_dotcrlf
	      Insert  a	 delay before sending ".<CR><LF>" after the end of the
	      message content.	The delay is  subject  to  the	smtp_pix_work‐
	      around_delay_time and smtp_pix_workaround_threshold_time parame‐
	      ter settings.

       disable_esmtp
	      Disable all extended SMTP commands: send HELO instead of EHLO.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later.  The	 default  set‐
       tings are backwards compatible with earlier Postfix versions.

smtp_quit_timeout (default: 300s)
       The  Postfix  SMTP  client time limit for sending the QUIT command, and
       for receiving the remote SMTP server response.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

smtp_quote_rfc821_envelope (default: yes)
       Quote  addresses	 in Postfix SMTP client MAIL FROM and RCPT TO commands
       as required by RFC 5321. This includes putting quotes around an address
       localpart that ends in ".".

       The  default  is to comply with RFC 5321. If you have to send mail to a
       broken SMTP server, configure a special SMTP client in master.cf:

	   /etc/postfix/master.cf:
	       broken-smtp . . . smtp -o smtp_quote_rfc821_envelope=no

       and route mail for the destination in  question	to  the	 "broken-smtp"
       message delivery with a transport(5) table.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtp_randomize_addresses (default: yes)
       Randomize  the  order of equal-preference MX host addresses.  This is a
       performance feature of the Postfix SMTP client.

smtp_rcpt_timeout (default: 300s)
       The Postfix SMTP client time limit for sending the SMTP	RCPT  TO  com‐
       mand, and for receiving the remote SMTP server response.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

smtp_reply_filter (default: empty)
       A mechanism to transform replies from remote SMTP servers one line at a
       time.   This  is	 a last-resort tool to work around server replies that
       break inter-operability with  the  Postfix  SMTP	 client.   Other  uses
       involve	 fault	 injection  to	test  Postfix's	 handling  of  invalid
       responses.

       Notes:

       ·      In the case of a multi-line reply, the Postfix SMTP client  uses
	      the  final  reply	 line's numerical SMTP reply code and enhanced
	      status code.

       ·      The numerical SMTP reply code (XYZ) takes	 precedence  over  the
	      enhanced	status	code  (X.Y.Z).	 When the enhanced status code
	      initial digit differs from the SMTP reply code initial digit, or
	      when no enhanced status code is present, the Postfix SMTP client
	      uses a generic enhanced status code (X.0.0) instead.

       Specify the name of a "type:table" lookup table. The search string is a
       single  SMTP reply line as received from the remote SMTP server, except
       that the trailing <CR><LF> are removed.	When the lookup succeeds,  the
       result replaces the single SMTP reply line.

       Examples:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
	   smtp_reply_filter = pcre:/etc/postfix/reply_filter

       /etc/postfix/reply_filter:
	   # Transform garbage into "250-filler..." so that it looks like
	   # one line from a multi-line reply. It does not matter what we
	   # substitute here as long it has the right syntax.  The Postfix
	   # SMTP client will use the final line's numerical SMTP reply
	   # code and enhanced status code.
	   !/^([2-5][0-9][0-9]($|[- ]))/ 250-filler for garbage

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7.

smtp_rset_timeout (default: 20s)
       The  Postfix  SMTP  client time limit for sending the RSET command, and
       for receiving the remote SMTP server response. The  SMTP	 client	 sends
       RSET  in order to finish a recipient address probe, or to verify that a
       cached session is still usable.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtp_sasl_auth_cache_name (default: empty)
       An optional table to prevent repeated SASL authentication failures with
       the same remote SMTP server hostname, username and password. Each table
       (key, value) pair contains a server name, a username and password,  and
       the full server response. This information is stored when a remote SMTP
       server rejects an authentication attempt with a	535  reply  code.   As
       long  as the smtp_sasl_password_maps information does no change, and as
       long as the smtp_sasl_auth_cache_name information does not expire  (see
       smtp_sasl_auth_cache_time)  the Postfix SMTP client avoids SASL authen‐
       tication attempts with the same	server,	 username  and	password,  and
       instead	  bounces    or	  defers   mail	  as   controlled   with   the
       smtp_sasl_auth_soft_bounce configuration parameter.

       Use  a  per-destination	delivery  concurrency  of  1   (for   example,
       "smtp_destination_concurrency_limit  =  1",  "relay_destination_concur‐
       rency_limit = 1", etc.), otherwise multiple delivery agents may experi‐
       ence a login failure at the same time.

       The  table  must	 be  accessed via the proxywrite service, i.e. the map
       name must start with "proxy:". The table should	be  stored  under  the
       directory specified with the data_directory parameter.

       This  feature  uses  cryptographic  hashing to protect plain-text pass‐
       words, and requires that Postfix is compiled with TLS support.

       Example:

       smtp_sasl_auth_cache_name = proxy:btree:/var/lib/postfix/sasl_auth_cache

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_sasl_auth_cache_time (default: 90d)
       The maximal age of an  smtp_sasl_auth_cache_name	 entry	before	it  is
       removed.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_sasl_auth_enable (default: no)
       Enable SASL authentication in the Postfix SMTP client.  By default, the
       Postfix SMTP client uses no authentication.

       Example:

       smtp_sasl_auth_enable = yes

smtp_sasl_auth_soft_bounce (default: yes)
       When a remote SMTP server rejects a SASL authentication request with  a
       535  reply code, defer mail delivery instead of returning mail as unde‐
       liverable. The latter behavior was hard-coded prior to Postfix  version
       2.5.

       Note: the setting "yes" overrides the global soft_bounce parameter, but
       the setting "no" does not.

       Example:

       # Default as of Postfix 2.5
       smtp_sasl_auth_soft_bounce = yes
       # The old hard-coded default
       smtp_sasl_auth_soft_bounce = no

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter (default: empty)
       If non-empty, a Postfix SMTP client filter for the remote SMTP server's
       list of offered SASL mechanisms.	 Different client and server implemen‐
       tations may support different mechanism lists; by default, the  Postfix
       SMTP  client  will  use	the  intersection of the two. smtp_sasl_mecha‐
       nism_filter specifies an optional third	mechanism  list	 to  intersect
       with.

       Specify	mechanism  names, "/file/name" patterns or "type:table" lookup
       tables.	The  right-hand	 side  result  from  "type:table"  lookups  is
       ignored.	 Specify "!pattern" to exclude a mechanism name from the list.
       The form "!/file/name" is supported only in  Postfix  version  2.4  and
       later.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Examples:

       smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter = plain, login
       smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter = /etc/postfix/smtp_mechs
       smtp_sasl_mechanism_filter = !gssapi, !login, static:rest

smtp_sasl_password_maps (default: empty)
       Optional	 Postfix  SMTP client lookup tables with one username:password
       entry per remote hostname or domain, or	sender	address	 when  sender-
       dependent  authentication is enabled.  If no username:password entry is
       found, then the Postfix SMTP client will not attempt to authenticate to
       the remote host.

       The  Postfix  SMTP client opens the lookup table before going to chroot
       jail, so you can leave the password file in /etc/postfix.

smtp_sasl_path (default: empty)
       Implementation-specific information that the Postfix SMTP client passes
       through	to  the	 SASL  plug-in	implementation	that  is selected with
       smtp_sasl_type.	Typically this specifies the name of  a	 configuration
       file or rendezvous point.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_sasl_security_options (default: noplaintext, noanonymous)
       Postfix	SMTP  client SASL security options; as of Postfix 2.3 the list
       of available features depends on the SASL client implementation that is
       selected with smtp_sasl_type.

       The  following  security features are defined for the cyrus client SASL
       implementation:

       Specify zero or more of the following:

       noplaintext
	      Disallow methods that use plaintext passwords.

       noactive
	      Disallow methods subject to active (non-dictionary) attack.

       nodictionary
	      Disallow methods subject to passive (dictionary) attack.

       noanonymous
	      Disallow methods that allow anonymous authentication.

       mutual_auth
	      Only allow  methods  that	 provide  mutual  authentication  (not
	      available with SASL version 1).

       Example:

       smtp_sasl_security_options = noplaintext

smtp_sasl_tls_security_options (default: $smtp_sasl_security_options)
       The  SASL  authentication security options that the Postfix SMTP client
       uses for TLS encrypted SMTP sessions.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_sasl_tls_verified_security_options	    (default:	  $smtp_sasl_tls_secu‐
       rity_options)
       The  SASL  authentication security options that the Postfix SMTP client
       uses for TLS encrypted SMTP sessions with a  verified  server  certifi‐
       cate.

       When  mail  is  sent  to the public MX host for the recipient's domain,
       server certificates are by default optional, and delivery proceeds even
       if  certificate	verification fails. For delivery via a submission ser‐
       vice that requires SASL authentication, it may be appropriate  to  send
       plaintext  passwords only when the connection to the server is strongly
       encrypted and the server identity is verified.

       The smtp_sasl_tls_verified_security_options parameter makes it possible
       to  only	 enable	 plaintext  mechanisms when a secure connection to the
       server is available. Submission servers subject	to  this  policy  must
       either  have  verifiable	 certificates  or offer suitable non-plaintext
       SASL mechanisms.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

smtp_sasl_type (default: cyrus)
       The SASL plug-in type that the  Postfix	SMTP  client  should  use  for
       authentication.	 The available types are listed with the "postconf -A"
       command.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_send_dummy_mail_auth (default: no)
       Whether or not to append the "AUTH=<>" option to the MAIL FROM  command
       in  SASL-authenticated  SMTP sessions. The default is not to send this,
       to avoid problems with broken remote SMTP servers.  Before Postfix  2.9
       the behavior is as if "smtp_send_dummy_mail_auth = yes".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later.

smtp_send_xforward_command (default: no)
       Send  the  non-standard	XFORWARD  command when the Postfix SMTP server
       EHLO response announces XFORWARD support.

       This allows a Postfix SMTP delivery agent, used for injecting mail into
       a  content filter, to forward the name, address, protocol and HELO name
       of the original client to the content  filter  and  downstream  queuing
       SMTP   server.  This  can  produce  more	 useful	 logging  than	local‐
       host[127.0.0.1] etc.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtp_sender_dependent_authentication (default: no)
       Enable sender-dependent authentication in the Postfix SMTP client; this
       is  available  only with SASL authentication, and disables SMTP connec‐
       tion caching to ensure that mail from different senders	will  use  the
       appropriate credentials.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_skip_4xx_greeting (default: yes)
       Skip SMTP servers that greet with a 4XX status code (go away, try again
       later).

       By default, the Postfix SMTP client moves on the next  mail  exchanger.
       Specify	"smtp_skip_4xx_greeting = no" if Postfix should defer delivery
       immediately.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and  earlier.	Later  Postfix
       versions	 always	 skip remote SMTP servers that greet with a 4XX status
       code.

smtp_skip_5xx_greeting (default: yes)
       Skip remote SMTP servers that greet with a 5XX status code (go away, do
       not try again later).

       By  default,  the Postfix SMTP client moves on the next mail exchanger.
       Specify "smtp_skip_5xx_greeting = no" if Postfix should bounce the mail
       immediately.  The default setting is incorrect, but it is what a lot of
       people expect to happen.

smtp_skip_quit_response (default: yes)
       Do not wait for the response to the SMTP QUIT command.

smtp_starttls_timeout (default: 300s)
       Time limit for Postfix SMTP client write and read operations during TLS
       startup and shutdown handshake procedures.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_CAfile (default: empty)
       A  file	containing  CA certificates of root CAs trusted to sign either
       remote SMTP server certificates or intermediate CA certificates.	 These
       are  loaded  into  memory  before  the smtp(8) client enters the chroot
       jail.  If  the  number  of  trusted  roots  is  large,  consider	 using
       smtp_tls_CApath	instead,  but  note  that the latter directory must be
       present in the chroot jail if the smtp(8) client is chrooted. This file
       may  also be used to augment the client certificate trust chain, but it
       is  best	 to  include  all  the	required  certificates	 directly   in
       $smtp_tls_cert_file.

       Specify	"smtp_tls_CAfile  =  /path/to/system_CA_file"  to use ONLY the
       system-supplied default certificate authority certificates.

       Specify "tls_append_default_CA = no" to prevent Postfix from  appending
       the system-supplied default CAs and trusting third-party certificates.

       Example:

       smtp_tls_CAfile = /etc/postfix/CAcert.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_CApath (default: empty)
       Directory  with	PEM format certificate authority certificates that the
       Postfix SMTP client uses to verify a remote  SMTP  server  certificate.
       Don't  forget  to  create the necessary "hash" links with, for example,
       "$OPENSSL_HOME/bin/c_rehash /etc/postfix/certs".

       To use this option in chroot mode, this directory (or a copy)  must  be
       inside the chroot jail.

       Specify	"smtp_tls_CApath  =  /path/to/system_CA_directory" to use ONLY
       the system-supplied default certificate authority certificates.

       Specify "tls_append_default_CA = no" to prevent Postfix from  appending
       the system-supplied default CAs and trusting third-party certificates.

       Example:

       smtp_tls_CApath = /etc/postfix/certs

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_block_early_mail_reply (default: no)
       Try  to detect a mail hijacking attack based on a TLS protocol vulnera‐
       bility (CVE-2009-3555), where  an  attacker  prepends  malicious	 HELO,
       MAIL,  RCPT,  DATA  commands to a Postfix SMTP client TLS session.  The
       attack would succeed with non-Postfix SMTP servers that	reply  to  the
       malicious HELO, MAIL, RCPT, DATA commands after negotiating the Postfix
       SMTP client TLS session.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7.

smtp_tls_cert_file (default: empty)
       File with the Postfix SMTP client RSA certificate in PEM format.	  This
       file  may  also	contain	 the  Postfix SMTP client private RSA key, and
       these may be the same as the Postfix SMTP server	 RSA  certificate  and
       key file.

       Do not configure client certificates unless you must present client TLS
       certificates to one or more servers. Client certificates are  not  usu‐
       ally  needed,  and  can cause problems in configurations that work well
       without them. The recommended setting is to let the defaults stand:

	   smtp_tls_cert_file =
	   smtp_tls_key_file =
	   smtp_tls_dcert_file =
	   smtp_tls_dkey_file =
	   smtp_tls_eccert_file =
	   smtp_tls_eckey_file =

       The best way to use the default settings is to comment  out  the	 above
       parameters in main.cf if present.

       To  enable  remote  SMTP servers to verify the Postfix SMTP client cer‐
       tificate, the issuing CA certificates must be  made  available  to  the
       server. You should include the required certificates in the client cer‐
       tificate file, the client certificate first,  then  the	issuing	 CA(s)
       (bottom-up order).

       Example: the certificate for "client.example.com" was issued by "inter‐
       mediate CA" which itself has a certificate issued by "root CA".	Create
       the  client.pem	file  with  "cat  client_cert.pem  intermediate_CA.pem
       root_CA.pem > client.pem".

       If you also want to verify remote SMTP server  certificates  issued  by
       these  CAs,  you can add the CA certificates to the smtp_tls_CAfile, in
       which case it is not necessary to have them in the  smtp_tls_cert_file,
       smtp_tls_dcert_file or smtp_tls_eccert_file.

       A certificate supplied here must be usable as an SSL client certificate
       and hence pass the "openssl verify -purpose sslclient ..." test.

       Example:

       smtp_tls_cert_file = /etc/postfix/client.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_cipherlist (default: empty)
       Obsolete Postfix < 2.3 control for the Postfix SMTP client  TLS	cipher
       list. As this feature applies to all TLS security levels, it is easy to
       create inter-operability problems  by  choosing	a  non-default	cipher
       list.  Do  not  use a non-default TLS cipher list on hosts that deliver
       email to the public Internet: you will  be  unable  to  send  email  to
       servers	that  only support the ciphers you exclude. Using a restricted
       cipher list may be more appropriate for an internal MTA, where one  can
       exert  some  control  over  the	TLS  software and settings of the peer
       servers.

       Note: do not use "" quotes around the parameter value.

       This feature is available in Postfix version 2.2. It is not  used  with
       Postfix 2.3 and later; use smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers instead.

smtp_tls_ciphers (default: export)
       The minimum TLS cipher grade that the Postfix SMTP client will use with
       opportunistic	TLS    encryption.    Cipher	types	 listed	    in
       smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers	 are  excluded from the base definition of the
       selected cipher grade.  The  default  value  "export"  ensures  maximum
       inter-operability.  Because  encryption	is optional, stronger controls
       are not appropriate, and this setting SHOULD NOT be changed unless  the
       change is essential.

       When   TLS   is	 mandatory   the   cipher  grade  is  chosen  via  the
       smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers configuration parameter, see there for  syn‐
       tax details. See smtp_tls_policy_maps for information on how to config‐
       ure ciphers on a per-destination basis.

       Example:
       smtp_tls_ciphers = export

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later. With earlier	 Post‐
       fix  releases  only  the smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers parameter is imple‐
       mented, and opportunistic TLS always uses "export" or better (i.e. all)
       ciphers.

smtp_tls_dcert_file (default: empty)
       File  with the Postfix SMTP client DSA certificate in PEM format.  This
       file may also contain the Postfix SMTP client private DSA key.

       See the discussion under smtp_tls_cert_file for more details.

       Example:

       smtp_tls_dcert_file = /etc/postfix/client-dsa.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_dkey_file (default: $smtp_tls_dcert_file)
       File with the Postfix SMTP client DSA private key in PEM format.	  This
       file  may be combined with the Postfix SMTP client DSA certificate file
       specified with $smtp_tls_dcert_file.

       The private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it  must
       not be encrypted. File permissions should grant read-only access to the
       system superuser account ("root"), and no access to anyone else.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_eccert_file (default: empty)
       File with the Postfix SMTP client  ECDSA	 certificate  in  PEM  format.
       This file may also contain the Postfix SMTP client ECDSA private key.

       See the discussion under smtp_tls_cert_file for more details.

       Example:

       smtp_tls_eccert_file = /etc/postfix/ecdsa-ccert.pem

       This  feature  is  available  in Postfix 2.6 and later, when Postfix is
       compiled and linked with OpenSSL 1.0.0 or later.

smtp_tls_eckey_file (default: $smtp_tls_eccert_file)
       File with the Postfix SMTP client ECDSA	private	 key  in  PEM  format.
       This  file  may be combined with the Postfix SMTP client ECDSA certifi‐
       cate file specified with $smtp_tls_eccert_file.

       The private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it  must
       not be encrypted. File permissions should grant read-only access to the
       system superuser account ("root"), and no access to anyone else.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and  later,  when  Postfix  is
       compiled and linked with OpenSSL 1.0.0 or later.

smtp_tls_enforce_peername (default: yes)
       With  mandatory	TLS  encryption,  require  that the remote SMTP server
       hostname matches the information in the remote SMTP server certificate.
       As  of  RFC 2487 the requirements for hostname checking for MTA clients
       are not specified.

       This option can be set to "no" to disable strict	 peer  name  checking.
       This  setting  has  no  effect  on sessions that are controlled via the
       smtp_tls_per_site table.

       Disabling the hostname verification can make sense in  closed  environ‐
       ment where special CAs are created.  If not used carefully, this option
       opens the danger of a "man-in-the-middle"  attack  (the	CommonName  of
       this attacker will be logged).

       This  feature  is  available in Postfix 2.2 and later. With Postfix 2.3
       and later use smtp_tls_security_level instead.

smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers (default: empty)
       List of ciphers or cipher types to exclude from the Postfix SMTP client
       cipher  list  at	 all  TLS  security  levels.  This  is	not an OpenSSL
       cipherlist, it is a simple list separated by whitespace and/or  commas.
       The  elements  are a single cipher, or one or more "+" separated cipher
       properties, in which case only ciphers matching all the properties  are
       excluded.

       Examples (some of these will cause problems):

	   smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers = aNULL
	   smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers = MD5, DES
	   smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers = DES+MD5
	   smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers = AES256-SHA, DES-CBC3-MD5
	   smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers = kEDH+aRSA

       The  first  setting,  disables anonymous ciphers. The next setting dis‐
       ables ciphers that use the MD5 digest algorithm	or  the	 (single)  DES
       encryption  algorithm.  The  next setting disables ciphers that use MD5
       and  DES	 together.   The  next	setting	 disables  the	 two   ciphers
       "AES256-SHA" and "DES-CBC3-MD5". The last setting disables ciphers that
       use "EDH" key exchange with RSA authentication.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_tls_fingerprint_cert_match (default: empty)
       List of acceptable remote SMTP server certificate fingerprints for  the
       "fingerprint"  TLS  security  level  (smtp_tls_security_level = finger‐
       print). At this security level, certificate authorities are  not	 used,
       and  certificate expiration times are ignored. Instead, server certifi‐
       cates are verified directly via their certificate fingerprint or public
       key  fingerprint	 (Postfix 2.9 and later). The fingerprint is a message
       digest of the server certificate (or public key). The digest  algorithm
       is selected via the smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest parameter.

       When  an	 smtp_tls_policy_maps  table entry specifies the "fingerprint"
       security level, any "match" attributes in that entry specify  the  list
       of  valid fingerprints for the corresponding destination. Multiple fin‐
       gerprints can be combined with  a  "|"  delimiter  in  a	 single	 match
       attribute, or multiple match attributes can be employed.

       Example:	 Certificate  fingerprint  verification with internal mailhub.
       Two matching fingerprints are listed. The  relayhost  may  be  multiple
       physical hosts behind a load-balancer, each with its own private/public
       key and self-signed certificate. Alternatively, a single relayhost  may
       be  in  the process of switching from one set of private/public keys to
       another, and both keys are trusted just prior to the transition.

	   relayhost = [mailhub.example.com]
	   smtp_tls_security_level = fingerprint
	   smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest = md5
	   smtp_tls_fingerprint_cert_match =
	       3D:95:34:51:24:66:33:B9:D2:40:99:C0:C1:17:0B:D1
	       EC:3B:2D:B0:5B:B1:FB:6D:20:A3:9D:72:F6:8D:12:35

       Example: Certificate fingerprint verification  with  selected  destina‐
       tions.  As in the example above, we show two matching fingerprints:

	   /etc/postfix/main.cf:
	       smtp_tls_policy_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/tls_policy
	       smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest = md5

	   /etc/postfix/tls_policy:
	       example.com     fingerprint
		   match=3D:95:34:51:24:66:33:B9:D2:40:99:C0:C1:17:0B:D1
		   match=EC:3B:2D:B0:5B:B1:FB:6D:20:A3:9D:72:F6:8D:12:35

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest (default: md5)
       The  message digest algorithm used to construct remote SMTP server cer‐
       tificate	 fingerprints.	At  the	 "fingerprint"	TLS   security	 level
       (smtp_tls_security_level = fingerprint), the server certificate is ver‐
       ified by directly matching its certificate fingerprint  or  its	public
       key fingerprint (Postfix 2.9 and later). The fingerprint is the message
       digest of the server certificate (or its public key) using the selected
       algorithm.  With	 a  digest  algorithm  resistant to "second pre-image"
       attacks, it is not feasible to create a new public key and  a  matching
       certificate (or public/private key-pair) that has the same fingerprint.

       The  default  algorithm	is  md5; this is consistent with the backwards
       compatible setting of the digest used to verify client certificates  in
       the SMTP server.

       The  best practice algorithm is now sha1. Recent advances in hash func‐
       tion cryptanalysis have led to md5 being deprecated in favor  of	 sha1.
       However,	 as  long  as  there  are  no known "second pre-image" attacks
       against md5, its use in this context can still be considered safe.

       While additional digest algorithms are often available  with  OpenSSL's
       libcrypto, only those used by libssl in SSL cipher suites are available
       to Postfix. For now this means just md5 or sha1.

       To find the fingerprint of a specific certificate file, with a specific
       digest algorithm, run:

	   $ openssl x509 -noout -fingerprint -digest -in certfile.pem

       The  text  to  the  right  of "=" sign is the desired fingerprint.  For
       example:

	   $ openssl x509 -noout -fingerprint -sha1 -in cert.pem
	   SHA1 Fingerprint=D4:6A:AB:19:24:79:F8:32:BB:A6:CB:66:82:C0:8E:9B:EE:29:A8:1A

       To extract the public key fingerprint from an  X.509  certificate,  you
       need  to	 extract  the  public key from the certificate and compute the
       appropriate digest of its DER (ASN.1) encoding. With OpenSSL the "-pub‐
       key"  option  of	 the  "x509" command extracts the public key always in
       "PEM" format. We pipe the result to another OpenSSL command  that  con‐
       verts the key to DER and then to the "dgst" command to compute the fin‐
       gerprint.

       The actual command to transform the key to DER format  depends  on  the
       version	of OpenSSL used. With OpenSSL 1.0.0 and later, the "pkey" com‐
       mand supports all key types. With OpenSSL 0.9.8 and  earlier,  the  key
       type  is	 always	 RSA  (nobody uses DSA, and EC keys are not fully sup‐
       ported by 0.9.8), so the "rsa" command is used.

	   # OpenSSL 1.0 with all certificates and SHA-1 fingerprints.
	   $ openssl x509 -in cert.pem -noout -pubkey |
	       openssl pkey -pubin -outform DER |
	       openssl dgst -sha1 -c
	   (stdin)= 64:3f:1f:f6:e5:1e:d4:2a:56:8b:fc:09:1a:61:98:b5:bc:7c:60:58

	   # OpenSSL 0.9.8 with RSA certificates and MD5 fingerprints.
	   $ openssl x509 -in cert.pem -noout -pubkey |
	       openssl rsa -pubin -outform DER |
	       openssl dgst -md5 -c
	   (stdin)= f4:62:60:f6:12:8f:d5:8d:28:4d:13:a7:db:b2:ff:50

       The Postfix SMTP server and client log the peer (leaf) certificate fin‐
       gerprint	 and  public  key  fingerprint	when  the TLS loglevel is 2 or
       higher.

       Note: Postfix 2.9.0–2.9.5 computed	 the  public  key  fingerprint
       incorrectly.  To	 use public-key fingerprints, upgrade to Postfix 2.9.6
       or later.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtp_tls_key_file (default: $smtp_tls_cert_file)
       File with the Postfix SMTP client RSA private key in PEM format.	  This
       file  may be combined with the Postfix SMTP client RSA certificate file
       specified with $smtp_tls_cert_file.

       The private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it  must
       not be encrypted. File permissions should grant read-only access to the
       system superuser account ("root"), and no access to anyone else.

       Example:

       smtp_tls_key_file = $smtp_tls_cert_file

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_loglevel (default: 0)
       Enable additional Postfix SMTP client logging of	 TLS  activity.	  Each
       logging	level  also includes the information that is logged at a lower
       logging level.

	      0 Log only a summary message on TLS handshake completion —
	      no logging of remote SMTP server certificate trust-chain verifi‐
	      cation  errors  if  server  certificate  verification   is   not
	      required.	  With Postfix 2.8 and earlier, disable logging of TLS
	      activity.

	      1 Also log remote SMTP server  trust-chain  verification	errors
	      and  peer	 certificate summary information. With Postfix 2.8 and
	      earlier, log TLS handshake and certificate information.

	      2 Also log levels during TLS negotiation.

	      3 Also  log  hexadecimal	and  ASCII  dump  of  TLS  negotiation
	      process.

	      4	 Also  log hexadecimal and ASCII dump of complete transmission
	      after STARTTLS.

       Do not use "smtp_tls_loglevel = 2" or higher except in  case  of	 prob‐
       lems. Use of loglevel 4 is strongly discouraged.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers (default: medium)
       The minimum TLS cipher grade that the Postfix SMTP client will use with
       mandatory TLS encryption.  The default value "medium" is	 suitable  for
       most destinations with which you may want to enforce TLS, and is beyond
       the reach of today's cryptanalytic  methods.  See  smtp_tls_policy_maps
       for information on how to configure ciphers on a per-destination basis.

       The following cipher grades are supported:

       export Enable  "EXPORT"	grade  or better OpenSSL ciphers.  This is the
	      default for opportunistic encryption. It is not recommended  for
	      mandatory encryption unless you must enforce TLS with "crippled"
	      peers.  The  underlying  cipherlist   is	 specified   via   the
	      tls_export_cipherlist  configuration  parameter,	which  you are
	      strongly encouraged to not change.

       low    Enable "LOW" grade or better OpenSSL ciphers.  This  setting  is
	      only  appropriate	 for  internal	mail  servers.	The underlying
	      cipherlist is specified via the tls_low_cipherlist configuration
	      parameter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change.

       medium Enable "MEDIUM" grade or better OpenSSL ciphers.	The underlying
	      cipherlist is specified via the tls_medium_cipherlist configura‐
	      tion parameter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change.

       high   Enable  only  "HIGH" grade OpenSSL ciphers.  This setting may be
	      appropriate when all mandatory TLS destinations (e.g.  when  all
	      mail is routed to a suitably capable relayhost) support at least
	      one "HIGH" grade cipher. The underlying cipherlist is  specified
	      via  the	tls_high_cipherlist configuration parameter, which you
	      are strongly encouraged to not change.

       null   Enable only the "NULL" OpenSSL ciphers, these provide  authenti‐
	      cation  without encryption.  This setting is only appropriate in
	      the rare case that all servers are prepared to use NULL  ciphers
	      (not  normally  enabled in TLS servers). A plausible use-case is
	      an LMTP server listening on a UNIX-domain socket that is config‐
	      ured  to	support	 "NULL"	 ciphers. The underlying cipherlist is
	      specified via the tls_null_cipherlist  configuration  parameter,
	      which you are strongly encouraged to not change.

       The  underlying cipherlists for grades other than "null" include anony‐
       mous ciphers, but these are automatically filtered out if  the  Postfix
       SMTP  client is configured to verify server certificates.  You are very
       unlikely to need to take any steps to exclude anonymous	ciphers,  they
       are excluded automatically as necessary.	 If you must exclude anonymous
       ciphers at the "may" or "encrypt" security  levels,  when  the  Postfix
       SMTP   client   does   not   need   or	use   peer  certificates,  set
       "smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers = aNULL". To exclude anonymous	 ciphers  only
       when TLS is enforced, set "smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers = aNULL".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers (default: empty)
       Additional  list of ciphers or cipher types to exclude from the Postfix
       SMTP client cipher list at mandatory TLS	 security  levels.  This  list
       works	 in	addition     to	   the	  exclusions	listed	  with
       smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers (see there for syntax details).

       Starting with Postfix 2.6, the mandatory cipher exclusions can be spec‐
       ified   on  a  per-destination  basis  via  the	TLS  policy  "exclude"
       attribute. See smtp_tls_policy_maps for notes and examples.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols (default: !SSLv2)
       List of SSL/TLS protocols that the Postfix SMTP client  will  use  with
       mandatory  TLS  encryption.   In	 main.cf  the  values are separated by
       whitespace, commas or colons. In the policy table "protocols" attribute
       (see  smtp_tls_policy_maps) the only valid separator is colon. An empty
       value means allow all protocols. The valid protocol names, (see	\fBfB‐
       SSL_get_version(3)), are "SSLv2", "SSLv3" and "TLSv1".

       Note:  As of OpenSSL 1.0.1 two new protocols are defined, "TLSv1.1" and
       "TLSv1.2". If an older Postfix version is linked against OpenSSL	 1.0.1
       or  later,  these, or any other new protocol versions, are uncondition‐
       ally enabled.

       With Postfix >= 2.5 the parameter syntax is expanded to support	proto‐
       col  exclusions.	 One  can  now	explicitly  exclude  SSLv2  by setting
       "smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols = !SSLv2".	 To  exclude  both  SSLv2  and
       SSLv3  set "smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3". Listing the
       protocols to include, rather than protocols to exclude,	is  supported,
       but not recommended. The exclusion form more closely matches the behav‐
       ior when the OpenSSL library is newer than Postfix.

       Since SSL version 2 has known protocol weaknesses  and  is  now	depre‐
       cated,  the  default  setting  excludes	"SSLv2".   This	 means that by
       default, SSL version 2 will not be used at the "encrypt" security level
       and higher.

       See   the  documentation	 of  the  smtp_tls_policy_maps	parameter  and
       TLS_README for more information about security levels.

       Example:

       # Preferred form with Postfix >= 2.5:
       smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3
       # Alternative form.
       smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols = TLSv1

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_tls_note_starttls_offer (default: no)
       Log the hostname of a remote SMTP server that offers STARTTLS, when TLS
       is not already enabled for that server.

       The logfile record looks like:

       postfix/smtp[pid]:  Host offered STARTTLS: [name.of.host]

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_per_site (default: empty)
       Optional lookup tables with the Postfix SMTP client TLS usage policy by
       next-hop destination and by remote SMTP	server	hostname.   When  both
       lookups	succeed,  the  more specific per-site policy (NONE, MUST, etc)
       overrides the less specific one (MAY), and  the	more  secure  per-site
       policy  (MUST, etc) overrides the less secure one (NONE).  With Postfix
       2.3  and	 later	smtp_tls_per_site   is	 strongly   discouraged:   use
       smtp_tls_policy_maps instead.

       Use  of	the bare hostname as the per-site table lookup key is discour‐
       aged. Always use the full destination nexthop (enclosed in  []  with  a
       possible	 ":port"  suffix).  A recipient domain or MX-enabled transport
       next-hop with no port suffix may look like  a  bare  hostname,  but  is
       still a suitable destination.

       Specify	a  next-hop  destination  or  server hostname on the left-hand
       side; no wildcards are allowed. The next-hop destination is either  the
       recipient  domain, or the destination specified with a transport(5) ta‐
       ble, the relayhost parameter, or the relay_transport parameter.	On the
       right hand side specify one of the following keywords:

       NONE   Don't  use TLS at all. This overrides a less specific MAY lookup
	      result from the alternate host or next-hop lookup key, and over‐
	      rides    the    global   smtp_use_tls,   smtp_enforce_tls,   and
	      smtp_tls_enforce_peername settings.

       MAY    Try to use TLS if the server announces  support,	otherwise  use
	      the unencrypted connection. This has less precedence than a more
	      specific result (including NONE)	from  the  alternate  host  or
	      next-hop	lookup key, and has less precedence than the more spe‐
	      cific global "smtp_enforce_tls = yes" or "smtp_tls_enforce_peer‐
	      name = yes".

       MUST_NOPEERMATCH
	      Require  TLS encryption, but do not require that the remote SMTP
	      server hostname matches  the  information	 in  the  remote  SMTP
	      server certificate, or that the server certificate was issued by
	      a trusted CA. This overrides a less secure NONE or a  less  spe‐
	      cific  MAY  lookup  result  from	the alternate host or next-hop
	      lookup   key,   and   overrides	the    global	 smtp_use_tls,
	      smtp_enforce_tls and smtp_tls_enforce_peername settings.

       MUST   Require  TLS  encryption,	 require  that	the remote SMTP server
	      hostname matches the information in the remote SMTP server  cer‐
	      tificate,	 and  require  that the remote SMTP server certificate
	      was issued by a trusted CA. This overrides a  less  secure  NONE
	      and  MUST_NOPEERMATCH  or a less specific MAY lookup result from
	      the alternate host or next-hop lookup  key,  and	overrides  the
	      global smtp_use_tls, smtp_enforce_tls and smtp_tls_enforce_peer‐
	      name settings.

       The above keywords correspond to the "none", "may", "encrypt" and "ver‐
       ify"  security  levels  for  the	 new smtp_tls_security_level parameter
       introduced in Postfix 2.3. Starting with Postfix 2.3, and independently
       of  how	the  policy  is	 specified, the smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers and
       smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols parameters apply when  TLS	encryption  is
       mandatory.  Connections	for  which  encryption	is  optional typically
       enable all "export" grade and better ciphers (see smtp_tls_ciphers  and
       smtp_tls_protocols).

       As long as no secure DNS lookup mechanism is available, false hostnames
       in MX or CNAME responses can change the server  hostname	 that  Postfix
       uses  for  TLS  policy lookup and server certificate verification. Even
       with a perfect match between the server hostname and  the  server  cer‐
       tificate,  there is no guarantee that Postfix is connected to the right
       server.	See TLS_README (Closing a DNS loophole with obsolete  per-site
       TLS policies) for a possible work-around.

       This  feature  is  available in Postfix 2.2 and later. With Postfix 2.3
       and later use smtp_tls_policy_maps instead.

smtp_tls_policy_maps (default: empty)
       Optional lookup tables with the Postfix SMTP client TLS security policy
       by  next-hop  destination;  when	 a  non-empty value is specified, this
       overrides the obsolete smtp_tls_per_site parameter.  See TLS_README for
       a more detailed discussion of TLS security levels.

       The TLS policy table is indexed by the full next-hop destination, which
       is either the recipient domain, or the verbatim next-hop	 specified  in
       the     transport    table,    $local_transport,	   $virtual_transport,
       $relay_transport or $default_transport.	This  includes	any  enclosing
       square brackets and any non-default destination server port suffix. The
       LMTP socket type prefix (inet: or unix:) is not included in the	lookup
       key.

       Only  the  next-hop  domain,  or $myhostname with LMTP over UNIX-domain
       sockets, is used as the nexthop name for certificate verification.  The
       port  and  any  enclosing  square brackets are used in the table lookup
       key, but are not used for server name verification.

       When the lookup key is a domain name without enclosing square  brackets
       or  any	:port  suffix  (typically  the recipient domain), and the full
       domain is not found in the table, just as with the transport(5)	table,
       the  parent  domain starting with a leading "." is matched recursively.
       This allows one to specify a security policy for a recipient domain and
       all its sub-domains.

       The  lookup result is a security level, followed by an optional list of
       whitespace and/or comma separated name=value attributes	that  override
       related	main.cf settings. The TLS security levels in order of increas‐
       ing security are:

       none   No TLS. No additional attributes are supported at this level.

       may    Opportunistic TLS. Since sending in  the	clear  is  acceptable,
	      demanding	 stronger  than	 default  TLS  security merely reduces
	      inter-operability. The optional "ciphers", "exclude" and "proto‐
	      cols"  attributes	 (available for opportunistic TLS with Postfix
	      >=       2.6)	  override	 the	   "smtp_tls_ciphers",
	      "smtp_tls_exclude_ciphers"  and  "smtp_tls_protocols" configura‐
	      tion parameters. When opportunistic TLS handshakes fail, Postfix
	      retries  the  connection	with  TLS  disabled.  This allows mail
	      delivery to sites with non-interoperable TLS implementations.

       encrypt
	      Mandatory TLS encryption. At this level and higher, the optional
	      "protocols"  attribute  overrides	 the  main.cf  smtp_tls_manda‐
	      tory_protocols parameter, the optional "ciphers" attribute over‐
	      rides  the main.cf smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers parameter, and the
	      optional "exclude" attribute  (Postfix  >=  2.6)	overrides  the
	      main.cf  smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers  parameter.  In  the
	      policy table, multiple protocols or  excluded  ciphers  must  be
	      separated	 by colons, as attribute values may not contain white‐
	      space or commas.

       fingerprint
	      Certificate fingerprint verification. Available with Postfix 2.5
	      and later. At this security level, there are no trusted certifi‐
	      cate authorities. The certificate trust chain, expiration	 date,
	      ...  are	not checked. Instead, the optional match attribute, or
	      else  the	 main.cf  smtp_tls_fingerprint_cert_match   parameter,
	      lists the certificate fingerprints or the public key fingerprint
	      (Postfix 2.9 and later) of the  valid  server  certificate.  The
	      digest  algorithm	 used to calculate the fingerprint is selected
	      by the smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest parameter.  Multiple  finger‐
	      prints  can  be  combined with a "|" delimiter in a single match
	      attribute, or multiple match attributes can be employed. The ":"
	      character	 is  not used as a delimiter as it occurs between each
	      pair of fingerprint (hexadecimal) digits.

       verify Mandatory TLS verification.  At  this  security  level,  DNS  MX
	      lookups  are  trusted to be secure enough, and the name verified
	      in the server certificate is  usually  obtained  indirectly  via
	      unauthenticated  DNS MX lookups.	The optional "match" attribute
	      overrides the main.cf smtp_tls_verify_cert_match	parameter.  In
	      the policy table, multiple match patterns and strategies must be
	      separated by colons.  In practice explicit control over matching
	      is more common with the "secure" policy, described below.

       secure Secure-channel  TLS.  At	this  security	level, DNS MX lookups,
	      though potentially used  to  determine  the  candidate  next-hop
	      gateway  IP  addresses,  are not trusted to be secure enough for
	      TLS peername verification. Instead, the default name verified in
	      the  server  certificate is obtained directly from the next-hop,
	      or is explicitly specified  via  the  optional  match  attribute
	      which  overrides	the main.cf smtp_tls_secure_cert_match parame‐
	      ter. In the policy table, multiple match patterns and strategies
	      must be separated by colons.  The match attribute is most useful
	      when multiple domains are supported by common server, the policy
	      entries  for  additional	domains specify matching rules for the
	      primary domain  certificate.  While  transport  table  overrides
	      routing  the secondary domains to the primary nexthop also allow
	      secure verification, they risk delivery to the wrong destination
	      when  domains  change  hands or are re-assigned to new gateways.
	      With the "match" attribute approach, routing is  not  perturbed,
	      and mail is deferred if verification of a new MX host fails.

       Example:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
	   smtp_tls_policy_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/tls_policy
	   # Postfix 2.5 and later
	   smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest = md5

       /etc/postfix/tls_policy:
	   example.edu		       none
	   example.mil		       may
	   example.gov		       encrypt protocols=TLSv1
	   example.com		       verify ciphers=high
	   example.net		       secure
	   .example.net		       secure match=.example.net:example.net
	   [mail.example.org]:587      secure match=nexthop
	   # Postfix 2.5 and later
	   [thumb.example.org]		fingerprint
	    match=EC:3B:2D:B0:5B:B1:FB:6D:20:A3:9D:72:F6:8D:12:35
	    match=3D:95:34:51:24:66:33:B9:D2:40:99:C0:C1:17:0B:D1

       Note:  The  hostname  strategy  if  listed  in a non-default setting of
       smtp_tls_secure_cert_match or in the match attribute in the policy  ta‐
       ble  can	 render the secure level vulnerable to DNS forgery. Do not use
       the hostname strategy for secure-channel configurations in environments
       where DNS security is not assured.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_tls_protocols (default: !SSLv2)
       List  of	 TLS  protocols	 that  the Postfix SMTP client will exclude or
       include with opportunistic TLS encryption. Starting with	 Postfix  2.6,
       the Postfix SMTP client will by default not use the obsolete SSLv2 pro‐
       tocol.

       In main.cf the values are separated by whitespace, commas or colons. In
       the policy table (see smtp_tls_policy_maps) the only valid separator is
       colon. An empty value means allow all  protocols.  The  valid  protocol
       names, (see \fBfBSSL_get_version(3)), are "SSLv2", "SSLv3" and "TLSv1".

       Note:  As of OpenSSL 1.0.1 two new protocols are defined, "TLSv1.1" and
       "TLSv1.2". If an older Postfix version is linked against OpenSSL	 1.0.1
       or  later,  these, or any other new protocol versions, are uncondition‐
       ally enabled.

       To include a protocol list its name, to exclude	it,  prefix  the  name
       with  a	"!" character. To exclude SSLv2 even for opportunistic TLS set
       "smtp_tls_protocols = !SSLv2". To exclude both "SSLv2" and "SSLv3"  set
       "smtp_tls_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3". Explicitly listing the protocols
       to include, rather than protocols to exclude,  is  supported,  but  not
       recommended.  The exclusion form more closely matches the behavior when
       the OpenSSL library is newer than Postfix.

       Example:
       # TLSv1 only!
       smtp_tls_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

smtp_tls_scert_verifydepth (default: 9)
       The verification depth for remote SMTP server certificates. A depth  of
       1 is sufficient if the issuing CA is listed in a local CA file.

       The  default verification depth is 9 (the OpenSSL default) for compati‐
       bility with earlier Postfix behavior. Prior to Postfix 2.5, the default
       value  was  5, but the limit was not actually enforced. If you have set
       this to a lower	non-default  value,  certificates  with	 longer	 trust
       chains  may  now fail to verify. Certificate chains with 1 or 2 CAs are
       common, deeper chains are more rare and any  number  between  5	and  9
       should suffice in practice. You can choose a lower number if, for exam‐
       ple, you trust certificates directly signed by an issuing  CA  but  not
       any CAs it delegates to.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_secure_cert_match (default: nexthop, dot-nexthop)
       How  the	 Postfix  SMTP client verifies the server certificate peername
       for the "secure" TLS security level. In a  "secure"  TLS	 policy	 table
       ($smtp_tls_policy_maps)	entry the optional "match" attribute overrides
       this main.cf setting.

       This parameter specifies one or more patterns or	 strategies  separated
       by  commas,  whitespace	or colons.  In the policy table the only valid
       separator is the colon character.

       For  a  description  of	the  pattern  and  strategy  syntax  see   the
       smtp_tls_verify_cert_match parameter. The "hostname" strategy should be
       avoided in this context, as in the absence  of  a  secure  global  DNS,
       using  the  results  of	MX  lookups in certificate verification is not
       immune to active (man-in-the-middle) attacks on DNS.

       Sample main.cf setting:

	   smtp_tls_secure_cert_match = nexthop

       Sample policy table override:

	   example.net	   secure match=example.com:.example.com
	   .example.net	   secure match=example.com:.example.com

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_tls_security_level (default: empty)
       The default SMTP TLS security level for the Postfix SMTP client; when a
       non-empty  value	 is  specified, this overrides the obsolete parameters
       smtp_use_tls, smtp_enforce_tls, and smtp_tls_enforce_peername.

       Specify one of the following security levels:

       none   TLS will not be used unless enabled  for	specific  destinations
	      via smtp_tls_policy_maps.

       may    Opportunistic  TLS.  Use	TLS if this is supported by the remote
	      SMTP server, otherwise use plaintext. Since sending in the clear
	      is  acceptable,  demanding  stronger  than  default TLS security
	      merely reduces inter-operability.	  The  "smtp_tls_ciphers"  and
	      "smtp_tls_protocols"  (Postfix  >= 2.6) configuration parameters
	      provide control over the protocols and cipher  grade  used  with
	      opportunistic  TLS.  With earlier releases the opportunistic TLS
	      cipher grade is always "export" and no protocols	are  disabled.
	      When  TLS	 handshakes  fail,  the connection is retried with TLS
	      disabled.	 This allows mail delivery to sites with  non-interop‐
	      erable TLS implementations.

       encrypt
	      Mandatory	 TLS  encryption. Since a minimum level of security is
	      intended, it is reasonable to  be	 specific  about  sufficiently
	      secure protocol versions and ciphers. At this security level and
	      higher, the main.cf parameters smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols  and
	      smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers specify the TLS protocols and minimum
	      cipher grade which the administrator considers secure enough for
	      mandatory	 encrypted  sessions.  This  security  level is not an
	      appropriate default for systems delivering mail to the Internet.

       fingerprint
	      Certificate fingerprint verification. Available with Postfix 2.5
	      and later. At this security level, there are no trusted certifi‐
	      cate authorities. The certificate trust chain, expiration	 date,
	      ...    are    not	  checked.   Instead,	the   smtp_tls_finger‐
	      print_cert_match parameter lists the certificate fingerprint  or
	      public  key  fingerprint	(Postfix  2.9  and later) of the valid
	      server certificate. The digest algorithm used to	calculate  the
	      fingerprint   is	selected  by  the  smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest
	      parameter.

       verify Mandatory TLS verification.  At  this  security  level,  DNS  MX
	      lookups  are  trusted to be secure enough, and the name verified
	      in the server certificate is  usually  obtained  indirectly  via
	      unauthenticated  DNS  MX lookups. The smtp_tls_verify_cert_match
	      parameter controls how the server name is verified. In  practice
	      explicit	control	 over  matching is more common at the "secure"
	      level, described below. This security level is not an  appropri‐
	      ate default for systems delivering mail to the Internet.

       secure Secure-channel  TLS.   At	 this  security level, DNS MX lookups,
	      though potentially used  to  determine  the  candidate  next-hop
	      gateway  IP  addresses,  are not trusted to be secure enough for
	      TLS peername verification. Instead, the default name verified in
	      the  server  certificate is obtained from the next-hop domain as
	      specified in the smtp_tls_secure_cert_match configuration param‐
	      eter.  The  default  matching  rule is that a server certificate
	      matches when its name is equal to or is a sub-domain of the nex‐
	      thop  domain.  This security level is not an appropriate default
	      for systems delivering mail to the Internet.

       Examples:

       # No TLS. Formerly: smtp_use_tls=no and smtp_enforce_tls=no.
       smtp_tls_security_level = none

       # Opportunistic TLS.
       smtp_tls_security_level = may
       # Postfix >= 2.6:
       # Do not tweak opportunistic ciphers or protocol unless it is essential
       # to do so (if a security vulnerability is found in the SSL library that
       # can be mitigated by disabling a particular protocol or raising the
       # cipher grade from "export" to "low" or "medium").
       smtp_tls_ciphers = export
       smtp_tls_protocols = !SSLv2

       # Mandatory (high-grade) TLS encryption.
       smtp_tls_security_level = encrypt
       smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers = high

       # Mandatory TLS verification of hostname or nexthop domain.
       smtp_tls_security_level = verify
       smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers = high
       smtp_tls_verify_cert_match = hostname, nexthop, dot-nexthop

       # Secure channel TLS with exact nexthop name match.
       smtp_tls_security_level = secure
       smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols = TLSv1
       smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers = high
       smtp_tls_secure_cert_match = nexthop

       # Certificate fingerprint verification (Postfix >= 2.5).
       # The CA-less "fingerprint" security level only scales to a limited
       # number of destinations. As a global default rather than a per-site
       # setting, this is practical when mail for all recipients is sent
       # to a central mail hub.
       relayhost = [mailhub.example.com]
       smtp_tls_security_level = fingerprint
       smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3
       smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers = high
       smtp_tls_fingerprint_cert_match =
	   3D:95:34:51:24:66:33:B9:D2:40:99:C0:C1:17:0B:D1
	   EC:3B:2D:B0:5B:B1:FB:6D:20:A3:9D:72:F6:8D:12:35

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_tls_session_cache_database (default: empty)
       Name of the file containing the optional Postfix SMTP client  TLS  ses‐
       sion  cache. Specify a database type that supports enumeration, such as
       btree or sdbm; there is no need to support concurrent access.  The file
       is  created  if it does not exist. The smtp(8) daemon does not use this
       parameter directly, rather the cache is implemented indirectly  in  the
       tlsmgr(8) daemon. This means that per-smtp-instance master.cf overrides
       of this parameter are not effective.  Note,  that  each	of  the	 cache
       databases supported by tlsmgr(8) daemon: $smtpd_tls_session_cache_data‐
       base, $smtp_tls_session_cache_database (and with Postfix 2.3 and	 later
       $lmtp_tls_session_cache_database), needs to be stored separately. It is
       not at this time possible to store multiple caches in  a	 single	 data‐
       base.

       Note:  dbm  databases  are  not	suitable.  TLS session objects are too
       large.

       As of version 2.5, Postfix no longer uses root privileges when  opening
       this  file.  The	 file  should  now  be	stored under the Postfix-owned
       data_directory. As a migration aid, an attempt to open the file under a
       non-Postfix  directory  is  redirected to the Postfix-owned data_direc‐
       tory, and a warning is logged.

       Example:

       smtp_tls_session_cache_database = btree:/var/lib/postfix/smtp_scache

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_session_cache_timeout (default: 3600s)
       The expiration time of Postfix SMTP client TLS session  cache  informa‐
       tion.   A  cache cleanup is performed periodically every $smtp_tls_ses‐
       sion_cache_timeout seconds. As  with  $smtp_tls_session_cache_database,
       this  parameter	is  implemented	 in the tlsmgr(8) daemon and therefore
       per-smtp-instance master.cf overrides are not possible.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtp_tls_verify_cert_match (default: hostname)
       How the Postfix SMTP client verifies the	 server	 certificate  peername
       for  the	 "verify"  TLS	security level. In a "verify" TLS policy table
       ($smtp_tls_policy_maps) entry the optional "match" attribute  overrides
       this main.cf setting.

       This  parameter	specifies one or more patterns or strategies separated
       by commas, whitespace or colons.	 In the policy table  the  only	 valid
       separator is the colon character.

       Patterns specify domain names, or domain name suffixes:

       example.com
	      Match  the  example.com domain, i.e. one of the names the server
	      certificate must be example.com, upper and lower	case  distinc‐
	      tions are ignored.

       .example.com
	      Match subdomains of the example.com domain, i.e. match a name in
	      the server certificate that consists of  a  non-zero  number  of
	      labels  followed by a .example.com suffix. Case distinctions are
	      ignored.

       Strategies specify a transformation from the  next-hop  domain  to  the
       expected name in the server certificate:

       nexthop
	      Match against the next-hop domain, which is either the recipient
	      domain, or the transport	next-hop  configured  for  the	domain
	      stripped	of  any	 optional socket type prefix, enclosing square
	      brackets and trailing port. When MX lookups are not  suppressed,
	      this  is the original nexthop domain prior to the MX lookup, not
	      the result of the MX lookup. For LMTP delivery  via  UNIX-domain
	      sockets, the verified next-hop name is $myhostname.  This strat‐
	      egy is suitable for  use	with  the  "secure"  policy.  Case  is
	      ignored.

       dot-nexthop
	      As above, but match server certificate names that are subdomains
	      of the next-hop domain. Case is ignored.

       hostname
	      Match against the hostname of the server, often obtained via  an
	      unauthenticated DNS MX lookup. For LMTP delivery via UNIX-domain
	      sockets, the verified name is $myhostname. This matches the ver‐
	      ification	 strategy  of  the  "MUST"  keyword  in	 the  obsolete
	      smtp_tls_per_site table, and is suitable for use with the	 "ver‐
	      ify"  security  level.  When  the	 next-hop  name is enclosed in
	      square brackets to suppress MX lookups, the "hostname"  strategy
	      is the same as the "nexthop" strategy. Case is ignored.

       Sample main.cf setting:

       smtp_tls_verify_cert_match = hostname, nexthop, dot-nexthop

       Sample policy table override:

       example.com     verify  match=hostname:nexthop
       .example.com    verify  match=example.com:.example.com:hostname

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtp_use_tls (default: no)
       Opportunistic  mode: use TLS when a remote SMTP server announces START‐
       TLS support, otherwise send the mail in the clear.  Beware:  some  SMTP
       servers	offer  STARTTLS	 even if it is not configured.	With Postfix <
       2.3, if the TLS handshake fails, and  no	 other	server	is  available,
       delivery	 is deferred and mail stays in the queue. If this is a concern
       for you, use the smtp_tls_per_site feature instead.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.  With  Postfix  2.3
       and later use smtp_tls_security_level instead.

smtp_xforward_timeout (default: 300s)
       The  Postfix  SMTP  client time limit for sending the XFORWARD command,
       and for receiving the remote SMTP server response.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_authorized_verp_clients (default: $authorized_verp_clients)
       What  remote  SMTP  clients  are	 allowed to specify the XVERP command.
       This command requests that mail be delivered one recipient  at  a  time
       with a per recipient return address.

       By default, no clients are allowed to specify XVERP.

       This  parameter was renamed with Postfix version 2.1. The default value
       is backwards compatible with Postfix version 2.0.

       Specify a list of network/netmask patterns, separated by commas	and/or
       whitespace.  The	 mask specifies the number of bits in the network part
       of a host address. You can also specify hostnames or .domain names (the
       initial	 dot   causes	the  domain  to	 match	any  name  below  it),
       "/file/name" or	"type:table"  patterns.	  A  "/file/name"  pattern  is
       replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched when a
       table entry matches a lookup string (the	 lookup	 result	 is  ignored).
       Continue	 long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Specify
       "!pattern" to exclude an address or network block from  the  list.  The
       form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Note:  IP  version 6 address information must be specified inside [] in
       the smtpd_authorized_verp_clients value, and in	files  specified  with
       "/file/name".   IP  version  6 addresses contain the ":" character, and
       would otherwise be confused with a "type:table" pattern.

smtpd_authorized_xclient_hosts (default: empty)
       What remote SMTP clients are allowed to use the XCLIENT feature.	  This
       command	overrides  remote  SMTP	 client	 information  that is used for
       access control. Typical use is for SMTP-based content  filters,	fetch‐
       mail-like  programs,  or	 SMTP  server  access  rule  testing.  See the
       XCLIENT_README document for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       By default, no clients are allowed to specify XCLIENT.

       Specify a list of network/netmask patterns, separated by commas	and/or
       whitespace.  The	 mask specifies the number of bits in the network part
       of a host address. You can also specify hostnames or .domain names (the
       initial	 dot   causes	the  domain  to	 match	any  name  below  it),
       "/file/name" or	"type:table"  patterns.	  A  "/file/name"  pattern  is
       replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched when a
       table entry matches a lookup string (the	 lookup	 result	 is  ignored).
       Continue	 long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. Specify
       "!pattern" to exclude an address or network block from  the  list.  The
       form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Note:  IP  version 6 address information must be specified inside [] in
       the smtpd_authorized_xclient_hosts value, and in files  specified  with
       "/file/name".   IP  version  6 addresses contain the ":" character, and
       would otherwise be confused with a "type:table" pattern.

smtpd_authorized_xforward_hosts (default: empty)
       What remote SMTP clients are allowed to use the XFORWARD feature.  This
       command	forwards  information  that  is	 used to improve logging after
       SMTP-based  content  filters.  See  the	XFORWARD_README	 document  for
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       By default, no clients are allowed to specify XFORWARD.

       Specify	a list of network/netmask patterns, separated by commas and/or
       whitespace. The mask specifies the number of bits in the	 network  part
       of a host address. You can also specify hostnames or .domain names (the
       initial	dot  causes  the  domain  to  match  any   name	  below	  it),
       "/file/name"  or	 "type:table"  patterns.   A  "/file/name"  pattern is
       replaced by its contents; a "type:table" lookup table is matched when a
       table  entry  matches  a	 lookup string (the lookup result is ignored).
       Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.  Specify
       "!pattern"  to  exclude	an address or network block from the list. The
       form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Note: IP version 6 address information must be specified inside	[]  in
       the  smtpd_authorized_xforward_hosts value, and in files specified with
       "/file/name".  IP version 6 addresses contain the  ":"  character,  and
       would otherwise be confused with a "type:table" pattern.

smtpd_banner (default: $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name)
       The  text that follows the 220 status code in the SMTP greeting banner.
       Some people like to see the mail version advertised. By default,	 Post‐
       fix shows no version.

       You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. This is required
       by the SMTP protocol.

       Example:

       smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)

smtpd_client_connection_count_limit (default: 50)
       How many simultaneous connections any client is allowed to make to this
       service.	  By  default,	the  limit  is set to half the default process
       limit value.

       To disable this feature, specify a limit of 0.

       WARNING: The purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not  be
       used to regulate legitimate mail traffic.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_client_connection_rate_limit (default: 0)
       The maximal number of connection attempts any client is allowed to make
       to this service per time unit.  The time unit  is  specified  with  the
       anvil_rate_time_unit configuration parameter.

       By  default,  a	client	can  make as many connections per time unit as
       Postfix can accept.

       To disable this feature, specify a limit of 0.

       WARNING: The purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not  be
       used to regulate legitimate mail traffic.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Example:

       smtpd_client_connection_rate_limit = 1000

smtpd_client_event_limit_exceptions (default: $mynetworks)
       Clients that are excluded from smtpd_client_*_count/rate_limit restric‐
       tions. See the mynetworks parameter description for the parameter value
       syntax.

       By default, clients in trusted networks are excluded. Specify a list of
       network blocks, hostnames or .domain names (the initial dot causes  the
       domain to match any name below it).

       Note:  IP  version 6 address information must be specified inside [] in
       the smtpd_client_event_limit_exceptions value, and in  files  specified
       with  "/file/name".   IP version 6 addresses contain the ":" character,
       and would otherwise be confused with a "type:table" pattern.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_client_message_rate_limit (default: 0)
       The maximal number of message delivery  requests	 that  any  client  is
       allowed to make to this service per time unit, regardless of whether or
       not Postfix actually accepts those messages.  The time unit  is	speci‐
       fied with the anvil_rate_time_unit configuration parameter.

       By  default,  a	client	can send as many message delivery requests per
       time unit as Postfix can accept.

       To disable this feature, specify a limit of 0.

       WARNING: The purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not  be
       used to regulate legitimate mail traffic.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Example:

       smtpd_client_message_rate_limit = 1000

smtpd_client_new_tls_session_rate_limit (default: 0)
       The  maximal  number of new (i.e., uncached) TLS sessions that a remote
       SMTP client is allowed to negotiate with this service  per  time	 unit.
       The  time unit is specified with the anvil_rate_time_unit configuration
       parameter.

       By default, a remote SMTP client can negotiate as many new TLS sessions
       per time unit as Postfix can accept.

       To  disable  this  feature,  specify a limit of 0. Otherwise, specify a
       limit that is at least the per-client concurrent session limit, or else
       legitimate client sessions may be rejected.

       WARNING:	 The purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not be
       used to regulate legitimate mail traffic.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

       Example:

       smtpd_client_new_tls_session_rate_limit = 100

smtpd_client_port_logging (default: no)
       Enable logging of the remote SMTP client port in addition to the	 host‐
       name and IP address. The logging format is "host[address]:port".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtpd_client_recipient_rate_limit (default: 0)
       The maximal number of recipient addresses that any client is allowed to
       send to this service per time unit, regardless of whether or not	 Post‐
       fix actually accepts those recipients.  The time unit is specified with
       the anvil_rate_time_unit configuration parameter.

       By default, a client can send as many recipient addresses per time unit
       as Postfix can accept.

       To disable this feature, specify a limit of 0.

       WARNING:	 The purpose of this feature is to limit abuse. It must not be
       used to regulate legitimate mail traffic.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Example:

       smtpd_client_recipient_rate_limit = 1000

smtpd_client_restrictions (default: empty)
       Optional restrictions that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the  con‐
       text  of a client connection request.  See SMTPD_ACCESS_README, section
       "Delayed evaluation of SMTP access restriction lists" for a  discussion
       of evaluation context and time.

       The default is to allow all connection requests.

       Specify	a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or whitespace.
       Continue	 long  lines  by  starting  the	 next  line  with  whitespace.
       Restrictions  are applied in the order as specified; the first restric‐
       tion that matches wins.

       The following restrictions are specific to client  hostname  or	client
       network address information.

       check_ccert_access type:table
	      Use the remote SMTP client certificate fingerprint or the public
	      key fingerprint (Postfix 2.9 and later) as lookup	 key  for  the
	      specified	 access(5)  database;  with  Postfix version 2.2, also
	      require that the remote SMTP client certificate is verified suc‐
	      cessfully.  The fingerprint digest algorithm is configurable via
	      the smtpd_tls_fingerprint_digest parameter  (hard-coded  as  md5
	      prior  to	 Postfix version 2.5).	This feature is available with
	      Postfix version 2.2 and later.

       check_client_access type:table
	      Search the specified access database for	the  client  hostname,
	      parent  domains,	client	IP  address,  or  networks obtained by
	      stripping least significant octets.  See	the  access(5)	manual
	      page for details.

       check_client_mx_access type:table
	      Search the specified access(5) database for the MX hosts for the
	      client hostname, and execute the corresponding action.  Note:  a
	      result  of  "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead, use
	      DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from blacklists.	  This
	      feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

       check_client_ns_access type:table
	      Search  the specified access(5) database for the DNS servers for
	      the client  hostname,  and  execute  the	corresponding  action.
	      Note:  a	result	of  "OK"  is  not  allowed for safety reasons.
	      Instead, use DUNNO in  order  to	exclude	 specific  hosts  from
	      blacklists.  This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

       check_reverse_client_hostname_access type:table
	      Search  the specified access database for the unverified reverse
	      client hostname, parent domains, client IP address, or  networks
	      obtained	 by   stripping	 least	significant  octets.  See  the
	      access(5) manual page for details.  Note: a result  of  "OK"  is
	      not  allowed for safety reasons.	Instead, use DUNNO in order to
	      exclude specific hosts from blacklists.  This feature is	avail‐
	      able in Postfix 2.6 and later.

       check_reverse_client_hostname_mx_access type:table
	      Search the specified access(5) database for the MX hosts for the
	      unverified reverse client hostname, and execute the  correspond‐
	      ing  action.   Note:  a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety
	      reasons.	Instead, use DUNNO in order to exclude specific	 hosts
	      from  blacklists.	  This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and
	      later.

       check_reverse_client_hostname_ns_access type:table
	      Search the specified access(5) database for the DNS servers  for
	      the  unverified  reverse client hostname, and execute the corre‐
	      sponding action.	Note: a result of  "OK"	 is  not  allowed  for
	      safety reasons.  Instead, use DUNNO in order to exclude specific
	      hosts from blacklists.  This feature is available in Postfix 2.7
	      and later.

       permit_inet_interfaces
	      Permit   the   request   when  the  client  IP  address  matches
	      $inet_interfaces.

       permit_mynetworks
	      Permit the request when the client IP address matches  any  net‐
	      work or network address listed in	 $mynetworks.

       permit_sasl_authenticated
	      Permit the request when the client is successfully authenticated
	      via the RFC 4954 (AUTH) protocol.

       permit_tls_all_clientcerts
	      Permit the request when the remote SMTP  client  certificate  is
	      verified	successfully.  This option must be used only if a spe‐
	      cial CA issues the certificates and only this CA	is  listed  as
	      trusted  CA.  Otherwise,	clients with a third-party certificate
	      would also be allowed to relay.  Specify	"tls_append_default_CA
	      =	 no" when the trusted CA is specified with smtpd_tls_CAfile or
	      smtpd_tls_CApath, to prevent Postfix from appending the  system-
	      supplied	default	 CAs.	This feature is available with Postfix
	      version 2.2.

       permit_tls_clientcerts
	      Permit the request when the remote SMTP client certificate  fin‐
	      gerprint	or  public  key fingerprint (Postfix 2.9 and later) is
	      listed in $relay_clientcerts.  The fingerprint digest  algorithm
	      is  configurable	via the smtpd_tls_fingerprint_digest parameter
	      (hard-coded as md5 prior to Postfix version 2.5).	 This  feature
	      is available with Postfix version 2.2.

       reject_rbl_client rbl_domain=d.d.d.d
	      Reject  the  request when the reversed client network address is
	      listed with the A record	"d.d.d.d"  under  rbl_domain  (Postfix
	      version 2.1 and later only).  Each "d" is a number, or a pattern
	      inside "[]" that contains one or more ";"-separated  numbers  or
	      number..number  ranges  (Postfix	version 2.8 and later).	 If no
	      "=d.d.d.d" is specified, reject the request  when	 the  reversed
	      client  network  address	is  listed  with  any  A  record under
	      rbl_domain.
	      The maps_rbl_reject_code parameter specifies the	response  code
	      for  rejected  requests  (default:   554), the default_rbl_reply
	      parameter	 specifies  the	 default   server   reply,   and   the
	      rbl_reply_maps   parameter  specifies tables with server replies
	      indexed by rbl_domain.  This feature is available in Postfix 2.0
	      and later.

       permit_dnswl_client dnswl_domain=d.d.d.d
	      Accept  the  request when the reversed client network address is
	      listed with the A record "d.d.d.d" under dnswl_domain.  Each "d"
	      is  a number, or a pattern inside "[]" that contains one or more
	      ";"-separated  numbers  or   number..number   ranges.    If   no
	      "=d.d.d.d"  is  specified,  accept the request when the reversed
	      client network  address  is  listed  with	 any  A	 record	 under
	      dnswl_domain.
	      For  safety,  permit_dnswl_client	 is  silently  ignored when it
	      would  override  reject_unauth_destination.    The   result   is
	      DEFER_IF_REJECT  when  whitelist	lookup fails.  This feature is
	      available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

       reject_rhsbl_client rbl_domain=d.d.d.d
	      Reject the request when the client hostname is listed with the A
	      record "d.d.d.d" under rbl_domain (Postfix version 2.1 and later
	      only).  Each "d" is a number, or a pattern inside "[]" that con‐
	      tains one or more ";"-separated numbers or number..number ranges
	      (Postfix version 2.8 and later).	If no "=d.d.d.d" is specified,
	      reject the request when the client hostname is listed with any A
	      record under rbl_domain. See the	reject_rbl_client  description
	      above for additional RBL related configuration parameters.  This
	      feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later; with Postfix ver‐
	      sion  2.8	 and  later,  reject_rhsbl_reverse_client will usually
	      produce better results.

       permit_rhswl_client rhswl_domain=d.d.d.d
	      Accept the request when the client hostname is listed with the A
	      record "d.d.d.d" under rhswl_domain.  Each "d" is a number, or a
	      pattern inside "[]" that contains one or more ";"-separated num‐
	      bers  or	number..number	ranges. If no "=d.d.d.d" is specified,
	      accept the request when the client hostname is listed with any A
	      record under rhswl_domain.
	      Caution:	client	name whitelisting is fragile, since the client
	      name lookup can fail due	to  temporary  outages.	  Client  name
	      whitelisting  should  be	used only to reduce false positives in
	      e.g.  DNS-based blocklists,  and	not  for  making  access  rule
	      exceptions.
	      For  safety,  permit_rhswl_client	 is  silently  ignored when it
	      would  override  reject_unauth_destination.    The   result   is
	      DEFER_IF_REJECT  when  whitelist	lookup fails.  This feature is
	      available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

       reject_rhsbl_reverse_client rbl_domain=d.d.d.d
	      Reject the request when the unverified reverse  client  hostname
	      is  listed  with	the A record "d.d.d.d" under rbl_domain.  Each
	      "d" is a number, or a pattern inside "[]" that contains  one  or
	      more  ";"-separated  numbers  or	number..number	ranges.	 If no
	      "=d.d.d.d" is specified, reject the request when the  unverified
	      reverse  client  hostname	 is  listed  with  any	A record under
	      rbl_domain. See  the  reject_rbl_client  description  above  for
	      additional  RBL  related configuration parameters.  This feature
	      is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

       reject_unknown_client_hostname	   (with      Postfix	   <	  2.3:
       reject_unknown_client)
	      Reject  the  request when 1) the client IP address->name mapping
	      fails,  2)  the  name->address  mapping	fails,	 or   3)   the
	      name->address mapping does not match the client IP address.
	      This	is     a     stronger	  restriction	  than	   the
	      reject_unknown_reverse_client_hostname feature,  which  triggers
	      only under condition 1) above.
	      The  unknown_client_reject_code parameter specifies the response
	      code for rejected requests (default: 450). The reply  is	always
	      450 in case the address->name or name->address lookup failed due
	      to a temporary problem.

       reject_unknown_reverse_client_hostname
	      Reject  the  request  when  the  client  IP   address   has   no
	      address->name mapping.
	      This	is	a      weaker	  restriction	  than	   the
	      reject_unknown_client_hostname feature, which requires not  only
	      that  the	 address->name	and  name->address mappings exist, but
	      also that the two mappings reproduce the client IP address.
	      The unknown_client_reject_code parameter specifies the  response
	      code  for rejected requests (default: 450).  The reply is always
	      450 in case the address->name lookup failed due to  a  temporary
	      problem.
	      This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

       In  addition,  you  can	use any of the following generic restrictions.
       These restrictions are applicable in any SMTP command context.

       check_policy_service servername
	      Query the specified policy server. See  the  SMTPD_POLICY_README
	      document	for  details. This feature is available in Postfix 2.1
	      and later.

       defer  Defer the request. The client is told to try again  later.  This
	      restriction  is useful at the end of a restriction list, to make
	      the default policy explicit.
	      The defer_code parameter specifies the SMTP  server  reply  code
	      (default: 450).

       defer_if_permit
	      Defer  the  request if some later restriction would result in an
	      explicit or implicit PERMIT  action.   This  is  useful  when  a
	      blacklisting  feature  fails  due	 to a temporary problem.  This
	      feature is available in Postfix version 2.1 and later.

       defer_if_reject
	      Defer the request if some later restriction would	 result	 in  a
	      REJECT action.  This is useful when a whitelisting feature fails
	      due to a temporary problem.  This feature is available in	 Post‐
	      fix version 2.1 and later.

       permit Permit  the  request. This restriction is useful at the end of a
	      restriction list, to make the default policy explicit.

       reject_multi_recipient_bounce
	      Reject the request when the envelope sender is the null address,
	      and the message has multiple envelope recipients. This usage has
	      rare but	legitimate  applications:  under  certain  conditions,
	      multi-recipient  mail  that  was	posted	with  the  DSN	option
	      NOTIFY=NEVER may be forwarded with the null sender address.
	      Note: this restriction can  only	work  reliably	when  used  in
	      smtpd_data_restrictions	 or    smtpd_end_of_data_restrictions,
	      because the total number of recipients is not known at  an  ear‐
	      lier stage of the SMTP conversation.  Use at the RCPT stage will
	      only reject the second etc.  recipient.
	      The multi_recipient_bounce_reject_code parameter	specifies  the
	      response	code for rejected requests (default:  550).  This fea‐
	      ture is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       reject_plaintext_session
	      Reject the request when the connection is	 not  encrypted.  This
	      restriction  should  not	be  used  before  the client has had a
	      chance to negotiate encryption with the AUTH  or	STARTTLS  com‐
	      mands.
	      The  plaintext_reject_code parameter specifies the response code
	      for rejected requests (default:  450).  This feature  is	avail‐
	      able in Postfix 2.3 and later.

       reject_unauth_pipelining
	      Reject  the request when the client sends SMTP commands ahead of
	      time where it is not allowed, or when the client sends SMTP com‐
	      mands  ahead  of time without knowing that Postfix actually sup‐
	      ports ESMTP command pipelining. This stops mail from  bulk  mail
	      software	that improperly uses ESMTP command pipelining in order
	      to speed up deliveries.
	      With Postfix 2.6 and later, the SMTP server sets	a  per-session
	      flag whenever it detects illegal pipelining, including pipelined
	      EHLO or HELO commands. The reject_unauth_pipelining feature sim‐
	      ply  tests  whether the flag was set at any point in time during
	      the session.
	      With older Postfix versions, reject_unauth_pipelining checks the
	      current  status  of  the	input read queue, and its usage is not
	      recommended in contexts other than smtpd_data_restrictions.

       reject Reject the request. This restriction is useful at the end	 of  a
	      restriction  list,  to  make  the	 default policy explicit.  The
	      reject_code configuration parameter specifies the response  code
	      for rejected requests (default: 554).

       sleep seconds
	      Pause  for  the specified number of seconds and proceed with the
	      next restriction in the list, if any. This may stop zombie  mail
	      when used as:
	      /etc/postfix/main.cf:
		  smtpd_client_restrictions =
		      sleep 1, reject_unauth_pipelining
		  smtpd_delay_reject = no
	      This feature is available in Postfix 2.3.

       warn_if_reject
	      A safety net for testing. When "warn_if_reject" is placed before
	      a reject-type restriction, access	 table	query,	or  check_pol‐
	      icy_service  query, this logs a "reject_warning" message instead
	      of rejecting a request (when a reject-type restriction fails due
	      to  a  temporary error, this logs a "reject_warning" message for
	      any implicit "defer_if_permit" actions that would normally  pre‐
	      vent mail from being accepted by some later access restriction).
	      This feature has no effect on defer_if_reject restrictions.

       Other restrictions that are valid in this context:

       ·      SMTP command specific restrictions that are described under  the
	      smtpd_helo_restrictions,	     smtpd_sender_restrictions	    or
	      smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameters. When  helo,  sender  or
	      recipient	 restrictions  are  listed under smtpd_client_restric‐
	      tions, they have effect only with "smtpd_delay_reject = yes", so
	      that  $smtpd_client_restrictions is evaluated at the time of the
	      RCPT TO command.

       Example:

       smtpd_client_restrictions = permit_mynetworks, reject_unknown_client_hostname

smtpd_command_filter (default: empty)
       A mechanism to transform commands from remote SMTP clients.  This is  a
       last-resort  tool to work around client commands that break inter-oper‐
       ability with the Postfix SMTP server.  Other uses involve fault	injec‐
       tion to test Postfix's handling of invalid commands.

       Specify	the  name of a "type:table" lookup table. The search string is
       the SMTP command as received from the remote SMTP client,  except  that
       initial	whitespace  and the trailing <CR><LF> are removed.  The result
       value is executed by the Postfix SMTP server.

       There is no need to use smtpd_command_filter for the following cases:

       ·      Use "resolve_numeric_domain = yes" to accept "user@ipaddress".

       ·      Postfix already accepts the correct form "user@[ipaddress]". Use
	      virtual_alias_maps  or  canonical_maps  to  translate these into
	      domain names if necessary.

       ·      Use "strict_rfc821_envelopes = no" to accept "RCPT TO:<User Name
	      <user@example.com>>".  Postfix  will ignore the "User Name" part
	      and deliver to the <user@example.com> address.

       Examples of problems that can be solved with  the  smtpd_command_filter
       feature:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
	   smtpd_command_filter = pcre:/etc/postfix/command_filter

       /etc/postfix/command_filter:
	   # Work around clients that send malformed HELO commands.
	   /^HELO\s*$/ HELO domain.invalid

	   # Work around clients that send empty lines.
	   /^\s*$/     NOOP

	   # Work around clients that send RCPT TO:<'user@domain'>.
	   # WARNING: do not lose the parameters that follow the address.
	   /^RCPT\s+TO:\s*<'([^[:space:]]+)'>(.*)/     RCPT TO:<$1>$2

	   # Append XVERP to MAIL FROM commands to request VERP-style delivery.
	   # See VERP_README for more information on how to use Postfix VERP.
	   /^(MAIL FROM:<listname@example\.com>.*)/   $1 XVERP

	   # Bounce-never mail sink. Use notify_classes=bounce,resource,software
	   # to send bounced mail to the postmaster (with message body removed).
	   /^(RCPT\s+TO:<.*>.*)\s+NOTIFY=\S+(.*)/ $1 NOTIFY=NEVER$2
	   /^(RCPT\s+TO:.*)/			$1 NOTIFY=NEVER

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7.

smtpd_data_restrictions (default: empty)
       Optional	 access	 restrictions  that the Postfix SMTP server applies in
       the context of the SMTP DATA command.  See SMTPD_ACCESS_README, section
       "Delayed	 evaluation of SMTP access restriction lists" for a discussion
       of evaluation context and time.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

       Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or  whitespace.
       Continue	 long  lines  by  starting  the	 next  line  with  whitespace.
       Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first  restric‐
       tion that matches wins.

       The following restrictions are valid in this context:

       ·      Generic  restrictions  that can be used in any SMTP command con‐
	      text, described under smtpd_client_restrictions.

       ·      SMTP   command	specific    restrictions    described	 under
	      smtpd_client_restrictions,	      smtpd_helo_restrictions,
	      smtpd_sender_restrictions or smtpd_recipient_restrictions.

       ·      However, no recipient information is available in	 the  case  of
	      multi-recipient mail. Acting on only one recipient would be mis‐
	      leading,	because	 any  decision	will  affect  all   recipients
	      equally.	Acting on all recipients would require a possibly very
	      large amount of memory, and would also  be  misleading  for  the
	      reasons mentioned before.

       Examples:

       smtpd_data_restrictions = reject_unauth_pipelining
       smtpd_data_restrictions = reject_multi_recipient_bounce

smtpd_delay_open_until_valid_rcpt (default: yes)
       Postpone	 the  start  of an SMTP mail transaction until a valid RCPT TO
       command is received. Specify "no" to create a mail transaction as  soon
       as the Postfix SMTP server receives a valid MAIL FROM command.

       With  sites  that  reject lots of mail, the default setting reduces the
       use of disk, CPU and memory resources. The downside  is	that  rejected
       recipients  are	logged	with NOQUEUE instead of a mail transaction ID.
       This complicates the logfile analysis of multi-recipient mail.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_delay_reject (default: yes)
       Wait until the RCPT TO command before evaluating $smtpd_client_restric‐
       tions, $smtpd_helo_restrictions and $smtpd_sender_restrictions, or wait
       until the ETRN command before evaluating $smtpd_client_restrictions and
       $smtpd_helo_restrictions.

       This  feature  is  turned on by default because some clients apparently
       mis-behave when the Postfix SMTP server rejects	commands  before  RCPT
       TO.

       The  default  setting  has  one major benefit: it allows Postfix to log
       recipient address information when rejecting a client  name/address  or
       sender  address, so that it is possible to find out whose mail is being
       rejected.

smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps (default: empty)
       Lookup tables, indexed by the remote SMTP  client  address,  with  case
       insensitive  lists  of EHLO keywords (pipelining, starttls, auth, etc.)
       that the Postfix SMTP server will not send in the EHLO  response	 to  a
       remote  SMTP  client. See smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords for details.  The
       table is not searched by hostname for robustness reasons.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_discard_ehlo_keywords (default: empty)
       A case insensitive list of EHLO keywords (pipelining,  starttls,	 auth,
       etc.)  that  the Postfix SMTP server will not send in the EHLO response
       to a remote SMTP client.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       Notes:

       ·      Specify the silent-discard pseudo keyword to prevent this action
	      from being logged.

       ·      Use  the smtpd_discard_ehlo_keyword_address_maps feature to dis‐
	      card EHLO keywords selectively.

smtpd_end_of_data_restrictions (default: empty)
       Optional access restrictions that the Postfix SMTP  server  applies  in
       the  context of the SMTP END-OF-DATA command.  See SMTPD_ACCESS_README,
       section "Delayed evaluation of SMTP access  restriction	lists"	for  a
       discussion of evaluation context and time.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

       See smtpd_data_restrictions for details and limitations.

smtpd_enforce_tls (default: no)
       Mandatory  TLS:	announce  STARTTLS support to remote SMTP clients, and
       require that clients use TLS encryption.	 According to  RFC  2487  this
       MUST NOT be applied in case of a publicly-referenced SMTP server.  This
       option is therefore off by default.

       Note 1: "smtpd_enforce_tls = yes" implies "smtpd_tls_auth_only = yes".

       Note 2: when invoked via	 "sendmail  -bs",  Postfix  will  never	 offer
       STARTTLS	 due  to  insufficient privileges to access the server private
       key. This is intended behavior.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.  With  Postfix  2.3
       and later use smtpd_tls_security_level instead.

smtpd_error_sleep_time (default: 1s)
       With  Postfix  version  2.1  and	 later: the SMTP server response delay
       after a client has made more than $smtpd_soft_error_limit  errors,  and
       fewer than $smtpd_hard_error_limit errors, without delivering mail.

       With  Postfix  version  2.0  and	 earlier: the SMTP server delay before
       sending a reject (4xx or 5xx) response, when the client has made	 fewer
       than $smtpd_soft_error_limit errors without delivering mail.

smtpd_etrn_restrictions (default: empty)
       Optional	 restrictions that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the con‐
       text of	a  client  ETRN	 command.   See	 SMTPD_ACCESS_README,  section
       "Delayed	 evaluation of SMTP access restriction lists" for a discussion
       of evaluation context and time.

       The Postfix ETRN implementation accepts only destinations that are eli‐
       gible  for  the	Postfix "fast flush" service. See the ETRN_README file
       for details.

       Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or  whitespace.
       Continue	 long  lines  by  starting  the	 next  line  with  whitespace.
       Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first  restric‐
       tion that matches wins.

       The  following restrictions are specific to the domain name information
       received with the ETRN command.

       check_etrn_access type:table
	      Search the specified access database for the ETRN domain name or
	      its parent domains. See the access(5) manual page for details.

       Other restrictions that are valid in this context:

       ·      Generic  restrictions  that can be used in any SMTP command con‐
	      text, described under smtpd_client_restrictions.

       ·      SMTP   command	specific    restrictions    described	 under
	      smtpd_client_restrictions and smtpd_helo_restrictions.

       Example:

       smtpd_etrn_restrictions = permit_mynetworks, reject

smtpd_expansion_filter (default: see postconf -d output)
       What characters are allowed in $name expansions of RBL reply templates.
       Characters not in the allowed set are replaced  by  "_".	  Use  C  like
       escapes to specify special characters such as whitespace.

       This parameter is not subjected to $parameter expansion.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

smtpd_forbidden_commands (default: CONNECT, GET, POST)
       List of commands that cause the Postfix SMTP server to immediately ter‐
       minate the session with a 221 code. This	 can  be  used	to  disconnect
       clients	that obviously attempt to abuse the system. In addition to the
       commands listed in this parameter, commands that	 follow	 the  "Label:"
       format of message headers will also cause a disconnect.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_hard_error_limit (default: normal: 20, overload: 1)
       The  maximal  number  of errors a remote SMTP client is allowed to make
       without delivering mail. The Postfix SMTP server disconnects  when  the
       limit  is  exceeded.  Normally  the default limit is 20, but it changes
       under overload to just 1. With Postfix 2.5 and earlier, the SMTP server
       always allows up to 20 errors by default.

smtpd_helo_required (default: no)
       Require	that  a	 remote SMTP client introduces itself with the HELO or
       EHLO command before sending the MAIL command  or	 other	commands  that
       require EHLO negotiation.

       Example:

       smtpd_helo_required = yes

smtpd_helo_restrictions (default: empty)
       Optional	 restrictions that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the con‐
       text of	a  client  HELO	 command.   See	 SMTPD_ACCESS_README,  section
       "Delayed	 evaluation of SMTP access restriction lists" for a discussion
       of evaluation context and time.

       The default is to permit everything.

       Note:  specify  "smtpd_helo_required  =	yes"  to  fully	 enforce  this
       restriction  (without  "smtpd_helo_required = yes", a client can simply
       skip smtpd_helo_restrictions by not sending HELO or EHLO).

       Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or  whitespace.
       Continue	 long  lines  by  starting  the	 next  line  with  whitespace.
       Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first  restric‐
       tion that matches wins.

       The  following  restrictions  are  specific to the hostname information
       received with the HELO or EHLO command.

       check_helo_access type:table
	      Search the specified access(5) database for  the	HELO  or  EHLO
	      hostname	or  parent  domains,  and  execute  the	 corresponding
	      action.  Note: specify  "smtpd_helo_required  =  yes"  to	 fully
	      enforce this restriction (without "smtpd_helo_required = yes", a
	      client can simply skip check_helo_access by not sending HELO  or
	      EHLO).

       check_helo_mx_access type:table
	      Search the specified access(5) database for the MX hosts for the
	      HELO or EHLO hostname, and  execute  the	corresponding  action.
	      Note  1:	a  result  of  "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons.
	      Instead, use DUNNO in  order  to	exclude	 specific  hosts  from
	      blacklists.   Note  2:  specify  "smtpd_helo_required  = yes" to
	      fully enforce this restriction (without  "smtpd_helo_required  =
	      yes", a client can simply skip check_helo_mx_access by not send‐
	      ing HELO or EHLO).  This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and
	      later.

       check_helo_ns_access type:table
	      Search  the specified access(5) database for the DNS servers for
	      the HELO or EHLO hostname, and execute the corresponding action.
	      Note  1:	a  result  of  "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons.
	      Instead, use DUNNO in  order  to	exclude	 specific  hosts  from
	      blacklists.   Note  2:  specify  "smtpd_helo_required  = yes" to
	      fully enforce this restriction (without  "smtpd_helo_required  =
	      yes", a client can simply skip check_helo_ns_access by not send‐
	      ing HELO or EHLO). This feature is available in Postfix 2.1  and
	      later.

       reject_invalid_helo_hostname  (with Postfix < 2.3: reject_invalid_host‐
       name)
	      Reject the request when the HELO or EHLO hostname is  malformed.
	      Note:  specify "smtpd_helo_required = yes" to fully enforce this
	      restriction (without "smtpd_helo_required = yes", a  client  can
	      simply  skip reject_invalid_helo_hostname by not sending HELO or
	      EHLO).
	      The invalid_hostname_reject_code specifies the response code for
	      rejected requests (default: 501).

       reject_non_fqdn_helo_hostname	   (with      Postfix	   <	  2.3:
       reject_non_fqdn_hostname)
	      Reject the request when the HELO or  EHLO	 hostname  is  not  in
	      fully-qualified domain form, as required by the RFC. Note: spec‐
	      ify "smtpd_helo_required = yes" to fully enforce	this  restric‐
	      tion  (without  "smtpd_helo_required = yes", a client can simply
	      skip reject_non_fqdn_helo_hostname by not sending HELO or EHLO).
	      The non_fqdn_reject_code parameter specifies the	response  code
	      for rejected requests (default: 504).

       reject_rhsbl_helo rbl_domain=d.d.d.d
	      Reject  the  request  when the HELO or EHLO hostname hostname is
	      listed with the A record	"d.d.d.d"  under  rbl_domain  (Postfix
	      version 2.1 and later only).  Each "d" is a number, or a pattern
	      inside "[]" that contains one or more ";"-separated  numbers  or
	      number..number  ranges  (Postfix	version 2.8 and later).	 If no
	      "=d.d.d.d" is specified, reject the request  when	 the  HELO  or
	      EHLO  hostname is listed with any A record under rbl_domain. See
	      the reject_rbl_client description	 for  additional  RBL  related
	      configuration  parameters.  Note: specify "smtpd_helo_required =
	      yes"   to	   fully    enforce    this    restriction    (without
	      "smtpd_helo_required   =	 yes",	 a   client  can  simply  skip
	      reject_rhsbl_helo by not sending HELO or EHLO). This feature  is
	      available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

       reject_unknown_helo_hostname  (with Postfix < 2.3: reject_unknown_host‐
       name)
	      Reject the request when the HELO or EHLO hostname has no	DNS  A
	      or MX record.
	      The unknown_hostname_reject_code parameter specifies the numeri‐
	      cal response code for rejected requests (default: 450).
	      The  unknown_helo_hostname_tempfail_action  parameter  specifies
	      the  action  after a temporary DNS error (default: defer_if_per‐
	      mit). Note: specify "smtpd_helo_required = yes" to fully enforce
	      this  restriction (without "smtpd_helo_required = yes", a client
	      can simply skip reject_unknown_helo_hostname by not sending HELO
	      or EHLO).

       Other restrictions that are valid in this context:

       ·      Generic  restrictions  that can be used in any SMTP command con‐
	      text, described under smtpd_client_restrictions.

       ·      Client  hostname	or  network  address   specific	  restrictions
	      described under smtpd_client_restrictions.

       ·      SMTP    command	 specific    restrictions    described	 under
	      smtpd_sender_restrictions or smtpd_recipient_restrictions.  When
	      sender	or    recipient	   restrictions	  are	listed	 under
	      smtpd_helo_restrictions,	 they	have	effect	  only	  with
	      "smtpd_delay_reject  = yes", so that $smtpd_helo_restrictions is
	      evaluated at the time of the RCPT TO command.

       Examples:

       smtpd_helo_restrictions = permit_mynetworks, reject_invalid_helo_hostname
       smtpd_helo_restrictions = permit_mynetworks, reject_unknown_helo_hostname

smtpd_history_flush_threshold (default: 100)
       The maximal number of lines in the Postfix SMTP server command  history
       before it is flushed upon receipt of EHLO, RSET, or end of DATA.

smtpd_junk_command_limit (default: normal: 100, overload: 1)
       The  number  of	junk commands (NOOP, VRFY, ETRN or RSET) that a remote
       SMTP client can send before the Postfix SMTP server starts to increment
       the  error  counter  with each junk command.  The junk command count is
       reset after mail is delivered.  See also the smtpd_error_sleep_time and
       smtpd_soft_error_limit  configuration parameters.  Normally the default
       limit is 100, but it changes under overload to just 1. With Postfix 2.5
       and  earlier,  the SMTP server always allows up to 100 junk commands by
       default.

smtpd_log_access_permit_actions (default: empty)
       Enable logging of the named "permit"  actions  in  SMTP	server	access
       lists  (by default, the SMTP server logs "reject" actions but not "per‐
       mit" actions).  This feature does not affect conditional	 actions  such
       as "defer_if_permit".

       Specify	a  list of "permit" action names, "/file/name" or "type:table"
       patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. The  list  is  matched
       left  to right, and the search stops on the first match. A "/file/name"
       pattern is replaced by its contents; a  "type:table"  lookup  table  is
       matched	when  a	 name  matches	a  lookup  key	(the  lookup result is
       ignored).  Continue long lines by starting the next  line  with	white‐
       space. Specify "!pattern" to exclude a name from the list.

       Examples:

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
	   # Log all "permit" actions.
	   smtpd_log_access_permit_actions = static:all

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
	   # Log "permit_dnswl_client" only.
	   smtpd_log_access_permit_actions = permit_dnswl_client

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.10 and later.

smtpd_milters (default: empty)
       A  list	of Milter (mail filter) applications for new mail that arrives
       via the Postfix smtpd(8) server. Specify space or comma	as  separator.
       See the MILTER_README document for details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_noop_commands (default: empty)
       List of commands that the Postfix SMTP server replies to with "250 Ok",
       without doing any syntax checks and without changing state.  This  list
       overrides any commands built into the Postfix SMTP server.

smtpd_null_access_lookup_key (default: <;>)
       The  lookup key to be used in SMTP access(5) tables instead of the null
       sender address.

smtpd_peername_lookup (default: yes)
       Attempt to look up the remote SMTP client hostname, and verify that the
       name  matches  the client IP address. A client name is set to "unknown"
       when it cannot be looked up or verified, or when name  lookup  is  dis‐
       abled.	Turning	 off  name lookup reduces delays due to DNS lookup and
       increases the maximal inbound delivery rate.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_per_record_deadline (default: normal: no, overload: yes)
       Change the behavior of the smtpd_timeout time limit, from a time	 limit
       per  read  or  write  system call, to a time limit to send or receive a
       complete record (an SMTP command line, SMTP response line, SMTP message
       content	line,  or  TLS protocol message).  This limits the impact from
       hostile peers that trickle data one byte at a time.

       Note: when per-record deadlines are enabled, a short timeout may	 cause
       problems	 with TLS over very slow network connections.  The reasons are
       that a TLS protocol message can be up to 16 kbytes long	(with  TLSv1),
       and that an entire TLS protocol message must be sent or received within
       the per-record deadline.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9 and later. With older  Postfix
       releases, the behavior is as if this parameter is set to "no".

smtpd_policy_service_max_idle (default: 300s)
       The time after which an idle SMTPD policy service connection is closed.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_policy_service_max_ttl (default: 1000s)
       The  time  after	 which	an  active  SMTPD policy service connection is
       closed.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_policy_service_timeout (default: 100s)
       The time limit for connecting to, writing to or receiving from a	 dele‐
       gated SMTPD policy server.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_proxy_ehlo (default: $myhostname)
       How  the	 Postfix SMTP server announces itself to the proxy filter.  By
       default, the Postfix hostname is used.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_proxy_filter (default: empty)
       The hostname and TCP port of the	 mail  filtering  proxy	 server.   The
       proxy  receives	all mail from the Postfix SMTP server, and is supposed
       to give the result to another Postfix SMTP server process.

       Specify	"host:port"  or	 "inet:host:port"  for	a  TCP	endpoint,   or
       "unix:pathname"	for  a UNIX-domain endpoint. The host can be specified
       as an IP address or as a symbolic name; no MX lookups are  done.	  When
       no  "host"  or  "host:"	 are  specified, the local machine is assumed.
       Pathname interpretation is relative to the Postfix queue directory.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       The "inet:" and "unix:" prefixes	 are  available	 in  Postfix  2.3  and
       later.

smtpd_proxy_options (default: empty)
       List  of	 options that control how the Postfix SMTP server communicates
       with a before-queue content filter. Specify zero or more of the follow‐
       ing, separated by comma or whitespace.

       speed_adjust
	      Do  not connect to a before-queue content filter until an entire
	      message has been received. This reduces the number of simultane‐
	      ous before-queue content filter processes.

       NOTE  1:	 A  filter  must not selectively reject recipients of a multi-
       recipient message.  Rejecting all recipients is OK, as is accepting all
       recipients.

       NOTE  2:	 This feature increases the minimum amount of free queue space
       by $message_size_limit. The extra space is needed to save  the  message
       to a temporary file.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.7 and later.

smtpd_proxy_timeout (default: 100s)
       The  time  limit	 for  connecting  to a proxy filter and for sending or
       receiving information.  When a  connection  fails  the  client  gets  a
       generic	error message while more detailed information is logged to the
       maillog file.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_recipient_limit (default: 1000)
       The  maximal  number of recipients that the Postfix SMTP server accepts
       per message delivery request.

smtpd_recipient_overshoot_limit (default: 1000)
       The number of recipients that a remote SMTP client can send  in	excess
       of  the limit specified with $smtpd_recipient_limit, before the Postfix
       SMTP server increments the per-session  error  count  for  each	excess
       recipient.

smtpd_recipient_restrictions (default: see postconf -d output)
       Optional	 restrictions that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the con‐
       text of a client RCPT TO command, after smtpd_relay_restrictions.   See
       SMTPD_ACCESS_README,   section	"Delayed  evaluation  of  SMTP	access
       restriction lists" for a discussion of evaluation context and time.

       With Postfix versions before 2.10, the rules for relay  permission  and
       spam blocking were combined under smtpd_recipient_restrictions, result‐
       ing in error-prone configuration.  As of Postfix 2.10, relay permission
       rules are preferably implemented with smtpd_relay_restrictions, so that
       a permissive spam blocking  policy  under  smtpd_recipient_restrictions
       will no longer result in a permissive mail relay policy.

       For  backwards  compatibility, sites that migrate from Postfix versions
       before 2.10 can set smtpd_relay_restrictions to the  empty  value,  and
       use smtpd_recipient_restrictions exactly as before.

       IMPORTANT:  Either  the	smtpd_relay_restrictions  or the smtpd_recipi‐
       ent_restrictions parameter must specify at least one of	the  following
       restrictions. Otherwise Postfix will refuse to receive mail:

	   reject, reject_unauth_destination

	   defer, defer_if_permit, defer_unauth_destination

       Specify	a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or whitespace.
       Continue	 long  lines  by  starting  the	 next  line  with  whitespace.
       Restrictions  are applied in the order as specified; the first restric‐
       tion that matches wins.

       The following restrictions are specific to the recipient	 address  that
       is received with the RCPT TO command.

       check_recipient_access type:table
	      Search the specified access(5) database for the resolved RCPT TO
	      address, domain, parent domains, or localpart@, and execute  the
	      corresponding action.

       check_recipient_mx_access type:table
	      Search the specified access(5) database for the MX hosts for the
	      RCPT TO domain, and execute the corresponding action.   Note:  a
	      result  of  "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead, use
	      DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from blacklists.	  This
	      feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       check_recipient_ns_access type:table
	      Search  the specified access(5) database for the DNS servers for
	      the RCPT TO domain, and execute the corresponding action.	 Note:
	      a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead, use
	      DUNNO in order to exclude specific hosts from blacklists.	  This
	      feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       permit_auth_destination
	      Permit the request when one of the following is true:

       ·      Postfix  is  mail forwarder: the resolved RCPT TO domain matches
	      $relay_domains or a subdomain thereof, and the address  contains
	      no sender-specified routing (user@elsewhere@domain),

       ·      Postfix  is  the	final destination: the resolved RCPT TO domain
	      matches  $mydestination,	$inet_interfaces,   $proxy_interfaces,
	      $virtual_alias_domains,  or  $virtual_mailbox_domains,  and  the
	      address  contains	 no   sender-specified	 routing   (user@else‐
	      where@domain).

       permit_mx_backup
	      Permit  the  request when the local mail system is backup MX for
	      the RCPT TO domain, or when the domain is an authorized destina‐
	      tion (see permit_auth_destination for definition).

       ·      Safety:  permit_mx_backup	 does  not  accept addresses that have
	      sender-specified	routing	  information	(example:   user@else‐
	      where@domain).

       ·      Safety:  permit_mx_backup	 can  be  vulnerable  to  mis-use when
	      access is not restricted with permit_mx_backup_networks.

       ·      Safety: as of Postfix version 2.3,  permit_mx_backup  no	longer
	      accepts the address when the local mail system is primary MX for
	      the recipient domain.  Exception: permit_mx_backup  accepts  the
	      address  when  it	 specifies an authorized destination (see per‐
	      mit_auth_destination for definition).

       ·      Limitation: mail may be rejected in  case	 of  a	temporary  DNS
	      lookup problem with Postfix prior to version 2.0.

       reject_non_fqdn_recipient
	      Reject  the  request  when  the RCPT TO address is not in fully-
	      qualified domain form, as required by the RFC.
	      The non_fqdn_reject_code parameter specifies the	response  code
	      for rejected requests (default: 504).

       reject_rhsbl_recipient rbl_domain=d.d.d.d
	      Reject  the request when the RCPT TO domain is listed with the A
	      record "d.d.d.d" under rbl_domain (Postfix version 2.1 and later
	      only).  Each "d" is a number, or a pattern inside "[]" that con‐
	      tains one or more ";"-separated numbers or number..number ranges
	      (Postfix	version 2.8 and later). If no "=d.d.d.d" is specified,
	      reject the request when the RCPT TO domain is listed with any  A
	      record under rbl_domain.
	      The  maps_rbl_reject_code	 parameter specifies the response code
	      for rejected  requests  (default:	 554);	the  default_rbl_reply
	      parameter	  specifies   the   default   server  reply;  and  the
	      rbl_reply_maps parameter specifies tables	 with  server  replies
	      indexed  by  rbl_domain.	 This  feature is available in Postfix
	      version 2.0 and later.

       reject_unauth_destination
	      Reject the request unless one of the following is true:

       ·      Postfix is mail forwarder: the resolved RCPT TO  domain  matches
	      $relay_domains  or  a subdomain thereof, and contains no sender-
	      specified routing (user@elsewhere@domain),

       ·      Postfix is the final destination: the resolved  RCPT  TO	domain
	      matches	$mydestination,	 $inet_interfaces,  $proxy_interfaces,
	      $virtual_alias_domains, or  $virtual_mailbox_domains,  and  con‐
	      tains no sender-specified routing (user@elsewhere@domain).
	      The  relay_domains_reject_code  parameter specifies the response
	      code for rejected requests (default: 554).

       defer_unauth_destination
	      Reject the same requests as  reject_unauth_destination,  with  a
	      non-permanent  error code.  This feature is available in Postfix
	      2.10 and later.

       reject_unknown_recipient_domain
	      Reject the request when Postfix is not final destination for the
	      recipient	 domain,  and the RCPT TO domain has 1) no DNS A or MX
	      record or 2) a malformed MX record such as a record with a zero-
	      length MX hostname (Postfix version 2.3 and later).
	      The  unknown_address_reject_code parameter specifies the numeri‐
	      cal response code for rejected  requests	(default:  450).   The
	      response is always 450 in case of a temporary DNS error.
	      The   unknown_address_tempfail_action  parameter	specifies  the
	      action after a temporary DNS error (default: defer_if_permit).

       reject_unlisted_recipient  (with	 Postfix  version  2.0:	 check_recipi‐
       ent_maps)
	      Reject the request when the RCPT TO address is not listed in the
	      list  of	valid  recipients  for	its  domain  class.  See   the
	      smtpd_reject_unlisted_recipient	 parameter   description   for
	      details.	This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       reject_unverified_recipient
	      Reject the request when mail to the RCPT TO address is known  to
	      bounce,  or when the recipient address destination is not reach‐
	      able.  Address verification information is managed by  the  ver‐
	      ify(8)  server;  see  the	 ADDRESS_VERIFICATION_README  file for
	      details.
	      The  unverified_recipient_reject_code  parameter	specifies  the
	      numerical	 response  code	 when  an  address  is known to bounce
	      (default: 450, change into 550 when you are confident that it is
	      safe to do so).
	      The   unverified_recipient_defer_code  parameter	specifies  the
	      numerical response code when an address probe failed  due	 to  a
	      temporary problem (default: 450).
	      The unverified_recipient_tempfail_action parameter specifies the
	      action after addres probe failure due  to	 a  temporary  problem
	      (default: defer_if_permit).
	      This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       Other restrictions that are valid in this context:

       ·      Generic  restrictions  that can be used in any SMTP command con‐
	      text, described under smtpd_client_restrictions.

       ·      SMTP   command	specific    restrictions    described	 under
	      smtpd_client_restrictions,      smtpd_helo_restrictions	   and
	      smtpd_sender_restrictions.

       Example:

       # The Postfix before 2.10 default mail relay policy. Later Postfix
       # versions implement this preferably with smtpd_relay_restrictions.
       smtpd_recipient_restrictions = permit_mynetworks, reject_unauth_destination

smtpd_reject_footer (default: empty)
       Optional information that is appended after each	 Postfix  SMTP	server
       4XX or 5XX response.

       The following example uses "\c" at the start of the template (supported
       in Postfix 2.10 and later) to suppress the line break between the reply
       text  and  the  footer  text. With earlier Postfix versions, the footer
       text always begins on a new line, and the "\c" is output literally.

       /etc/postfix/main.cf:
	   smtpd_reject_footer = \c. For assistance, call 800-555-0101.
	    Please provide the following information in your problem report:
	    time ($localtime), client ($client_address) and server
	    ($server_name).

       Server response:

	   550-5.5.1 <user@example> Recipient address rejected: User
	   unknown. For assistance, call 800-555-0101. Please provide the
	   following information in your problem report: time (Jan 4 15:42:00),
	   client (192.168.1.248) and server (mail1.example.com).

       Note: the above text is meant to make it easier	to  find  the  Postfix
       logfile	records	 for  a	 failed	 SMTP  session. The text itself is not
       logged to the Postfix SMTP server's maillog file.

       Be sure to keep the text as short as possible. Long text may  be	 trun‐
       cated  before it is logged to the remote SMTP client's maillog file, or
       before it is returned to the sender in a delivery status notification.

       This feature supports a limited	number	of  $name  attributes  in  the
       footer  text.  These  are  replaced by their current value for the SMTP
       session:

       client_address
	      The Client IP address that is logged in the maillog file.

       client_port
	      The client TCP port that is logged in the maillog file.

       localtime
	      The server local time (Mmm dd hh:mm:ss) that is  logged  in  the
	      maillog file.

       server_name
	      The server's myhostname value.  This attribute is made available
	      for sites with multiple MTAs (perhaps behind  a  load-balancer),
	      where  the  server  name	can  help  the	server support team to
	      quickly find the right log files.

       Notes:

       ·      NOT SUPPORTED are other attributes such as sender, recipient, or
	      main.cf parameters.

       ·      For  safety  reasons,  text  that	 does  not match $smtpd_expan‐
	      sion_filter is censored.

       This feature supports the two-character sequence \n as a request for  a
       line break in the footer text. Postfix automatically inserts after each
       line break the three-digit SMTP reply code (and optional enhanced  sta‐
       tus code) from the original Postfix reject message.

       To work around mail software that mis-handles multi-line replies, spec‐
       ify the two-character sequence \c at the start of the  template.	  This
       suppresses  the	line  break between the reply text and the footer text
       (Postfix 2.10 and later).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

smtpd_reject_unlisted_recipient (default: yes)
       Request that the Postfix SMTP server rejects mail for unknown recipient
       addresses,  even	 when  no  explicit  reject_unlisted_recipient	access
       restriction is specified. This prevents the Postfix queue from  filling
       up with undeliverable MAILER-DAEMON messages.

       An  address  is	always considered "known" when it matches a virtual(5)
       alias or a canonical(5) mapping.

       ·      The recipient domain matches $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or
	      $proxy_interfaces,   but	 the   recipient   is  not  listed  in
	      $local_recipient_maps, and $local_recipient_maps is not null.

       ·      The recipient  domain  matches  $virtual_alias_domains  but  the
	      recipient is not listed in $virtual_alias_maps.

       ·      The  recipient  domain  matches $virtual_mailbox_domains but the
	      recipient is not	listed	in  $virtual_mailbox_maps,  and	 $vir‐
	      tual_mailbox_maps is not null.

       ·      The recipient domain matches $relay_domains but the recipient is
	      not listed in $relay_recipient_maps,  and	 $relay_recipient_maps
	      is not null.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_reject_unlisted_sender (default: no)
       Request	that  the Postfix SMTP server rejects mail from unknown sender
       addresses, even when no explicit reject_unlisted_sender access restric‐
       tion  is specified. This can slow down an explosion of forged mail from
       worms or viruses.

       An address is always considered "known" when it	matches	 a  virtual(5)
       alias or a canonical(5) mapping.

       ·      The  sender  domain  matches $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or
	      $proxy_interfaces, but the sender is not listed in $local_recip‐
	      ient_maps, and $local_recipient_maps is not null.

       ·      The  sender domain matches $virtual_alias_domains but the sender
	      is not listed in $virtual_alias_maps.

       ·      The  sender  domain  matches  $virtual_mailbox_domains  but  the
	      sender   is  not	listed	in  $virtual_mailbox_maps,  and	 $vir‐
	      tual_mailbox_maps is not null.

       ·      The sender domain matches $relay_domains but the sender  is  not
	      listed  in  $relay_recipient_maps,  and $relay_recipient_maps is
	      not null.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_relay_restrictions  (default:  permit_mynetworks,	 permit_sasl_authenti‐
       cated, defer_unauth_destination)
       Access restrictions for mail relay control that the Postfix SMTP server
       applies in the context of the RCPT  TO  command,	 before	 smtpd_recipi‐
       ent_restrictions.  See SMTPD_ACCESS_README, section "Delayed evaluation
       of SMTP access restriction lists" for a discussion of  evaluation  con‐
       text and time.

       With  Postfix  versions before 2.10, the rules for relay permission and
       spam blocking were combined under smtpd_recipient_restrictions, result‐
       ing in error-prone configuration.  As of Postfix 2.10, relay permission
       rules are preferably implemented with smtpd_relay_restrictions, so that
       a  permissive  spam  blocking policy under smtpd_recipient_restrictions
       will no longer result in a permissive mail relay policy.

       For backwards compatibility, sites that migrate from  Postfix  versions
       before  2.10  can  set smtpd_relay_restrictions to the empty value, and
       use smtpd_recipient_restrictions exactly as before.

       By default, the Postfix SMTP server accepts:

       ·      Mail from clients whose IP address matches $mynetworks, or:

       ·      Mail to remote destinations that	match  $relay_domains,	except
	      for  addresses that contain sender-specified routing (user@else‐
	      where@domain), or:

       ·      Mail  to	local  destinations  that  match  $inet_interfaces  or
	      $proxy_interfaces,  $mydestination,  $virtual_alias_domains,  or
	      $virtual_mailbox_domains.

       IMPORTANT: Either the  smtpd_relay_restrictions	or  the	 smtpd_recipi‐
       ent_restrictions	 parameter  must specify at least one of the following
       restrictions. Otherwise Postfix will refuse to receive mail:

	   reject, reject_unauth_destination

	   defer, defer_if_permit, defer_unauth_destination

       Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or  whitespace.
       Continue	 long  lines  by  starting the next line with whitespace.  The
       same restrictions  are  available  as  documented  under	 smtpd_recipi‐
       ent_restrictions.

       This feature is available in Postix 2.10 and later.

smtpd_restriction_classes (default: empty)
       User-defined aliases for groups of access restrictions. The aliases can
       be specified in smtpd_recipient_restrictions etc., and  on  the	right-
       hand side of a Postfix access(5) table.

       One  major  application	is for implementing per-recipient UCE control.
       See the RESTRICTION_CLASS_README document for other examples.

smtpd_sasl_application_name (default: smtpd)
       The application name that the Postfix SMTP server uses for SASL	server
       initialization.	This controls the name of the SASL configuration file.
       The default value is smtpd, corresponding to a SASL configuration  file
       named smtpd.conf.

       This  feature  is available in Postfix 2.1 and 2.2. With Postfix 2.3 it
       was renamed to smtpd_sasl_path.

smtpd_sasl_auth_enable (default: no)
       Enable SASL authentication in the Postfix SMTP server. By default,  the
       Postfix SMTP server does not use authentication.

       If a remote SMTP client is authenticated, the permit_sasl_authenticated
       access restriction can be used to permit relay access, like this:

	   # With Postfix 2.10 and later, the mail relay policy is
	   # preferably specified under smtpd_relay_restrictions.
	   smtpd_relay_restrictions =
	       permit_mynetworks, permit_sasl_authenticated, ...

       # With Postfix before 2.10, the relay policy can be
       # specified only under smtpd_recipient_restrictions.
       smtpd_recipient_restrictions =
	   permit_mynetworks, permit_sasl_authenticated, ...

       To reject all SMTP connections from  unauthenticated  clients,  specify
       "smtpd_delay_reject = yes" (which is the default) and use:

	   smtpd_client_restrictions = permit_sasl_authenticated, reject

       See the SASL_README file for SASL configuration and operation details.

smtpd_sasl_authenticated_header (default: no)
       Report  the  SASL authenticated user name in the smtpd(8) Received mes‐
       sage header.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_sasl_exceptions_networks (default: empty)
       What remote SMTP clients the Postfix SMTP server will  not  offer  AUTH
       support to.

       Some  clients  (Netscape	 4  at	least)	have a bug that causes them to
       require a login and password whenever AUTH  is  offered,	 whether  it's
       necessary  or  not.  To work around this, specify, for example, $mynet‐
       works to prevent Postfix from offering AUTH to local clients.

       Specify a list of network/netmask patterns, separated by commas	and/or
       whitespace.  The	 mask specifies the number of bits in the network part
       of a host address. You can also "/file/name" or "type:table"  patterns.
       A  "/file/name"	pattern	 is  replaced  by its contents; a "type:table"
       lookup table is matched when a table entry matches a lookup string (the
       lookup  result  is  ignored).  Continue long lines by starting the next
       line with whitespace. Specify "!pattern" to exclude an address or  net‐
       work  block from the list.  The form "!/file/name" is supported only in
       Postfix version 2.4 and later.

       Note: IP version 6 address information must be specified inside	[]  in
       the  smtpd_sasl_exceptions_networks  value, and in files specified with
       "/file/name".  IP version 6 addresses contain the  ":"  character,  and
       would otherwise be confused with a "type:table" pattern.

       Example:

       smtpd_sasl_exceptions_networks = $mynetworks

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

smtpd_sasl_local_domain (default: empty)
       The name of the Postfix SMTP server's local SASL authentication realm.

       By default, the local authentication realm name is the null string.

       Examples:

       smtpd_sasl_local_domain = $mydomain
       smtpd_sasl_local_domain = $myhostname

smtpd_sasl_path (default: smtpd)
       Implementation-specific information that the Postfix SMTP server passes
       through to the  SASL  plug-in  implementation  that  is	selected  with
       smtpd_sasl_type.	  Typically this specifies the name of a configuration
       file or rendezvous point.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later. In earlier releases
       it was called smtpd_sasl_application_name.

smtpd_sasl_security_options (default: noanonymous)
       Postfix	SMTP  server SASL security options; as of Postfix 2.3 the list
       of available features depends on the SASL server implementation that is
       selected with smtpd_sasl_type.

       The  following  security features are defined for the cyrus server SASL
       implementation:

       Restrict what authentication mechanisms the Postfix  SMTP  server  will
       offer  to  the client.  The list of available authentication mechanisms
       is system dependent.

       Specify zero or more of the following:

       noplaintext
	      Disallow methods that use plaintext passwords.

       noactive
	      Disallow methods subject to active (non-dictionary) attack.

       nodictionary
	      Disallow methods subject to passive (dictionary) attack.

       noanonymous
	      Disallow methods that allow anonymous authentication.

       forward_secrecy
	      Only allow methods that support forward secrecy (Dovecot only).

       mutual_auth
	      Only allow  methods  that	 provide  mutual  authentication  (not
	      available with Cyrus SASL version 1).

       By default, the Postfix SMTP server accepts plaintext passwords but not
       anonymous logins.

       Warning: it appears that clients	 try  authentication  methods  in  the
       order  as  advertised  by  the  server (e.g., PLAIN ANONYMOUS CRAM-MD5)
       which means that if you disable plaintext passwords, clients  will  log
       in  anonymously, even when they should be able to use CRAM-MD5.	So, if
       you disable plaintext logins, disable anonymous	logins	too.   Postfix
       treats anonymous login as no authentication.

       Example:

       smtpd_sasl_security_options = noanonymous, noplaintext

smtpd_sasl_tls_security_options (default: $smtpd_sasl_security_options)
       The  SASL  authentication security options that the Postfix SMTP server
       uses for TLS encrypted SMTP sessions.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_sasl_type (default: cyrus)
       The SASL plug-in type that the  Postfix	SMTP  server  should  use  for
       authentication.	The  available types are listed with the "postconf -a"
       command.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_sender_login_maps (default: empty)
       Optional lookup table with the SASL login names that own	 sender	 (MAIL
       FROM) addresses.

       Specify	zero  or  more	"type:table"  lookup tables. With lookups from
       indexed files such as DB or DBM, or from networked tables such as  NIS,
       LDAP  or	 SQL,  the  following search operations are done with a sender
       address of user@domain:

       1) user@domain
	      This table lookup is always done and has the highest precedence.

       2) user
	      This table lookup is done only  when  the	 domain	 part  of  the
	      sender  address  matches $myorigin, $mydestination, $inet_inter‐
	      faces or $proxy_interfaces.

       3) @domain
	      This table lookup is done last and has the lowest precedence.

       In all cases the result of table lookup must be either "not found" or a
       list of SASL login names separated by comma and/or whitespace.

smtpd_sender_restrictions (default: empty)
       Optional	 restrictions that the Postfix SMTP server applies in the con‐
       text of a client MAIL FROM command.  See	 SMTPD_ACCESS_README,  section
       "Delayed	 evaluation of SMTP access restriction lists" for a discussion
       of evaluation context and time.

       The default is to permit everything.

       Specify a list of restrictions, separated by commas and/or  whitespace.
       Continue	 long  lines  by  starting  the	 next  line  with  whitespace.
       Restrictions are applied in the order as specified; the first  restric‐
       tion that matches wins.

       The  following restrictions are specific to the sender address received
       with the MAIL FROM command.

       check_sender_access type:table
	      Search the  specified  access(5)	database  for  the  MAIL  FROM
	      address,	domain, parent domains, or localpart@, and execute the
	      corresponding action.

       check_sender_mx_access type:table
	      Search the specified access(5) database for the MX hosts for the
	      MAIL  FROM address, and execute the corresponding action.	 Note:
	      a result of "OK" is not allowed for safety reasons. Instead, use
	      DUNNO  in order to exclude specific hosts from blacklists.  This
	      feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       check_sender_ns_access type:table
	      Search the specified access(5) database for the DNS servers  for
	      the  MAIL	 FROM  address,	 and execute the corresponding action.
	      Note: a result of	 "OK"  is  not	allowed	 for  safety  reasons.
	      Instead,	use  DUNNO  in	order  to  exclude specific hosts from
	      blacklists.  This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       reject_authenticated_sender_login_mismatch
	      Enforces	the   reject_sender_login_mismatch   restriction   for
	      authenticated clients only. This feature is available in Postfix
	      version 2.1 and later.

       reject_non_fqdn_sender
	      Reject the request when the MAIL FROM address is not  in	fully-
	      qualified domain form, as required by the RFC.
	      The  non_fqdn_reject_code	 parameter specifies the response code
	      for rejected requests (default: 504).

       reject_rhsbl_sender rbl_domain=d.d.d.d
	      Reject the request when the MAIL FROM domain is listed with  the
	      A	 record	 "d.d.d.d"  under  rbl_domain (Postfix version 2.1 and
	      later only).  Each "d" is a number, or  a	 pattern  inside  "[]"
	      that  contains one or more ";"-separated numbers or number..num‐
	      ber ranges (Postfix version 2.8 and later). If no "=d.d.d.d"  is
	      specified,  reject  the  request	when  the  MAIL FROM domain is
	      listed with any A record under rbl_domain.
	      The maps_rbl_reject_code parameter specifies the	response  code
	      for  rejected  requests  (default:   554); the default_rbl_reply
	      parameter	 specifies  the	 default   server   reply;   and   the
	      rbl_reply_maps  parameter	 specifies  tables with server replies
	      indexed by rbl_domain.  This feature is available in Postfix 2.0
	      and later.

       reject_sender_login_mismatch
	      Reject  the  request  when $smtpd_sender_login_maps specifies an
	      owner for the MAIL FROM address, but the client  is  not	(SASL)
	      logged in as that MAIL FROM address owner; or when the client is
	      (SASL) logged in, but the client login name doesn't own the MAIL
	      FROM address according to $smtpd_sender_login_maps.

       reject_unauthenticated_sender_login_mismatch
	      Enforces	the reject_sender_login_mismatch restriction for unau‐
	      thenticated clients only. This feature is available  in  Postfix
	      version 2.1 and later.

       reject_unknown_sender_domain
	      Reject the request when Postfix is not final destination for the
	      sender address, and the MAIL FROM domain has 1) no DNS A	or  MX
	      record,  or  2)  a  malformed  MX record such as a record with a
	      zero-length MX hostname (Postfix version 2.3 and later).
	      The unknown_address_reject_code parameter specifies the  numeri‐
	      cal  response  code  for	rejected requests (default: 450).  The
	      response is always 450 in case of a temporary DNS error.
	      The  unknown_address_tempfail_action  parameter  specifies   the
	      action after a temporary DNS error (default: defer_if_permit).

       reject_unlisted_sender
	      Reject  the  request when the MAIL FROM address is not listed in
	      the list of valid recipients  for	 its  domain  class.  See  the
	      smtpd_reject_unlisted_sender  parameter description for details.
	      This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       reject_unverified_sender
	      Reject the request when mail to the MAIL FROM address  is	 known
	      to  bounce, or when the sender address destination is not reach‐
	      able.  Address verification information is managed by  the  ver‐
	      ify(8)  server;  see  the	 ADDRESS_VERIFICATION_README  file for
	      details.
	      The unverified_sender_reject_code parameter specifies the numer‐
	      ical  response code when an address is known to bounce (default:
	      450, change into 550 when you are confident that it is  safe  to
	      do so).
	      The   unverified_sender_defer_code   specifies   the   numerical
	      response code when an address address probe failed due to a tem‐
	      porary problem (default: 450).
	      The  unverified_sender_tempfail_action  parameter	 specifies the
	      action after address probe failure due to	 a  temporary  problem
	      (default: defer_if_permit).
	      This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

       Other restrictions that are valid in this context:

       ·      Generic  restrictions  that can be used in any SMTP command con‐
	      text, described under smtpd_client_restrictions.

       ·      SMTP   command	specific    restrictions    described	 under
	      smtpd_client_restrictions and smtpd_helo_restrictions.

       ·      SMTP command specific restrictions described under smtpd_recipi‐
	      ent_restrictions. When recipient restrictions are	 listed	 under
	      smtpd_sender_restrictions,    they   have	  effect   only	  with
	      "smtpd_delay_reject = yes", so  that  $smtpd_sender_restrictions
	      is evaluated at the time of the RCPT TO command.

       Examples:

       smtpd_sender_restrictions = reject_unknown_sender_domain
       smtpd_sender_restrictions = reject_unknown_sender_domain,
	   check_sender_access hash:/etc/postfix/access

smtpd_service_name (default: smtpd)
       The  internal  service that postscreen(8) hands off allowed connections
       to. In a future version there may be different classes of SMTP service.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

smtpd_soft_error_limit (default: 10)
       The number of errors a remote SMTP client is allowed  to	 make  without
       delivering  mail	 before	 the  Postfix  SMTP  server slows down all its
       responses.

       ·      With Postfix version 2.1 and  later,  the	 Postfix  SMTP	server
	      delays all responses by $smtpd_error_sleep_time seconds.

       ·      With  Postfix  versions 2.0 and earlier, the Postfix SMTP server
	      delays all responses by (number of errors) seconds.

smtpd_starttls_timeout (default: see postconf -d output)
       The time limit for Postfix SMTP server write and read operations during
       TLS  startup  and  shutdown  handshake  procedures. The current default
       value is stress-dependent. Before Postfix version 2.8, it was fixed  at
       300s.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_timeout (default: normal: 300s, overload: 10s)
       The  time  limit	 for  sending  a  Postfix SMTP server response and for
       receiving a remote SMTP client request. Normally the default  limit  is
       300s,  but  it changes under overload to just 10s. With Postfix 2.5 and
       earlier, the SMTP server always uses a time limit of 300s by default.

       Note: if you set SMTP time limits to very large values you may have  to
       update the global ipc_timeout parameter.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

smtpd_tls_CAfile (default: empty)
       A file containing (PEM format) CA certificates of root CAs  trusted  to
       sign either remote SMTP client certificates or intermediate CA certifi‐
       cates.  These are loaded into memory before the smtpd(8) server	enters
       the  chroot  jail.  If  the  number of trusted roots is large, consider
       using smtpd_tls_CApath instead, but note that the latter directory must
       be  present in the chroot jail if the smtpd(8) server is chrooted. This
       file may also be used to augment the server  certificate	 trust	chain,
       but it is best to include all the required certificates directly in the
       server certificate file.

       Specify "smtpd_tls_CAfile = /path/to/system_CA_file" to	use  ONLY  the
       system-supplied default certificate authority certificates.

       Specify	"tls_append_default_CA = no" to prevent Postfix from appending
       the system-supplied default CAs and trusting third-party certificates.

       By default  (see	 smtpd_tls_ask_ccert),	client	certificates  are  not
       requested, and smtpd_tls_CAfile should remain empty. If you do make use
       of client certificates, the distinguished names (DNs) of	 the  certifi‐
       cate authorities listed in smtpd_tls_CAfile are sent to the remote SMTP
       client in the client certificate request message.  MUAs	with  multiple
       client  certificates may use the list of preferred certificate authori‐
       ties to select the correct client certificate.  You  may	 want  to  put
       your  "preferred" CA or CAs in this file, and install other trusted CAs
       in $smtpd_tls_CApath.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_CAfile = /etc/postfix/CAcert.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_CApath (default: empty)
       A directory containing (PEM format) CA certificates of root CAs trusted
       to  sign either remote SMTP client certificates or intermediate CA cer‐
       tificates. Do not forget to create the necessary "hash" links with, for
       example,	  "$OPENSSL_HOME/bin/c_rehash	/etc/postfix/certs".   To  use
       smtpd_tls_CApath in chroot mode, this directory (or  a  copy)  must  be
       inside the chroot jail.

       Specify	"smtpd_tls_CApath  = /path/to/system_CA_directory" to use ONLY
       the system-supplied default certificate authority certificates.

       Specify "tls_append_default_CA = no" to prevent Postfix from  appending
       the system-supplied default CAs and trusting third-party certificates.

       By  default  (see  smtpd_tls_ask_ccert),	 client	 certificates  are not
       requested, and smtpd_tls_CApath should remain  empty.  In  contrast  to
       smtpd_tls_CAfile,   DNs	 of   certificate   authorities	 installed  in
       $smtpd_tls_CApath are not included in the  client  certificate  request
       message.	 MUAs  with  multiple  client certificates may use the list of
       preferred certificate authorities to select the correct client certifi‐
       cate.	You   may   want   to  put  your  "preferred"  CA  or  CAs  in
       $smtpd_tls_CAfile,  and	install	  the	remaining   trusted   CAs   in
       $smtpd_tls_CApath.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_CApath = /etc/postfix/certs

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_always_issue_session_ids (default: yes)
       Force  the Postfix SMTP server to issue a TLS session id, even when TLS
       session caching	is  turned  off	 (smtpd_tls_session_cache_database  is
       empty). This behavior is compatible with Postfix < 2.3.

       With  Postfix 2.3 and later the Postfix SMTP server can disable session
       id generation when TLS session caching is turned off. This keeps remote
       SMTP  clients from caching sessions that almost certainly cannot be re-
       used.

       By default, the Postfix SMTP server always generates TLS	 session  ids.
       This works around a known defect in mail client applications such as MS
       Outlook, and may also prevent interoperability issues with other MTAs.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_always_issue_session_ids = no

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_tls_ask_ccert (default: no)
       Ask a remote SMTP client for a client certificate. This information  is
       needed  for certificate based mail relaying with, for example, the per‐
       mit_tls_clientcerts feature.

       Some clients such as Netscape will either complain if no certificate is
       available (for the list of CAs in $smtpd_tls_CAfile) or will offer mul‐
       tiple client certificates to choose from. This may be annoying, so this
       option is "off" by default.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_auth_only (default: no)
       When  TLS  encryption  is  optional  in the Postfix SMTP server, do not
       announce or accept SASL authentication over unencrypted connections.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_ccert_verifydepth (default: 9)
       The verification depth for remote SMTP client certificates. A depth  of
       1 is sufficient if the issuing CA is listed in a local CA file.

       The  default verification depth is 9 (the OpenSSL default) for compati‐
       bility with earlier Postfix behavior. Prior to Postfix 2.5, the default
       value  was  5, but the limit was not actually enforced. If you have set
       this to a lower	non-default  value,  certificates  with	 longer	 trust
       chains  may  now fail to verify. Certificate chains with 1 or 2 CAs are
       common, deeper chains are more rare and any  number  between  5	and  9
       should suffice in practice. You can choose a lower number if, for exam‐
       ple, you trust certificates directly signed by an issuing  CA  but  not
       any CAs it delegates to.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_cert_file (default: empty)
       File  with the Postfix SMTP server RSA certificate in PEM format.  This
       file may also contain the Postfix SMTP server private RSA key.

       Public Internet MX hosts without certificates signed by	a  "reputable"
       CA  must	 generate, and be prepared to present to most clients, a self-
       signed or private-CA signed certificate. The client will not be able to
       authenticate  the server, but unless it is running Postfix 2.3 or simi‐
       lar software, it will still insist on a server certificate.

       For servers that are not public Internet MX hosts, Postfix 2.3 supports
       configurations  with  no certificates. This entails the use of just the
       anonymous TLS ciphers, which are not supported by typical SMTP clients.
       Since such clients will not, as a rule, fall back to plain text after a
       TLS handshake failure, the server will be unable to receive email  from
       TLS  enabled  clients.  To avoid accidental configurations with no cer‐
       tificates, Postfix 2.3 enables certificate-less operation only when the
       administrator   explicitly  sets	 "smtpd_tls_cert_file  =  none".  This
       ensures that new Postfix configurations will not accidentally run  with
       no certificates.

       Both  RSA  and  DSA  certificates  are  supported.  When both types are
       present, the cipher used determines which certificate will be presented
       to the client.  For Netscape and OpenSSL clients without special cipher
       choices the RSA certificate is preferred.

       To enable a remote SMTP client to verify the Postfix SMTP  server  cer‐
       tificate,  the  issuing	CA  certificates must be made available to the
       client. You should include the required certificates in the server cer‐
       tificate	 file,	the  server  certificate first, then the issuing CA(s)
       (bottom-up order).

       Example: the certificate for "server.example.com" was issued by "inter‐
       mediate	CA"  which  itself has a certificate of "root CA".  Create the
       server.pem   file   with	  "cat	 server_cert.pem   intermediate_CA.pem
       root_CA.pem > server.pem".

       If you also want to verify client certificates issued by these CAs, you
       can add the CA certificates to the smtpd_tls_CAfile, in which  case  it
       is   not	  necessary   to  have	them  in  the  smtpd_tls_cert_file  or
       smtpd_tls_dcert_file.

       A certificate supplied here must be usable as an SSL server certificate
       and hence pass the "openssl verify -purpose sslserver ..." test.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_cert_file = /etc/postfix/server.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_cipherlist (default: empty)
       Obsolete	 Postfix  < 2.3 control for the Postfix SMTP server TLS cipher
       list. It is easy to create inter-operability  problems  by  choosing  a
       non-default cipher list. Do not use a non-default TLS cipherlist for MX
       hosts on the public Internet. Clients that begin the TLS handshake, but
       are  unable  to	agree  on a common cipher, may not be able to send any
       email to the SMTP server. Using a restricted cipher list	 may  be  more
       appropriate  for	 a dedicated MSA or an internal mailhub, where one can
       exert some control over the TLS software and settings of the connecting
       clients.

       Note: do not use "" quotes around the parameter value.

       This feature is available with Postfix version 2.2. It is not used with
       Postfix 2.3 and later; use smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers instead.

smtpd_tls_ciphers (default: export)
       The minimum TLS cipher grade that the Postfix SMTP server will use with
       opportunistic	 TLS	encryption.    Cipher	 types	  listed    in
       smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers are excluded from the base definition of  the
       selected	 cipher	 grade.	 The  default  value  "export" ensures maximum
       inter-operability. Because encryption is	 optional,  stronger  controls
       are  not appropriate, and this setting SHOULD NOT be changed unless the
       change is essential.

       When  TLS  is  mandatory	 the  cipher   grade   is   chosen   via   the
       smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers configuration parameter, see there for syn‐
       tax details.

       Example:
       smtpd_tls_ciphers = export

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later. With earlier	 Post‐
       fix  releases  only the smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers parameter is imple‐
       mented, and opportunistic TLS always uses "export" or better (i.e. all)
       ciphers.

smtpd_tls_dcert_file (default: empty)
       File  with the Postfix SMTP server DSA certificate in PEM format.  This
       file may also contain the Postfix SMTP server private DSA key.

       See the discussion under smtpd_tls_cert_file for more details.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_dcert_file = /etc/postfix/server-dsa.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file (default: empty)
       File with DH parameters that the Postfix SMTP server  should  use  with
       EDH ciphers.

       Instead	of  using  the	exact  same parameter sets as distributed with
       other TLS packages, it is more secure  to  generate  your  own  set  of
       parameters with something like the following command:

	   openssl gendh -out /etc/postfix/dh_1024.pem -2 1024

       Your  actual source for entropy may differ. Some systems have /dev/ran‐
       dom; on other system you may consider using the "Entropy Gathering Dae‐
       mon EGD", available at http://egd.sourceforge.net/

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file = /etc/postfix/dh_1024.pem

       This feature is available with Postfix version 2.2.

smtpd_tls_dh512_param_file (default: empty)
       File  with  DH  parameters that the Postfix SMTP server should use with
       EDH ciphers.

       See also the discussion under the smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file  configu‐
       ration parameter.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_dh512_param_file = /etc/postfix/dh_512.pem

       This feature is available with Postfix version 2.2.

smtpd_tls_dkey_file (default: $smtpd_tls_dcert_file)
       File  with the Postfix SMTP server DSA private key in PEM format.  This
       file may be combined with the Postfix SMTP server DSA certificate  file
       specified with $smtpd_tls_dcert_file.

       The  private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it must
       not be encrypted. File permissions should grant read-only access to the
       system superuser account ("root"), and no access to anyone else.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_eccert_file (default: empty)
       File  with  the	Postfix	 SMTP  server ECDSA certificate in PEM format.
       This file may also contain the Postfix SMTP server private ECDSA key.

       See the discussion under smtpd_tls_cert_file for more details.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_eccert_file = /etc/postfix/ecdsa-scert.pem

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and  later,  when  Postfix  is
       compiled and linked with OpenSSL 1.0.0 or later.

smtpd_tls_eckey_file (default: $smtpd_tls_eccert_file)
       File  with  the	Postfix	 SMTP  server ECDSA private key in PEM format.
       This file may be combined with the Postfix SMTP server  ECDSA  certifi‐
       cate file specified with $smtpd_tls_eccert_file.

       The  private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it must
       not be encrypted. File permissions should grant read-only access to the
       system superuser account ("root"), and no access to anyone else.

       This  feature  is  available  in Postfix 2.6 and later, when Postfix is
       compiled and linked with OpenSSL 1.0.0 or later.

smtpd_tls_eecdh_grade (default: see postconf -d output)
       The Postfix SMTP server security	 grade	for  ephemeral	elliptic-curve
       Diffie-Hellman (EECDH) key exchange.

       The available choices are:

       none   Don't  use  EECDH.  Ciphers  based on EECDH key exchange will be
	      disabled. This is the default in Postfix versions 2.6 and 2.7.

       strong Use EECDH with approximately 128 bits of security at  a  reason‐
	      able  computational  cost.  This	is  the	 current best-practice
	      trade-off between security and computational efficiency. This is
	      the default in Postfix version 2.8 and later.

       ultra  Use  EECDH  with	approximately 192 bits of security at computa‐
	      tional cost that is approximately	 twice	as  high  as  128  bit
	      strength	ECC. Barring significant progress in attacks on ellip‐
	      tic curve crypto-systems, the "strong" curve is  sufficient  for
	      most users.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later, when it is compiled
       and linked with OpenSSL 1.0.0 or later.

smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers (default: empty)
       List of ciphers or cipher types to exclude from the SMTP server	cipher
       list  at	 all  TLS  security levels. Excluding valid ciphers can create
       interoperability problems. DO NOT exclude ciphers unless it  is	essen‐
       tial  to	 do so. This is not an OpenSSL cipherlist; it is a simple list
       separated by whitespace	and/or	commas.	 The  elements	are  a	single
       cipher,	or  one or more "+" separated cipher properties, in which case
       only ciphers matching all the properties are excluded.

       Examples (some of these will cause problems):

	   smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers = aNULL
	   smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers = MD5, DES
	   smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers = DES+MD5
	   smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers = AES256-SHA, DES-CBC3-MD5
	   smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers = kEDH+aRSA

       The first setting disables anonymous ciphers. The next setting disables
       ciphers	that  use the MD5 digest algorithm or the (single) DES encryp‐
       tion algorithm. The next setting disables ciphers that use MD5 and  DES
       together.   The	next setting disables the two ciphers "AES256-SHA" and
       "DES-CBC3-MD5". The last setting disables ciphers that  use  "EDH"  key
       exchange with RSA authentication.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_tls_fingerprint_digest (default: md5)
       The  message  digest algorithm to construct remote SMTP client-certifi‐
       cate fingerprints or public key fingerprints (Postfix  2.9  and	later)
       for  check_ccert_access	and  permit_tls_clientcerts. The default algo‐
       rithm is md5, for backwards compatibility with Postfix  releases	 prior
       to 2.5.

       Advances	 in  hash  function cryptanalysis have led to md5 being depre‐
       cated in favor of sha1.	However, as long as there are no known "second
       pre-image"  attacks  against  md5, its use in this context can still be
       considered safe.

       While additional digest algorithms are often available  with  OpenSSL's
       libcrypto, only those used by libssl in SSL cipher suites are available
       to Postfix.

       To find the fingerprint of a specific certificate file, with a specific
       digest algorithm, run:

	   $ openssl x509 -noout -fingerprint -digest -in certfile.pem

       The  text  to  the  right  of "=" sign is the desired fingerprint.  For
       example:

	   $ openssl x509 -noout -fingerprint -sha1 -in cert.pem
	   SHA1 Fingerprint=D4:6A:AB:19:24:79:F8:32:BB:A6:CB:66:82:C0:8E:9B:EE:29:A8:1A

       To extract the public key fingerprint from an  X.509  certificate,  you
       need  to	 extract  the  public key from the certificate and compute the
       appropriate digest of its DER (ASN.1) encoding. With OpenSSL the "-pub‐
       key"  option  of	 the  "x509" command extracts the public key always in
       "PEM" format. We pipe the result to another OpenSSL command  that  con‐
       verts the key to DER and then to the "dgst" command to compute the fin‐
       gerprint.

       The actual command to transform the key to DER format  depends  on  the
       version	of OpenSSL used. With OpenSSL 1.0.0 and later, the "pkey" com‐
       mand supports all key types. With OpenSSL 0.9.8 and  earlier,  the  key
       type  is	 always	 RSA  (nobody uses DSA, and EC keys are not fully sup‐
       ported by 0.9.8), so the "rsa" command is used.

	   # OpenSSL 1.0 with all certificates and SHA-1 fingerprints.
	   $ openssl x509 -in cert.pem -noout -pubkey |
	       openssl pkey -pubin -outform DER |
	       openssl dgst -sha1 -c
	   (stdin)= 64:3f:1f:f6:e5:1e:d4:2a:56:8b:fc:09:1a:61:98:b5:bc:7c:60:58

	   # OpenSSL 0.9.8 with RSA certificates and MD5 fingerprints.
	   $ openssl x509 -in cert.pem -noout -pubkey |
	       openssl rsa -pubin -outform DER |
	       openssl dgst -md5 -c
	   (stdin)= f4:62:60:f6:12:8f:d5:8d:28:4d:13:a7:db:b2:ff:50

       The Postfix SMTP server and client log the peer (leaf) certificate fin‐
       gerprint	 and  public  key  fingerprint	when  the TLS loglevel is 2 or
       higher.

       Note: Postfix 2.9.0–2.9.5 computed	 the  public  key  fingerprint
       incorrectly.  To	 use public-key fingerprints, upgrade to Postfix 2.9.6
       or later.

       Example: client-certificate access table, with sha1 fingerprints:

	   /etc/postfix/main.cf:
	       smtpd_tls_fingerprint_digest = sha1
	       smtpd_client_restrictions =
		   check_ccert_access hash:/etc/postfix/access,
		   reject
	   /etc/postfix/access:
	       # Action folded to next line...
	       AF:88:7C:AD:51:95:6F:36:96:F6:01:FB:2E:48:CD:AB:49:25:A2:3B
		   OK
	       85:16:78:FD:73:6E:CE:70:E0:31:5F:0D:3C:C8:6D:C4:2C:24:59:E1
		   permit_auth_destination

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

smtpd_tls_key_file (default: $smtpd_tls_cert_file)
       File with the Postfix SMTP server RSA private key in PEM format.	  This
       file  may be combined with the Postfix SMTP server RSA certificate file
       specified with $smtpd_tls_cert_file.

       The private key must be accessible without a pass-phrase, i.e. it  must
       not be encrypted. File permissions should grant read-only access to the
       system superuser account ("root"), and no access to anyone else.

smtpd_tls_loglevel (default: 0)
       Enable additional Postfix SMTP server logging of	 TLS  activity.	  Each
       logging	level  also includes the information that is logged at a lower
       logging level.

	      0 Log only a summary message on TLS handshake completion —
	      no logging of remote SMTP client certificate trust-chain verifi‐
	      cation  errors  if  client  certificate  verification   is   not
	      required.	 With  Postfix 2.8 and earlier, disable logging of TLS
	      activity.

	      1 Also log trust-chain verification errors and peer  certificate
	      name and issuer. With Postfix 2.8 and earlier, log TLS handshake
	      and certificate information.

	      2 Also log levels during TLS negotiation.

	      3 Also  log  hexadecimal	and  ASCII  dump  of  TLS  negotiation
	      process.

	      4	 Also  log hexadecimal and ASCII dump of complete transmission
	      after STARTTLS.

       Do not use "smtpd_tls_loglevel = 2" or higher except in case  of	 prob‐
       lems. Use of loglevel 4 is strongly discouraged.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers (default: medium)
       The minimum TLS cipher grade that the Postfix SMTP server will use with
       mandatory TLS encryption. The default grade ("medium") is  sufficiently
       strong  that  any  benefit  from globally restricting TLS sessions to a
       more stringent grade is likely negligible, especially  given  the  fact
       that  many  implementations  still  do  not  offer any stronger ("high"
       grade) ciphers, while those that	 do,  will  always  use	 "high"	 grade
       ciphers. So insisting on "high" grade ciphers is generally counter-pro‐
       ductive. Allowing "export" or "low" ciphers is  typically  not  a  good
       idea,  as  systems  limited  to	just  these  are  limited  to obsolete
       browsers. No known SMTP clients fail to support at least	 one  "medium"
       or "high" grade cipher.

       The following cipher grades are supported:

       export Enable  "EXPORT" grade or stronger OpenSSL ciphers.  This is the
	      most appropriate setting for public MX hosts, and is always used
	      with  opportunistic TLS encryption. The underlying cipherlist is
	      specified via the tls_export_cipherlist configuration parameter,
	      which you are strongly encouraged to not change.

       low    Enable  "LOW"  grade or stronger OpenSSL ciphers. The underlying
	      cipherlist is specified via the tls_low_cipherlist configuration
	      parameter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change.

       medium Enable  "MEDIUM"	grade  or  stronger OpenSSL ciphers. These use
	      128-bit or longer symmetric bulk-encryption keys.	 This  is  the
	      default  minimum	strength  for  mandatory  TLS  encryption. The
	      underlying cipherlist is specified via the tls_medium_cipherlist
	      configuration  parameter,	 which	you are strongly encouraged to
	      not change.

       high   Enable  only  "HIGH"  grade  OpenSSL  ciphers.  The   underlying
	      cipherlist  is  specified via the tls_high_cipherlist configura‐
	      tion parameter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change.

       null   Enable only the "NULL" OpenSSL ciphers, these provide  authenti‐
	      cation  without encryption.  This setting is only appropriate in
	      the rare case that all clients are prepared to use NULL  ciphers
	      (not normally enabled in TLS clients). The underlying cipherlist
	      is specified via the tls_null_cipherlist	configuration  parame‐
	      ter, which you are strongly encouraged to not change.

       Cipher	types	listed	 in   smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers   or
       smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers are excluded from the base definition of  the
       selected	 cipher	 grade. See smtpd_tls_ciphers for cipher controls that
       apply to opportunistic TLS.

       The underlying cipherlists for grades other than "null" include	anony‐
       mous ciphers, but these are automatically filtered out if the server is
       configured to ask for remote SMTP client certificates.	You  are  very
       unlikely	 to  need to take any steps to exclude anonymous ciphers, they
       are excluded automatically as required.	If you must exclude  anonymous
       ciphers	even  when Postfix does not need or use peer certificates, set
       "smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers = aNULL". To exclude anonymous ciphers  only
       when   TLS  is  enforced,  set  "smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers  =
       aNULL".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers (default: empty)
       Additional list of ciphers or cipher types to exclude from the  Postfix
       SMTP  server  cipher  list at mandatory TLS security levels.  This list
       works	in    addition	  to	the	exclusions     listed	  with
       smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers (see there for syntax details).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols (default: !SSLv2)
       The  SSL/TLS  protocols accepted by the Postfix SMTP server with manda‐
       tory TLS encryption. If the list is  empty,  the	 server	 supports  all
       available  SSL/TLS  protocol  versions.	A non-empty value is a list of
       protocol names separated by whitespace, commas or colons. The supported
       protocol	 names are "SSLv2", "SSLv3" and "TLSv1", and are not case sen‐
       sitive.

       Note: As of OpenSSL 1.0.1 two new protocols are defined, "TLSv1.1"  and
       "TLSv1.2".  If an older Postfix version is linked against OpenSSL 1.0.1
       or later, these, or any other new protocol versions,  are  uncondition‐
       ally enabled.

       With  Postfix >= 2.5 the parameter syntax is expanded to support proto‐
       col exclusions.	One  can  now  explicitly  exclude  SSLv2  by  setting
       "smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols  =  !SSLv2".  To	exclude both SSLv2 and
       SSLv3 set "smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3". Listing the
       protocols  to  include, rather than protocols to exclude, is supported,
       but not recommended. The exclusion form more closely matches the behav‐
       ior when the OpenSSL library is newer than Postfix.

       Since  SSL  version  2  has known protocol weaknesses and is now depre‐
       cated, the default  setting  excludes  "SSLv2".	 This  means  that  by
       default,	 SSL  version  2  will	not  be used at the "encrypt" security
       level.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols = TLSv1
       # Alternative form with Postfix >= 2.5:
       smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_tls_protocols (default: empty)
       List of TLS protocols that the Postfix  SMTP  server  will  exclude  or
       include	with  opportunistic  TLS  encryption. This parameter SHOULD be
       left at its default empty value, allowing all protocols to be used with
       opportunistic TLS.

       In main.cf the values are separated by whitespace, commas or colons. An
       empty value means allow all protocols. The valid protocol  names,  (see
       \fBfBSSL_get_version(3)),   are	 "SSLv2",   "SSLv3"  and  "TLSv1".  In
       smtp_tls_policy_maps table entries, "protocols"	attribute  values  are
       separated by a colon.

       Note:  As of OpenSSL 1.0.1 two new protocols are defined, "TLSv1.1" and
       "TLSv1.2". If an older Postfix version is linked against OpenSSL	 1.0.1
       or  later,  these, or any other new protocol versions, are uncondition‐
       ally enabled.

       To include a protocol list its name, to exclude	it,  prefix  the  name
       with  a	"!" character. To exclude SSLv2 even for opportunistic TLS set
       "smtpd_tls_protocols = !SSLv2". To exclude both "SSLv2" and "SSLv3" set
       "smtpd_tls_protocols  =	!SSLv2, !SSLv3". Explicitly listing the proto‐
       cols to include, rather than protocols to exclude,  is  supported,  but
       not  recommended.  The exclusion form more closely matches the behavior
       when the OpenSSL library is newer than Postfix.

       Example:
       smtpd_tls_protocols = !SSLv2

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

smtpd_tls_received_header (default: no)
       Request that the Postfix SMTP server produces Received:	message	 head‐
       ers  that  include  information	about the protocol and cipher used, as
       well as the remote SMTP client CommonName and client certificate issuer
       CommonName.   This  is  disabled	 by default, as the information may be
       modified in transit through other mail servers.	Only information  that
       was recorded by the final destination can be trusted.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_req_ccert (default: no)
       With  mandatory	TLS  encryption,  require a trusted remote SMTP client
       certificate in order to allow TLS connections to proceed.  This	option
       implies "smtpd_tls_ask_ccert = yes".

       When TLS encryption is optional, this setting is ignored with a warning
       written to the mail log.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_security_level (default: empty)
       The SMTP TLS security level for the Postfix SMTP server;	 when  a  non-
       empty  value  is	 specified,  this  overrides  the  obsolete parameters
       smtpd_use_tls and smtpd_enforce_tls. This  parameter  is	 ignored  with
       "smtpd_tls_wrappermode = yes".

       Specify one of the following security levels:

       none   TLS will not be used.

       may    Opportunistic  TLS:  announce  STARTTLS  support	to remote SMTP
	      clients, but do not require that clients use TLS encryption.

       encrypt
	      Mandatory TLS encryption: announce STARTTLS  support  to	remote
	      SMTP  clients,  and  require  that  clients  use TLS encryption.
	      According to RFC 2487 this MUST NOT be applied in case of a pub‐
	      licly-referenced	SMTP  server.  Instead,	 this option should be
	      used only on dedicated servers.

       Note 1: the "fingerprint", "verify" and "secure" levels	are  not  sup‐
       ported here.  The Postfix SMTP server logs a warning and uses "encrypt"
       instead.	 To verify remote SMTP client certificates, see TLS_README for
       a  discussion of the smtpd_tls_ask_ccert, smtpd_tls_req_ccert, and per‐
       mit_tls_clientcerts features.

       Note 2: The  parameter  setting	"smtpd_tls_security_level  =  encrypt"
       implies "smtpd_tls_auth_only = yes".

       Note  3:	 when  invoked	via  "sendmail	-bs", Postfix will never offer
       STARTTLS due to insufficient privileges to access  the  server  private
       key. This is intended behavior.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

smtpd_tls_session_cache_database (default: empty)
       Name  of	 the file containing the optional Postfix SMTP server TLS ses‐
       sion cache. Specify a database type that supports enumeration, such  as
       btree or sdbm; there is no need to support concurrent access.  The file
       is created if it does not exist. The smtpd(8) daemon does not use  this
       parameter  directly,  rather the cache is implemented indirectly in the
       tlsmgr(8) daemon. This means that  per-smtpd-instance  master.cf	 over‐
       rides of this parameter are not effective. Note, that each of the cache
       databases supported by tlsmgr(8) daemon: $smtpd_tls_session_cache_data‐
       base,  $smtp_tls_session_cache_database (and with Postfix 2.3 and later
       $lmtp_tls_session_cache_database), needs to be stored separately. It is
       not  at	this  time possible to store multiple caches in a single data‐
       base.

       Note: dbm databases are not  suitable.  TLS  session  objects  are  too
       large.

       As  of version 2.5, Postfix no longer uses root privileges when opening
       this file. The file  should  now	 be  stored  under  the	 Postfix-owned
       data_directory. As a migration aid, an attempt to open the file under a
       non-Postfix directory is redirected to  the  Postfix-owned  data_direc‐
       tory, and a warning is logged.

       Example:

       smtpd_tls_session_cache_database = btree:/var/lib/postfix/smtpd_scache

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_session_cache_timeout (default: 3600s)
       The  expiration	time of Postfix SMTP server TLS session cache informa‐
       tion. A cache cleanup is performed periodically	every  $smtpd_tls_ses‐
       sion_cache_timeout  seconds. As with $smtpd_tls_session_cache_database,
       this parameter is implemented in the  tlsmgr(8)	daemon	and  therefore
       per-smtpd-instance master.cf overrides are not possible.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_tls_wrappermode (default: no)
       Run the Postfix SMTP server in the non-standard "wrapper" mode, instead
       of using the STARTTLS command.

       If you want to support this service, enable  a  special	port  in  mas‐
       ter.cf, and specify "-o smtpd_tls_wrappermode=yes" on the SMTP server's
       command line. Port 465 (smtps) was once chosen for this purpose.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

smtpd_upstream_proxy_protocol (default: empty)
       The name of the proxy protocol used by an optional  before-smtpd	 proxy
       agent.  When  a	proxy  agent  is used, this protocol conveys local and
       remote	   address	and	 port	   information.	       Specify
       "smtpd_upstream_proxy_protocol  = haproxy" to enable the haproxy proto‐
       col.

       NOTE: To use the nginx proxy with smtpd(8), enable the XCLIENT protocol
       with  smtpd_authorized_xclient_hosts. This supports SASL authentication
       in the proxy agent (Postfix 2.9 and later).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.10 and later.

smtpd_upstream_proxy_timeout (default: 5s)
       The  time  limit	 for   the   proxy   protocol	specified   with   the
       smtpd_upstream_proxy_protocol parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.10 and later.

smtpd_use_tls (default: no)
       Opportunistic  TLS:  announce  STARTTLS support to remote SMTP clients,
       but do not require that clients use TLS encryption.

       Note: when invoked via "sendmail -bs", Postfix will never offer	START‐
       TLS  due	 to  insufficient privileges to access the server private key.
       This is intended behavior.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.  With  Postfix  2.3
       and later use smtpd_tls_security_level instead.

soft_bounce (default: no)
       Safety  net to keep mail queued that would otherwise be returned to the
       sender.	This parameter disables locally-generated bounces, changes the
       handling	 of negative responses from remote servers, content filters or
       plugins, and prevents the Postfix SMTP server from rejecting mail  per‐
       manently by changing 5xx reply codes into 4xx.  However, soft_bounce is
       no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.

       Note: "soft_bounce = yes" is in some  cases  implemented	 by  modifying
       server  responses. Therefore, the response that Postfix logs may differ
       from the response that Postfix actually sends or receives.

       Example:

       soft_bounce = yes

stale_lock_time (default: 500s)
       The time after which a stale exclusive  mailbox	lockfile  is  removed.
       This is used for delivery to file or mailbox.

       Time  units:  s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

stress (default: empty)
       This feature is documented in the STRESS_README document.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

strict_7bit_headers (default: no)
       Reject mail with 8-bit text in message headers. This blocks  mail  from
       poorly written applications.

       This  feature  should  not be enabled on a general purpose mail server,
       because it is likely to reject legitimate email.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

strict_8bitmime (default: no)
       Enable both strict_7bit_headers and strict_8bitmime_body.

       This feature should not be enabled on a general	purpose	 mail  server,
       because it is likely to reject legitimate email.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

strict_8bitmime_body (default: no)
       Reject  8-bit  message  body  text  without 8-bit MIME content encoding
       information.  This blocks mail from poorly written applications.

       Unfortunately, this also rejects majordomo approval requests  when  the
       included request contains valid 8-bit MIME mail, and it rejects bounces
       from mailers that do not MIME encapsulate 8-bit content	(for  example,
       bounces from qmail or from old versions of Postfix).

       This  feature  should  not be enabled on a general purpose mail server,
       because it is likely to reject legitimate email.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

strict_mailbox_ownership (default: yes)
       Defer delivery when a mailbox file is not owned by its recipient.   The
       default setting is not backwards compatible.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5.3 and later.

strict_mime_encoding_domain (default: no)
       Reject mail with invalid Content-Transfer-Encoding: information for the
       message/* or multipart/* MIME content types.   This  blocks  mail  from
       poorly written software.

       This  feature  should  not be enabled on a general purpose mail server,
       because it will reject mail after a single violation.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

strict_rfc821_envelopes (default: no)
       Require that addresses received in SMTP MAIL FROM and RCPT TO  commands
       are  enclosed  with <>, and that those addresses do not contain RFC 822
       style comments or phrases.  This stops mail from poorly	written	 soft‐
       ware.

       By default, the Postfix SMTP server accepts RFC 822 syntax in MAIL FROM
       and RCPT TO addresses.

sun_mailtool_compatibility (default: no)
       Obsolete	 SUN  mailtool	compatibility  feature.	 Instead,  use	"mail‐
       box_delivery_lock = dotlock".

swap_bangpath (default: yes)
       Enable  the  rewriting of "site!user" into "user@site".	This is neces‐
       sary if your machine is connected to UUCP networks.  It is  enabled  by
       default.

       Note:  with  Postfix version 2.2, message header address rewriting hap‐
       pens only when one of the following conditions is true:

       ·      The message is received with the Postfix sendmail(1) command,

       ·      The message is received  from  a	network	 client	 that  matches
	      $local_header_rewrite_clients,

       ·      The   message   is   received   from   the   network,   and  the
	      remote_header_rewrite_domain  parameter  specifies  a  non-empty
	      value.

       To   get	  the	behavior   before   Postfix   version	2.2,   specify
       "local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all".

       Example:

       swap_bangpath = no

syslog_facility (default: mail)
       The syslog facility of Postfix logging. Specify a facility  as  defined
       in syslog.conf(5). The default facility is "mail".

       Warning:	 a non-default syslog_facility setting takes effect only after
       a Postfix process has completed initialization.	Errors during  process
       initialization  will be logged with the default facility.  Examples are
       errors while parsing the	 command  line	arguments,  and	 errors	 while
       accessing the Postfix main.cf configuration file.

syslog_name (default: see postconf -d output)
       The  mail  system  name that is prepended to the process name in syslog
       records, so that "smtpd" becomes, for example, "postfix/smtpd".

       Warning: a non-default syslog_name setting takes effect	only  after  a
       Postfix	process	 has  completed	 initialization. Errors during process
       initialization will be logged  with  the	 default  name.	 Examples  are
       errors  while  parsing  the  command  line  arguments, and errors while
       accessing the Postfix main.cf configuration file.

tcp_windowsize (default: 0)
       An optional workaround for  routers  that  break	 TCP  window  scaling.
       Specify	a  value > 0 and < 65536 to enable this feature.  With Postfix
       TCP servers (smtpd(8), qmqpd(8)), this feature is  implemented  by  the
       Postfix master(8) daemon.

       To  change  this	 parameter without stopping Postfix, you need to first
       terminate all Postfix TCP servers:

	   # postconf -e master_service_disable=inet
	   # postfix reload

       This immediately terminates all processes that accept  network  connec‐
       tions.	Next, you enable Postfix TCP servers with the updated tcp_win‐
       dowsize setting:

	   # postconf -e tcp_windowsize=65535 master_service_disable=
	   # postfix reload

       If you skip these  steps	 with  a  running  Postfix  system,  then  the
       tcp_windowsize  change will work only for Postfix TCP clients (smtp(8),
       lmtp(8)).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

tls_append_default_CA (default: no)
       Append the system-supplied default certificate  authority  certificates
       to  the	ones specified with *_tls_CApath or *_tls_CAfile.  The default
       is "no"; this prevents Postfix from trusting  third-party  certificates
       and giving them relay permission with permit_tls_all_clientcerts.

       This  feature  is available in Postfix 2.4.15, 2.5.11, 2.6.8, 2.7.2 and
       later versions. Specify "tls_append_default_CA  =  yes"	for  backwards
       compatibility,  to  avoid  breaking certificate verification with sites
       that don't use permit_tls_all_clientcerts.

tls_daemon_random_bytes (default: 32)
       The number of pseudo-random bytes that an smtp(8) or  smtpd(8)  process
       requests from the tlsmgr(8) server in order to seed its internal pseudo
       random number generator (PRNG).	The default of 32 bytes (equivalent to
       256 bits) is sufficient to generate a 128bit (or 168bit) session key.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

tls_disable_workarounds (default: see postconf -d output)
       List or bit-mask of OpenSSL bug work-arounds to disable.

       The  OpenSSL  toolkit  includes a set of work-arounds for buggy SSL/TLS
       implementations. Applications, such as Postfix, that want  to  maximize
       interoperability ask the OpenSSL library to enable the full set of rec‐
       ommended work-arounds.

       From time to time, it is discovered that a work-around creates a	 secu‐
       rity  issue,  and  should  no longer be used. If upgrading OpenSSL to a
       fixed version is not an option or an upgrade  is	 not  available	 in  a
       timely  manner,	or  in	closed	environments where no buggy clients or
       servers exist, it may be appropriate to disable	some  or  all  of  the
       OpenSSL	interoperability  work-arounds. This parameter specifies which
       bug work-arounds to disable.

       If the value of the parameter is a hexadecimal  long  integer  starting
       with  "0x", the bug work-arounds corresponding to the bits specified in
       its value are removed from the  SSL_OP_ALL  work-around	bit-mask  (see
       openssl/ssl.h  and  SSL_CTX_set_options(3)).  You can specify more bits
       than are present in SSL_OP_ALL, excess  bits  are  ignored.  Specifying
       0xFFFFFFFF disables all bug-workarounds on a 32-bit system. This should
       also be sufficient on 64-bit systems, until  OpenSSL  abandons  support
       for  32-bit  systems and starts using the high 32 bits of a 64-bit bug-
       workaround mask.

       Otherwise, the parameter is a white-space or comma  separated  list  of
       specific	 named bug work-arounds chosen from the list below. It is pos‐
       sible that your OpenSSL version includes	 new  bug  work-arounds	 added
       after  your  Postfix source code was last updated, in that case you can
       only disable one of these via the hexadecimal syntax above.

       MICROSOFT_SESS_ID_BUG
	      See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       NETSCAPE_CHALLENGE_BUG
	      See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       LEGACY_SERVER_CONNECT
	      See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       NETSCAPE_REUSE_CIPHER_CHANGE_BUG
	      also aliased as CVE-2010-4180. Postfix 2.8 disables  this	 work-
	      around  by  default  with	 OpenSSL versions that may predate the
	      fix. Fixed in OpenSSL 0.9.8q and OpenSSL 1.0.0c.

       SSLREF2_REUSE_CERT_TYPE_BUG
	      See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       MICROSOFT_BIG_SSLV3_BUFFER
	      See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       MSIE_SSLV2_RSA_PADDING
	      also aliased as CVE-2005-2969. Postfix 2.8 disables  this	 work-
	      around  by  default  with	 OpenSSL versions that may predate the
	      fix. Fixed in OpenSSL 0.9.7h and OpenSSL 0.9.8a.

       SSLEAY_080_CLIENT_DH_BUG
	      See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       TLS_D5_BUG
	      See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       TLS_BLOCK_PADDING_BUG
	      See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       TLS_ROLLBACK_BUG
	      See SSL_CTX_set_options(3).  This is disabled in	OpenSSL	 0.9.7
	      and later. Nobody should still be using 0.9.6!

       DONT_INSERT_EMPTY_FRAGMENTS
	      See SSL_CTX_set_options(3)

       CRYPTOPRO_TLSEXT_BUG
	      New with GOST support in OpenSSL 1.0.0.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tls_eecdh_strong_curve (default: prime256v1)
       The  elliptic curve used by the Postfix SMTP server for sensibly strong
       ephemeral ECDH key exchange. This curve is used	by  the	 Postfix  SMTP
       server  when  "smtpd_tls_eecdh_grade  =	strong".  The phrase "sensibly
       strong" means  approximately  128-bit  security	based  on  best	 known
       attacks. The selected curve must be implemented by OpenSSL (as reported
       by ecparam(1) with the "-list_curves" option) and be one of the	curves
       listed  in  Section  5.1.1 of RFC 4492. You should not generally change
       this setting.

       This default curve is specified in  NSA	"Suite	B"  Cryptography  (see
       http://www.nsa.gov/ia/industry/crypto_suite_b.cfm)    for   information
       classified as SECRET.

       Note: elliptic curve names are poorly standardized; different standards
       groups  are  assigning  different  names to the same underlying curves.
       The curve with the X9.62 name "prime256v1" is also known under the SECG
       name "secp256r1", but OpenSSL does not recognize the latter name.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later, when it is compiled
       and linked with OpenSSL 1.0.0 or later.

tls_eecdh_ultra_curve (default: secp384r1)
       The elliptic curve used by the Postfix SMTP server for maximally strong
       ephemeral  ECDH	key  exchange.	This curve is used by the Postfix SMTP
       server when "smtpd_tls_eecdh_grade  =  ultra".  The  phrase  "maximally
       strong"	means  approximately  192-bit  security	 based	on  best known
       attacks.	 This additional strength comes at a significant computational
       cost,  most  users should instead set "smtpd_tls_eecdh_grade = strong".
       The selected curve must be  implemented	by  OpenSSL  (as  reported  by
       ecparam(1)  with	 the  "-list_curves"  option) and be one of the curves
       listed in Section 5.1.1 of RFC 4492. You should	not  generally	change
       this setting.

       This  default  "ultra" curve is specified in NSA "Suite B" Cryptography
       (see http://www.nsa.gov/ia/industry/crypto_suite_b.cfm) for information
       classified as TOP SECRET.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later, when it is compiled
       and linked with OpenSSL 1.0.0 or later.

tls_export_cipherlist (default: ALL:+RC4:@STRENGTH)
       The OpenSSL cipherlist for  "EXPORT"  or	 higher	 grade	ciphers.  This
       defines	the  meaning  of  the  "export"	 setting  in  smtpd_tls_manda‐
       tory_ciphers,	smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers     and     lmtp_tls_manda‐
       tory_ciphers.  This is the cipherlist for the opportunistic ("may") TLS
       client security level and  is  the  default  cipherlist	for  the  SMTP
       server.	You  are  strongly encouraged to not change this setting. With
       OpenSSL 1.0.0 and later the cipherlist may start with an "aNULL:"  pre‐
       fix,  which restores the 0.9.8-compatible ordering of the aNULL ciphers
       to the top of the list when they are enabled. This prefix is not needed
       with previous OpenSSL releases.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

tls_high_cipherlist (default: ALL:!EXPORT:!LOW:!MEDIUM:+RC4:@STRENGTH)
       The OpenSSL cipherlist for "HIGH" grade ciphers. This defines the mean‐
       ing   of	  the	"high"	 setting    in	  smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers,
       smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers   and	 lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers.  You  are
       strongly encouraged to not change this setting. With OpenSSL 1.0.0  and
       later  the cipherlist may start with an "aNULL:" prefix, which restores
       the 0.9.8-compatible ordering of the aNULL ciphers to the  top  of  the
       list  when  they	 are  enabled. This prefix is not needed with previous
       OpenSSL releases.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

tls_legacy_public_key_fingerprints (default: no)
       A temporary migration aid for sites  that  use  certificate  public-key
       fingerprints  with  Postfix  2.9.0..2.9.5, which use an incorrect algo‐
       rithm. This parameter has no effect on the certificate fingerprint sup‐
       port that is available since Postfix 2.2.

       Specify "tls_legacy_public_key_fingerprints = yes" temporarily, pending
       a  migration  from   configuration   files   with   incorrect   Postfix
       2.9.0..2.9.5  certificate public-key finger prints, to the correct fin‐
       gerprints used by Postfix 2.9.6 and later.  To compute the correct cer‐
       tificate public-key fingerprints, see TLS_README.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.9.6 and later.

tls_low_cipherlist (default: ALL:!EXPORT:+RC4:@STRENGTH)
       The  OpenSSL cipherlist for "LOW" or higher grade ciphers. This defines
       the  meaning  of	 the  "low"  setting  in  smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers,
       smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers   and	 lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers.  You  are
       strongly encouraged to not change this setting.	With OpenSSL 1.0.0 and
       later  the cipherlist may start with an "aNULL:" prefix, which restores
       the 0.9.8-compatible ordering of the aNULL ciphers to the  top  of  the
       list  when  they	 are  enabled. This prefix is not needed with previous
       OpenSSL releases.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

tls_medium_cipherlist (default: ALL:!EXPORT:!LOW:+RC4:@STRENGTH)
       The OpenSSL cipherlist for  "MEDIUM"  or	 higher	 grade	ciphers.  This
       defines	the  meaning  of  the  "medium"	 setting  in  smtpd_tls_manda‐
       tory_ciphers,	smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers     and     lmtp_tls_manda‐
       tory_ciphers.  This is the default cipherlist for mandatory TLS encryp‐
       tion in the TLS client (with anonymous ciphers disabled when  verifying
       server  certificates).  You  are strongly encouraged to not change this
       setting.	 With OpenSSL 1.0.0 and later the cipherlist may start with an
       "aNULL:"	 prefix,  which	 restores the 0.9.8-compatible ordering of the
       aNULL ciphers to the top of the list when they are enabled. This prefix
       is not needed with previous OpenSSL releases.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

tls_null_cipherlist (default: eNULL:!aNULL)
       The  OpenSSL cipherlist for "NULL" grade ciphers that provide authenti‐
       cation without encryption. This defines the meaning of the "null"  set‐
       ting  in	 smtpd_mandatory_tls_ciphers,  smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers  and
       lmtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers.  You are strongly encouraged to not	change
       this setting.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.3 and later.

tls_preempt_cipherlist (default: no)
       With  SSLv3  and later, use the Postfix SMTP server's cipher preference
       order instead of the remote client's cipher preference order.

       By default, the OpenSSL server  selects	the  client's  most  preferred
       cipher  that  the server supports. With SSLv3 and later, the server may
       choose its own most preferred cipher that is supported (offered) by the
       client.	Setting	 "tls_preempt_cipherlist  = yes" enables server cipher
       preferences.

       While server cipher selection may in some cases lead to a  more	secure
       or  performant  cipher  choice,	there is some risk of interoperability
       issues. In the past,  some  SSL	clients	 have  listed  lower  priority
       ciphers	that they did not implement correctly. If the server chooses a
       cipher that the client prefers less,  it	 may  select  a	 cipher	 whose
       client implementation is flawed.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later, in combination with
       OpenSSL 0.9.7 and later.

tls_random_bytes (default: 32)
       The number of bytes that tlsmgr(8) reads from  $tls_random_source  when
       (re)seeding  the	 in-memory pseudo random number generator (PRNG) pool.
       The default of 32 bytes (256 bits) is good enough for 128bit  symmetric
       keys.  If using EGD or a device file, a maximum of 255 bytes is read.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

tls_random_exchange_name (default: see postconf -d output)
       Name  of	 the  pseudo random number generator (PRNG) state file that is
       maintained by tlsmgr(8). The file is created when it  does  not	exist,
       and its length is fixed at 1024 bytes.

       As  of version 2.5, Postfix no longer uses root privileges when opening
       this file, and the  default  file  location  was	 changed  from	${con‐
       fig_directory}/prng_exch	 to  ${data_directory}/prng_exch.  As a migra‐
       tion aid, an attempt to open the file under a non-Postfix directory  is
       redirected  to  the  Postfix-owned  data_directory,  and	 a  warning is
       logged.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

tls_random_prng_update_period (default: 3600s)
       The time between attempts by tlsmgr(8) to save the state of the	pseudo
       random  number  generator  (PRNG)  to the file specified with $tls_ran‐
       dom_exchange_name.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

tls_random_reseed_period (default: 3600s)
       The maximal time between attempts by tlsmgr(8) to re-seed the in-memory
       pseudo  random number generator (PRNG) pool from external sources.  The
       actual time between re-seeding attempts is calculated using  the	 PRNG,
       and is between 0 and the time specified.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

tls_random_source (default: see postconf -d output)
       The  external  entropy source for the in-memory tlsmgr(8) pseudo random
       number generator (PRNG) pool. Be sure to specify a non-blocking source.
       If  this	 source is not a regular file, the entropy source type must be
       prepended:  egd:/path/to/egd_socket for a source	 with  EGD  compatible
       socket interface, or dev:/path/to/device for a device file.

       Note:  on  OpenBSD systems specify /dev/arandom when /dev/urandom gives
       timeout errors.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.2 and later.

tlsproxy_enforce_tls (default: $smtpd_enforce_tls)
       Mandatory TLS: announce STARTTLS support to remote  SMTP	 clients,  and
       require that clients use TLS encryption. See smtpd_enforce_tls for fur‐
       ther details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_service_name (default: tlsproxy)
       The name of the tlsproxy(8) service entry in  master.cf.	 This  service
       performs plaintext <=> TLS ciphertext conversion.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_CAfile (default: $smtpd_tls_CAfile)
       A  file	containing (PEM format) CA certificates of root CAs trusted to
       sign either remote SMTP client certificates or intermediate CA certifi‐
       cates.  See smtpd_tls_CAfile for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_CApath (default: $smtpd_tls_CApath)
       A directory containing (PEM format) CA certificates of root CAs trusted
       to sign either remote SMTP client certificates or intermediate CA  cer‐
       tificates. See smtpd_tls_CApath for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_always_issue_session_ids  (default:  $smtpd_tls_always_issue_ses‐
       sion_ids)
       Force the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server to issue a TLS  session  id,  even
       when TLS session caching is turned off. See smtpd_tls_always_issue_ses‐
       sion_ids for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_ask_ccert (default: $smtpd_tls_ask_ccert)
       Ask  a	remote	 SMTP	client	 for   a   client   certificate.   See
       smtpd_tls_ask_ccert for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_ccert_verifydepth (default: $smtpd_tls_ccert_verifydepth)
       The  verification depth for remote SMTP client certificates. A depth of
       1 is sufficient if the issuing CA is listed in a	 local	CA  file.  See
       smtpd_tls_ccert_verifydepth for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_cert_file (default: $smtpd_tls_cert_file)
       File with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server RSA certificate in PEM format.
       This file may also contain the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server  private  RSA
       key.  See smtpd_tls_cert_file for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_ciphers (default: $smtpd_tls_ciphers)
       The  minimum  TLS cipher grade that the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server will
       use with opportunistic TLS encryption. See smtpd_tls_ciphers  for  fur‐
       ther details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_dcert_file (default: $smtpd_tls_dcert_file)
       File with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server DSA certificate in PEM format.
       This file may also contain the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server  private  DSA
       key.  See smtpd_tls_dcert_file for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_dh1024_param_file (default: $smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file)
       File  with DH parameters that the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server should use
       with EDH ciphers. See smtpd_tls_dh1024_param_file for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_dh512_param_file (default: $smtpd_tls_dh512_param_file)
       File with DH parameters that the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server should  use
       with EDH ciphers. See smtpd_tls_dh512_param_file for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_dkey_file (default: $smtpd_tls_dkey_file)
       File with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server DSA private key in PEM format.
       This file may be combined with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server DSA  cer‐
       tificate	   file	   specified	with	$smtpd_tls_dcert_file.	   See
       smtpd_tls_dkey_file for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_eccert_file (default: $smtpd_tls_eccert_file)
       File with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server ECDSA certificate in PEM  for‐
       mat.  This file may also contain the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server private
       ECDSA key.  See smtpd_tls_eccert_file for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_eckey_file (default: $smtpd_tls_eckey_file)
       File with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server ECDSA private key in PEM  for‐
       mat.   This  file  may  be combined with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server
       ECDSA certificate  file	specified  with	 $smtpd_tls_eccert_file.   See
       smtpd_tls_eckey_file for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_eecdh_grade (default: $smtpd_tls_eecdh_grade)
       The  Postfix  tlsproxy(8) server security grade for ephemeral elliptic-
       curve Diffie-Hellman (EECDH) key	 exchange.  See	 smtpd_tls_eecdh_grade
       for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_exclude_ciphers (default: $smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers)
       List  of ciphers or cipher types to exclude from the tlsproxy(8) server
       cipher list at all TLS security levels.	See  smtpd_tls_exclude_ciphers
       for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_fingerprint_digest (default: $smtpd_tls_fingerprint_digest)
       The  message  digest algorithm to construct remote SMTP client-certifi‐
       cate  fingerprints.  See	  smtpd_tls_fingerprint_digest	 for   further
       details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_key_file (default: $smtpd_tls_key_file)
       File with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server RSA private key in PEM format.
       This file may be combined with the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server RSA  cer‐
       tificate	    file    specified	 with	 $smtpd_tls_cert_file.	   See
       smtpd_tls_key_file for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_loglevel (default: $smtpd_tls_loglevel)
       Enable additional Postfix tlsproxy(8) server logging of	TLS  activity.
       Each  logging  level  also includes the information that is logged at a
       lower logging level. See smtpd_tls_loglevel for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_mandatory_ciphers (default: $smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers)
       The minimum TLS cipher grade that the Postfix tlsproxy(8)  server  will
       use  with mandatory TLS encryption. See smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers for
       further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers	     (default:	     $smtpd_tls_manda‐
       tory_exclude_ciphers)
       Additional  list	 of  ciphers  or  cipher  types	 to  exclude  from the
       tlsproxy(8) server cipher list at mandatory TLS security	 levels.   See
       smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_mandatory_protocols (default: $smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols)
       The  SSL/TLS  protocols accepted by the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server with
       mandatory TLS encryption. If the list is empty, the server supports all
       available SSL/TLS protocol versions.  See smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols
       for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_protocols (default: $smtpd_tls_protocols)
       List of TLS protocols that the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server will  exclude
       or  include  with opportunistic TLS encryption. See smtpd_tls_protocols
       for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_req_ccert (default: $smtpd_tls_req_ccert)
       With mandatory TLS encryption, require a	 trusted  remote  SMTP	client
       certificate  in	order  to  allow  TLS  connections  to	proceed.   See
       smtpd_tls_req_ccert for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_security_level (default: $smtpd_tls_security_level)
       The SMTP TLS security level for the Postfix tlsproxy(8) server; when  a
       non-empty  value	 is  specified, this overrides the obsolete parameters
       smtpd_use_tls and smtpd_enforce_tls. See	 smtpd_tls_security_level  for
       further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_tls_session_cache_timeout (default: $smtpd_tls_session_cache_timeout)

       The expiration time of Postfix tlsproxy(8)  server  TLS	session	 cache
       information.   A	  cache	  cleanup   is	performed  periodically	 every
       $smtpd_tls_session_cache_timeout	   seconds.	See	smtpd_tls_ses‐
       sion_cache_timeout for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_use_tls (default: $smtpd_use_tls)
       Opportunistic  TLS:  announce  STARTTLS support to remote SMTP clients,
       but do not require that clients use TLS encryption.  See	 smtpd_use_tls
       for further details.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8 and later.

tlsproxy_watchdog_timeout (default: 10s)
       How much time a tlsproxy(8) process may take to process local or remote
       I/O before it is terminated by a built-in watchdog timer.   This	 is  a
       safety mechanism that prevents tlsproxy(8) from becoming non-responsive
       due to a bug in Postfix itself or in system software.  To  avoid	 false
       alarms  and unnecessary cache corruption this limit cannot be set under
       10s.

       Specify a non-zero time value (an integral value plus an optional  one-
       letter  suffix that specifies the time unit).  Time units: s (seconds),
       m (minutes), h (hours), d (days), w (weeks).

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.8.

trace_service_name (default: trace)
       The name of the trace service.  This  service  is  implemented  by  the
       bounce(8) daemon and maintains a record of mail deliveries and produces
       a mail delivery report when verbose delivery is requested  with	"send‐
       mail -v".

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

transport_delivery_slot_cost (default: $default_delivery_slot_cost)
       A transport-specific override for the default_delivery_slot_cost param‐
       eter value, where transport is the master.cf name of the message deliv‐
       ery transport.

       Note:  transport_delivery_slot_cost  parameters	will  not  show	 up in
       "postconf" command output before Postfix version 2.9.  This  limitation
       applies	to  many parameters whose name is a combination of a master.cf
       service	name  and  a  built-in	suffix	 (in   this   case:   "_deliv‐
       ery_slot_cost").

transport_delivery_slot_discount (default: $default_delivery_slot_discount)
       A  transport-specific  override	for the default_delivery_slot_discount
       parameter value, where transport is the master.cf name of  the  message
       delivery transport.

       Note:  transport_delivery_slot_discount	parameters will not show up in
       "postconf" command output before Postfix version 2.9.  This  limitation
       applies	to  many parameters whose name is a combination of a master.cf
       service name and a built-in suffix (in this case:  "_delivery_slot_dis‐
       count").

transport_delivery_slot_loan (default: $default_delivery_slot_loan)
       A transport-specific override for the default_delivery_slot_loan param‐
       eter value, where transport is the master.cf name of the message deliv‐
       ery transport.

       Note:  transport_delivery_slot_loan  parameters	will  not  show	 up in
       "postconf" command output before Postfix version 2.9.  This  limitation
       applies	to  many parameters whose name is a combination of a master.cf
       service	name  and  a  built-in	suffix	 (in   this   case:   "_deliv‐
       ery_slot_loan").

transport_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit  (default: $default_des‐
       tination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit)
       A  transport-specific  override	for  the   default_destination_concur‐
       rency_failed_cohort_limit  parameter value, where transport is the mas‐
       ter.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note: some transport_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit param‐
       eters will not show up in "postconf" command output before Postfix ver‐
       sion 2.9.  This limitation applies to many parameters whose name	 is  a
       combination  of a master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in this
       case: "_destination_concurrency_failed_cohort_limit").

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

transport_destination_concurrency_limit (default: $default_destination_concur‐
       rency_limit)
       A   transport-specific  override	 for  the  default_destination_concur‐
       rency_limit parameter value, where transport is the master.cf  name  of
       the message delivery transport.

       Note:  some transport_destination_concurrency_limit parameters will not
       show up in "postconf" command output before Postfix version 2.9.	  This
       limitation  applies to many parameters whose name is a combination of a
       master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in this case:  "_destina‐
       tion_concurrency_limit").

transport_destination_concurrency_negative_feedback  (default: $default_desti‐
       nation_concurrency_negative_feedback)
       A  transport-specific  override	for  the   default_destination_concur‐
       rency_negative_feedback	parameter  value,  where transport is the mas‐
       ter.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note: some transport_destination_concurrency_negative_feedback  parame‐
       ters  will not show up in "postconf" command output before Postfix ver‐
       sion 2.9.  This limitation applies to many parameters whose name	 is  a
       combination  of a master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in this
       case: "_destination_concurrency_negative_feedback").

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

transport_destination_concurrency_positive_feedback (default:  $default_desti‐
       nation_concurrency_positive_feedback)
       A   transport-specific  override	 for  the  default_destination_concur‐
       rency_positive_feedback parameter value, where transport	 is  the  mas‐
       ter.cf name of the message delivery transport.

       Note:  some transport_destination_concurrency_positive_feedback parame‐
       ters will not show up in "postconf" command output before Postfix  ver‐
       sion  2.9.   This limitation applies to many parameters whose name is a
       combination of a master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in  this
       case: "_destination_concurrency_positive_feedback").

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

transport_destination_rate_delay (default: $default_destination_rate_delay)
       A  transport-specific  override	for the default_destination_rate_delay
       parameter value, where transport is the master.cf name of  the  message
       delivery transport.

       Note: some transport_destination_rate_delay parameters will not show up
       in "postconf" command output before Postfix version 2.9.	 This  limita‐
       tion  applies  to many parameters whose name is a combination of a mas‐
       ter.cf service name and a built-in suffix  (in  this  case:  "_destina‐
       tion_rate_delay").

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

transport_destination_recipient_limit  (default:  $default_destination_recipi‐
       ent_limit)
       A  transport-specific  override	for  the   default_destination_recipi‐
       ent_limit parameter value, where transport is the master.cf name of the
       message delivery transport.

       Note: some transport_destination_recipient_limit	 parameters  will  not
       show  up in "postconf" command output before Postfix version 2.9.  This
       limitation applies to many parameters whose name is a combination of  a
       master.cf  service name and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_destina‐
       tion_recipient_limit").

transport_extra_recipient_limit (default: $default_extra_recipient_limit)
       A transport-specific  override  for  the	 default_extra_recipient_limit
       parameter  value,  where transport is the master.cf name of the message
       delivery transport.

       Note: transport_extra_recipient_limit parameters will not  show	up  in
       "postconf"  command output before Postfix version 2.9.  This limitation
       applies to many parameters whose name is a combination of  a  master.cf
       service	name  and  a  built-in	suffix	(in this case: "_extra_recipi‐
       ent_limit").

transport_initial_destination_concurrency (default:  $initial_destination_con‐
       currency)
       A  transport-specific  override for the initial_destination_concurrency
       parameter value, where transport is the master.cf name of  the  message
       delivery transport.

       Note:  some  transport_initial_destination_concurrency  parameters will
       not show up in "postconf" command output before	Postfix	 version  2.9.
       This  limitation applies to many parameters whose name is a combination
       of a master.cf service name and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_ini‐
       tial_destination_concurrency").

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.5 and later.

transport_maps (default: empty)
       Optional lookup tables with mappings from recipient address to (message
       delivery	 transport,  next-hop  destination).   See  transport(5)   for
       details.

       Specify	zero or more "type:table" lookup tables.  If you use this fea‐
       ture with local files, run "postmap /etc/postfix/transport" after  mak‐
       ing a change.

       For safety reasons, as of Postfix 2.3 this feature does not allow $num‐
       ber substitutions in regular expression maps.

       Examples:

       transport_maps = dbm:/etc/postfix/transport
       transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport

transport_minimum_delivery_slots (default: $default_minimum_delivery_slots)
       A transport-specific override  for  the	default_minimum_delivery_slots
       parameter  value,  where transport is the master.cf name of the message
       delivery transport.

       Note: transport_minimum_delivery_slots parameters will not show	up  in
       "postconf"  command output before Postfix version 2.9.  This limitation
       applies to many parameters whose name is a combination of  a  master.cf
       service	name  and  a  built-in	suffix (in this case: "_minimum_deliv‐
       ery_slots").

transport_recipient_limit (default: $default_recipient_limit)
       A transport-specific override for the default_recipient_limit parameter
       value,  where  transport	 is the master.cf name of the message delivery
       transport.

       Note: some transport_recipient_limit parameters will  not  show	up  in
       "postconf"  command output before Postfix version 2.9.  This limitation
       applies to many parameters whose name is a combination of  a  master.cf
       service name and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_recipient_limit").

transport_recipient_refill_delay (default: $default_recipient_refill_delay)
       A  transport-specific  override	for the default_recipient_refill_delay
       parameter value, where transport is the master.cf name of  the  message
       delivery transport.

       Note:  transport_recipient_refill_delay	parameters will not show up in
       "postconf" command output before Postfix version 2.9.  This  limitation
       applies	to  many parameters whose name is a combination of a master.cf
       service	name  and  a  built-in	suffix	(in   this   case:   "_recipi‐
       ent_refill_delay").

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later.

transport_recipient_refill_limit (default: $default_recipient_refill_limit)
       A  transport-specific  override	for the default_recipient_refill_limit
       parameter value, where transport is the master.cf name of  the  message
       delivery transport.

       Note:  transport_recipient_refill_limit	parameters will not show up in
       "postconf" command output before Postfix version 2.9.  This  limitation
       applies	to  many parameters whose name is a combination of a master.cf
       service	name  and  a  built-in	suffix	(in   this   case:   "_recipi‐
       ent_refill_limit").

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.4 and later.

transport_retry_time (default: 60s)
       The  time  between  attempts  by the Postfix queue manager to contact a
       malfunctioning message delivery transport.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

transport_time_limit (default: $command_time_limit)
       A  transport-specific  override	for  the  command_time_limit parameter
       value, where transport is the master.cf name of	the  message  delivery
       transport.

       Note:  transport_time_limit  parameters	will not show up in "postconf"
       command output before Postfix version 2.9.  This limitation applies  to
       many parameters whose name is a combination of a master.cf service name
       and a built-in suffix (in this case: "_time_limit").

trigger_timeout (default: 10s)
       The time limit for sending a trigger to a Postfix daemon (for  example,
       the  pickup(8)  or  qmgr(8)  daemon). This time limit prevents programs
       from getting stuck when the mail system is under heavy load.

       Time units: s (seconds), m (minutes), h (hours), d (days),  w  (weeks).
       The default time unit is s (seconds).

undisclosed_recipients_header (default: see postconf -d output)
       Message	header	that the Postfix cleanup(8) server inserts when a mes‐
       sage contains no To: or Cc: message header. With Postfix 2.8 and later,
       the  default  value  is	empty.	With Postfix 2.4-2.7, specify an empty
       value to disable this feature.

       Example:

       # Default value before Postfix 2.8.
       # Note: the ":" and ";" are both required.
       undisclosed_recipients_header = To: undisclosed-recipients:;

unknown_address_reject_code (default: 450)
       The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a sender or recip‐
       ient   address  is  rejected  by	 the  reject_unknown_sender_domain  or
       reject_unknown_recipient_domain restriction.  The  response  is	always
       450 in case of a temporary DNS error.

       Do  not	change	this  unless  you have a complete understanding of RFC
       5321.

unknown_address_tempfail_action (default: $reject_tempfail_action)
       The Postfix SMTP server's action when  reject_unknown_sender_domain  or
       reject_unknown_recipient_domain	fail  due  to a temporary error condi‐
       tion. Specify "defer" to defer the remote SMTP client  request  immedi‐
       ately.  With  the  default  "defer_if_permit"  action, the Postfix SMTP
       server continues to look for opportunities to reject mail,  and	defers
       the client request only if it would otherwise be accepted.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

unknown_client_reject_code (default: 450)
       The  numerical  Postfix SMTP server response code when a client without
       valid   address	 <=>	name	mapping	   is	 rejected    by	   the
       reject_unknown_client_hostname  restriction.  The  SMTP	server	always
       replies with 450 when the mapping failed due to a temporary error  con‐
       dition.

       Do  not	change	this  unless  you have a complete understanding of RFC
       5321.

unknown_helo_hostname_tempfail_action (default: $reject_tempfail_action)
       The Postfix  SMTP  server's  action  when  reject_unknown_helo_hostname
       fails due to an temporary error condition. Specify "defer" to defer the
       remote SMTP client request immediately. With the default "defer_if_per‐
       mit"  action,  the Postfix SMTP server continues to look for opportuni‐
       ties to reject mail, and defers the client request  only	 if  it	 would
       otherwise be accepted.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

unknown_hostname_reject_code (default: 450)
       The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when the hostname spec‐
       ified  with  the	 HELO	or   EHLO   command   is   rejected   by   the
       reject_unknown_helo_hostname restriction.

       Do  not	change	this  unless  you have a complete understanding of RFC
       5321.

unknown_local_recipient_reject_code (default: 550)
       The numerical Postfix  SMTP  server  response  code  when  a  recipient
       address	is local, and $local_recipient_maps specifies a list of lookup
       tables that does not match the recipient.  A recipient address is local
       when   its   domain   matches   $mydestination,	 $proxy_interfaces  or
       $inet_interfaces.

       The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer	 to  initially
       use  450	 (try  again  later)  so  you  have  time  to find out if your
       local_recipient_maps settings are OK.

       Example:

       unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 450

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

unknown_relay_recipient_reject_code (default: 550)
       The numerical Postfix SMTP server reply code when a  recipient  address
       matches	$relay_domains,	 and  relay_recipient_maps specifies a list of
       lookup tables that does not match the recipient address.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

unknown_virtual_alias_reject_code (default: 550)
       The Postfix SMTP server reply code when	a  recipient  address  matches
       $virtual_alias_domains,	and  $virtual_alias_maps  specifies  a list of
       lookup tables that does not match the recipient address.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

unknown_virtual_mailbox_reject_code (default: 550)
       The Postfix SMTP server reply code when	a  recipient  address  matches
       $virtual_mailbox_domains, and $virtual_mailbox_maps specifies a list of
       lookup tables that does not match the recipient address.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

unverified_recipient_defer_code (default: 450)
       The numerical Postfix SMTP server response  when	 a  recipient  address
       probe fails due to a temporary error condition.

       Unlike elsewhere in Postfix, you can specify 250 in order to accept the
       address anyway.

       Do not change this unless you have  a  complete	understanding  of  RFC
       5321.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

unverified_recipient_reject_code (default: 450)
       The  numerical Postfix SMTP server response when a recipient address is
       rejected by the reject_unverified_recipient restriction.

       Unlike elsewhere in Postfix, you can specify 250 in order to accept the
       address anyway.

       Do  not	change	this  unless  you have a complete understanding of RFC
       5321.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

unverified_recipient_reject_reason (default: empty)
       The Postfix SMTP server's reply when rejecting mail with reject_unveri‐
       fied_recipient.	Do  not	 include  the  numeric	SMTP reply code or the
       enhanced status code. By default, the response includes actual  address
       verification details.

       Example:

       unverified_recipient_reject_reason = Recipient address lookup failed

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

unverified_recipient_tempfail_action (default: $reject_tempfail_action)
       The Postfix SMTP server's action when reject_unverified_recipient fails
       due to a temporary error condition. Specify "defer" to defer the remote
       SMTP  client  request  immediately.  With the default "defer_if_permit"
       action, the Postfix SMTP server continues to look for opportunities  to
       reject  mail,  and defers the client request only if it would otherwise
       be accepted.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

unverified_sender_defer_code (default: 450)
       The numerical Postfix SMTP server response code when a  sender  address
       probe fails due to a temporary error condition.

       Unlike elsewhere in Postfix, you can specify 250 in order to accept the
       address anyway.

       Do not change this unless you have  a  complete	understanding  of  RFC
       5321.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

unverified_sender_reject_code (default: 450)
       The  numerical  Postfix	SMTP  server  response	code  when a recipient
       address is rejected by the reject_unverified_sender restriction.

       Unlike elsewhere in Postfix, you can specify 250 in order to accept the
       address anyway.

       Do  not	change	this  unless  you have a complete understanding of RFC
       5321.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

unverified_sender_reject_reason (default: empty)
       The Postfix SMTP server's reply when rejecting mail with reject_unveri‐
       fied_sender. Do not include the numeric SMTP reply code or the enhanced
       status code. By default, the response includes actual address verifica‐
       tion details.

       Example:

       unverified_sender_reject_reason = Sender address lookup failed

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

unverified_sender_tempfail_action (default: $reject_tempfail_action)
       The  Postfix  SMTP  server's action when reject_unverified_sender fails
       due to a temporary error condition. Specify "defer" to defer the remote
       SMTP  client  request  immediately.  With the default "defer_if_permit"
       action, the Postfix SMTP server continues to look for opportunities  to
       reject  mail,  and defers the client request only if it would otherwise
       be accepted.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.6 and later.

verp_delimiter_filter (default: -=+)
       The characters Postfix accepts as  VERP	delimiter  characters  on  the
       Postfix sendmail(1) command line and in SMTP commands.

       This feature is available in Postfix 1.1 and later.

virtual_alias_domains (default: $virtual_alias_maps)
       Postfix	is  final  destination for the specified list of virtual alias
       domains, that is, domains  for  which  all  addresses  are  aliased  to
       addresses  in  other local or remote domains. The SMTP server validates
       recipient addresses with $virtual_alias_maps and	 rejects  non-existent
       recipients.   See   also	  the	virtual	 alias	domain	class  in  the
       ADDRESS_CLASS_README file

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. The	default	 value
       is backwards compatible with Postfix version 1.1.

       The  default  value  is	$virtual_alias_maps  so	 that you can keep all
       information about virtual alias domains in one place.  If you have many
       users,  it  is  better  to  separate information that changes more fre‐
       quently (virtual address ->  local  or  remote  address	mapping)  from
       information  that  changes  less frequently (the list of virtual domain
       names).

       Specify a list of host or domain names,	"/file/name"  or  "type:table"
       patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A "/file/name" pattern
       is replaced by its contents; a "type:table"  lookup  table  is  matched
       when  a	table  entry  matches  a  lookup  string (the lookup result is
       ignored).  Continue long lines by starting the next  line  with	white‐
       space.  Specify	"!pattern"  to	exclude a host or domain name from the
       list. The form "!/file/name" is supported only in Postfix  version  2.4
       and later.

       See also the VIRTUAL_README and ADDRESS_CLASS_README documents for fur‐
       ther information.

       Example:

       virtual_alias_domains = virtual1.tld virtual2.tld

virtual_alias_expansion_limit (default: 1000)
       The maximal number of addresses that virtual alias  expansion  produces
       from each original recipient.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

virtual_alias_maps (default: $virtual_maps)
       Optional lookup tables that alias specific mail addresses or domains to
       other local or remote address.  The table format and lookups are	 docu‐
       mented  in virtual(5). For an overview of Postfix address manipulations
       see the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. The	default	 value
       is backwards compatible with Postfix version 1.1.

       If  you	use  this  feature with indexed files, run "postmap /etc/post‐
       fix/virtual" after changing the file.

       Examples:

       virtual_alias_maps = dbm:/etc/postfix/virtual
       virtual_alias_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/virtual

virtual_alias_recursion_limit (default: 1000)
       The maximal nesting depth of virtual alias  expansion.	Currently  the
       recursion  limit	 is  applied  only to the left branch of the expansion
       graph, so the depth of the tree can in the worst case reach the sum  of
       the expansion and recursion limits.  This may change in the future.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.1 and later.

virtual_destination_concurrency_limit  (default:  $default_destination_concur‐
       rency_limit)
       The maximal number of parallel deliveries to the same  destination  via
       the  virtual  message delivery transport. This limit is enforced by the
       queue manager. The message delivery transport name is the  first	 field
       in the entry in the master.cf file.

virtual_destination_recipient_limit   (default:	  $default_destination_recipi‐
       ent_limit)
       The maximal number of recipients per message for	 the  virtual  message
       delivery	 transport.  This  limit is enforced by the queue manager. The
       message delivery transport name is the first field in the entry in  the
       master.cf file.

       Setting	this  parameter	 to  a	value of 1 changes the meaning of vir‐
       tual_destination_concurrency_limit from	concurrency  per  domain  into
       concurrency per recipient.

virtual_gid_maps (default: empty)
       Lookup  tables  with  the per-recipient group ID for virtual(8) mailbox
       delivery.

       This parameter is specific to the virtual(8) delivery agent.   It  does
       not  apply  when	 mail is delivered with a different mail delivery pro‐
       gram.

       In a lookup table, specify a left-hand side of "@domain.tld"  to	 match
       any  user  in  the  specified  domain  that  does  not  have a specific
       "user@domain.tld" entry.

       When  a	recipient  address   has   an	optional   address   extension
       (user+foo@domain.tld),  the virtual(8) delivery agent looks up the full
       address first, and when the lookup fails, it looks  up  the  unextended
       address (user@domain.tld).

       Note  1:	 for security reasons, the virtual(8) delivery agent disallows
       regular expression substitution of $1 etc. in regular expression lookup
       tables, because that would open a security hole.

       Note  2:	 for  security	reasons,  the  virtual(8)  delivery agent will
       silently ignore requests to use the proxymap(8) server. Instead it will
       open  the  table	 directly.  Before Postfix version 2.2, the virtual(8)
       delivery agent will terminate with a fatal error.

virtual_mailbox_base (default: empty)
       A prefix that the virtual(8) delivery agent prepends  to	 all  pathname
       results	from  $virtual_mailbox_maps  table  lookups.  This is a safety
       measure to ensure that an out of control map doesn't  litter  the  file
       system with mailboxes.  While virtual_mailbox_base could be set to "/",
       this setting isn't recommended.

       This parameter is specific to the virtual(8) delivery agent.   It  does
       not  apply  when	 mail is delivered with a different mail delivery pro‐
       gram.

       Example:

       virtual_mailbox_base = /var/mail

virtual_mailbox_domains (default: $virtual_mailbox_maps)
       Postfix is final destination for the specified list of domains; mail is
       delivered  via  the  $virtual_transport	mail  delivery	transport.  By
       default this is the Postfix virtual(8) delivery agent.  The SMTP server
       validates  recipient  addresses	with $virtual_mailbox_maps and rejects
       mail for non-existent recipients.  See also the virtual mailbox	domain
       class in the ADDRESS_CLASS_README file.

       This  parameter expects the same syntax as the mydestination configura‐
       tion parameter.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later. The	default	 value
       is backwards compatible with Postfix version 1.1.

virtual_mailbox_limit (default: 51200000)
       The  maximal  size  in  bytes  of  an  individual virtual(8) mailbox or
       maildir file, or zero (no limit).

       This parameter is specific to the virtual(8) delivery agent.   It  does
       not  apply  when	 mail is delivered with a different mail delivery pro‐
       gram.

virtual_mailbox_lock (default: see postconf -d output)
       How to lock a UNIX-style virtual(8) mailbox before attempting delivery.
       For  a  list  of	 available file locking methods, use the "postconf -l"
       command.

       This parameter is specific to the virtual(8) delivery agent.   It  does
       not  apply  when	 mail is delivered with a different mail delivery pro‐
       gram.

       This setting is ignored	with  maildir  style  delivery,	 because  such
       deliveries are safe without application-level locks.

       Note  1:	 the dotlock method requires that the recipient UID or GID has
       write access to the parent directory of the recipient's mailbox file.

       Note 2: the default setting of this parameter is system dependent.

virtual_mailbox_maps (default: empty)
       Optional lookup tables with all valid addresses	in  the	 domains  that
       match $virtual_mailbox_domains.

       In  a  lookup table, specify a left-hand side of "@domain.tld" to match
       any user in  the	 specified  domain  that  does	not  have  a  specific
       "user@domain.tld" entry.

       The  remainder  of  this	 text  is  specific to the virtual(8) delivery
       agent.  It does not apply when mail is delivered with a different  mail
       delivery program.

       The virtual(8) delivery agent uses this table to look up the per-recip‐
       ient mailbox or maildir pathname.  If the lookup result ends in a slash
       ("/"),  maildir-style  delivery	is  carried out, otherwise the path is
       assumed to specify a UNIX-style mailbox file.  Note that $virtual_mail‐
       box_base is unconditionally prepended to this path.

       When   a	  recipient   address	has   an  optional  address  extension
       (user+foo@domain.tld), the virtual(8) delivery agent looks up the  full
       address	first,	and  when the lookup fails, it looks up the unextended
       address (user@domain.tld).

       Note 1: for security reasons, the virtual(8) delivery  agent  disallows
       regular expression substitution of $1 etc. in regular expression lookup
       tables, because that would open a security hole.

       Note 2: for  security  reasons,	the  virtual(8)	 delivery  agent  will
       silently ignore requests to use the proxymap(8) server. Instead it will
       open the table directly. Before Postfix	version	 2.2,  the  virtual(8)
       delivery agent will terminate with a fatal error.

virtual_maps (default: empty)
       Optional lookup tables with a) names of domains for which all addresses
       are aliased to addresses in other  local	 or  remote  domains,  and  b)
       addresses  that	are  aliased  to  addresses  in	 other local or remote
       domains.	 Available before Postfix version 2.0.	With  Postfix  version
       2.0   and   later,   this   is  replaced	 by  separate  controls:  vir‐
       tual_alias_domains and virtual_alias_maps.

virtual_minimum_uid (default: 100)
       The minimum user ID value that the virtual(8) delivery agent accepts as
       a  result  from	$virtual_uid_maps  table lookup.  Returned values less
       than this will be rejected, and the message will be deferred.

       This parameter is specific to the virtual(8) delivery agent.   It  does
       not  apply  when	 mail is delivered with a different mail delivery pro‐
       gram.

virtual_transport (default: virtual)
       The default mail delivery transport and next-hop destination for	 final
       delivery	 to domains listed with $virtual_mailbox_domains.  This infor‐
       mation can be overruled with the transport(5) table.

       Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is  the
       name  of	 a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf.  The :nexthop
       destination is optional; its syntax is documented in the manual page of
       the corresponding delivery agent.

       This feature is available in Postfix 2.0 and later.

virtual_uid_maps (default: empty)
       Lookup tables with the per-recipient user ID that the virtual(8) deliv‐
       ery agent uses while writing to the recipient's mailbox.

       This parameter is specific to the virtual(8) delivery agent.   It  does
       not  apply  when	 mail is delivered with a different mail delivery pro‐
       gram.

       In a lookup table, specify a left-hand side of "@domain.tld"  to	 match
       any  user  in  the  specified  domain  that  does  not  have a specific
       "user@domain.tld" entry.

       When  a	recipient  address   has   an	optional   address   extension
       (user+foo@domain.tld),  the virtual(8) delivery agent looks up the full
       address first, and when the lookup fails, it looks  up  the  unextended
       address (user@domain.tld).

       Note  1:	 for security reasons, the virtual(8) delivery agent disallows
       regular expression substitution of $1 etc. in regular expression lookup
       tables, because that would open a security hole.

       Note  2:	 for  security	reasons,  the  virtual(8)  delivery agent will
       silently ignore requests to use the proxymap(8) server. Instead it will
       open  the  table	 directly.  Before Postfix version 2.2, the virtual(8)
       delivery agent will terminate with a fatal error.

SEE ALSO
       postconf(1), Postfix configuration parameter maintenance
       master(5), Postfix daemon configuration maintenance

LICENSE
       The Secure Mailer license must be distributed with this software.

AUTHOR(S)
       Wietse Venema
       IBM T.J. Watson Research
       P.O. Box 704
       Yorktown Heights, NY 10598, USA

								   POSTCONF(5)
[top]

List of man pages available for Oracle

Copyright (c) for man pages and the logo by the respective OS vendor.

For those who want to learn more, the polarhome community provides shell access and support.

[legal] [privacy] [GNU] [policy] [cookies] [netiquette] [sponsors] [FAQ]
Tweet
Polarhome, production since 1999.
Member of Polarhome portal.
Based on Fawad Halim's script.
....................................................................
Vote for polarhome
Free Shell Accounts :: the biggest list on the net